summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/Documentation
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'Documentation')
-rw-r--r--Documentation/00-INDEX6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/obsolete/sysfs-class-rfkill2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/removed/devfs2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-driver-usb-usbtmc10
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-module2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-block-dm25
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-rpmsg75
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-usb11
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-net-mesh7
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-power18
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-soc58
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-driver-samsung-laptop2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-mm-cleancache11
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/80211.tmpl1
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/filesystems.tmpl2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/kgdb.tmpl17
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl8
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/biblio.xml20
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/compat.xml18
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/controls.xml220
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/selection-api.xml8
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/v4l2.xml19
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-decoder-cmd.xml256
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-encoder-cmd.xml9
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-jpegcomp.xml16
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-selection.xml106
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-querycap.xml36
-rw-r--r--Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-s-hw-freq-seek.xml6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/1024x768.S44
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/1280x1024.S44
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/1680x1050.S44
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/1920x1080.S44
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/HOWTO.txt39
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/Makefile26
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/edid.S261
-rw-r--r--Documentation/EDID/hex1
-rw-r--r--Documentation/IRQ-domain.txt117
-rw-r--r--Documentation/RCU/RTFP.txt1784
-rw-r--r--Documentation/RCU/checklist.txt14
-rw-r--r--Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt87
-rw-r--r--Documentation/RCU/torture.txt33
-rw-r--r--Documentation/RCU/trace.txt36
-rw-r--r--Documentation/arm/kernel_user_helpers.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/backlight/lp855x-driver.txt78
-rw-r--r--Documentation/cgroups/blkio-controller.txt18
-rw-r--r--Documentation/cgroups/cgroups.txt26
-rw-r--r--Documentation/clk.txt233
-rw-r--r--Documentation/crc32.txt182
-rw-r--r--Documentation/device-mapper/dm-raid.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/device-mapper/persistent-data.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/device-mapper/thin-provisioning.txt67
-rw-r--r--Documentation/device-mapper/verity.txt194
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-aic.txt38
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-at91.txt92
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-pmc.txt11
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/exynos/power_domain.txt21
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/fsl.txt22
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/mrvl.txt6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/intc.txt27
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/omap.txt8
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/sirf.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/spear.txt8
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/emc.txt100
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/nvidia,tegra20-pmc.txt19
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/twd.txt48
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/vexpress.txt146
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/tegra20-apbdma.txt30
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_atmel.txt20
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_i2c.txt32
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_nvidia.txt36
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/led.txt6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/mrvl-gpio.txt23
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/mrvl-i2c.txt37
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/sirf-i2c.txt19
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/matrix-keymap.txt19
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/tegra-kbc.txt17
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/atmel-nand.txt41
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/nand.txt7
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/net/stmmac.txt28
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic-msgr.txt63
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic.txt22
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/msi-pic.txt6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/twl-regulator.txt68
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rtc/sa1100-rtc.txt17
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/serial/mrvl-serial.txt4
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/alc5632.txt24
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/imx-audmux.txt13
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sgtl5000.txt (renamed from Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/soc/codecs/fsl-sgtl5000.txt)0
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/tegra-audio-alc5632.txt59
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/omap-spi.txt20
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/tty/serial/efm32-uart.txt14
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/atmel-usb.txt49
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/tegra-usb.txt13
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/devicetree/booting-without-of.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/dmaengine.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/driver-model/devres.txt5
-rw-r--r--Documentation/dvb/cards.txt1
-rw-r--r--Documentation/dvb/lmedm04.txt11
-rw-r--r--Documentation/dynamic-debug-howto.txt30
-rw-r--r--Documentation/edac.txt4
-rw-r--r--Documentation/fb/matroxfb.txt8
-rw-r--r--Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt27
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/debugfs.txt7
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/ext4.txt12
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/gfs2-uevents.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/nfs/idmapper.txt20
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/nfs/pnfs.txt54
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/pohmelfs/network_protocol.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/porting6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt32
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/qnx6.txt174
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/ramfs-rootfs-initramfs.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/adm127532
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/jc4249
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/lm809
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/lm904
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/max160644
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/max3444034
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/max86884
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/mc13783-adc50
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/mcp302122
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/pmbus9
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/sch56275
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/sch56363
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/ucd90006
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/ucd920010
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/w83627ehf9
-rw-r--r--Documentation/hwmon/zl610026
-rw-r--r--Documentation/i2c/instantiating-devices6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/i2o/ioctl12
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ide/ChangeLog.ide-cd.1994-20042
-rw-r--r--Documentation/input/alps.txt7
-rw-r--r--Documentation/input/joystick.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt4
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ioctl/ioctl-number.txt5
-rw-r--r--Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt73
-rw-r--r--Documentation/ko_KR/HOWTO2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/kobject.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt63
-rw-r--r--Documentation/lockup-watchdogs.txt63
-rw-r--r--Documentation/magic-number.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/LICENSE.qlge328
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/dns_resolver.txt4
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/fore200e.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/l2tp.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/mac80211-auth-assoc-deauth.txt99
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/netdev-features.txt13
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/phy.txt3
-rw-r--r--Documentation/networking/ppp_generic.txt6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/nmi_watchdog.txt83
-rw-r--r--Documentation/numastat.txt27
-rw-r--r--Documentation/pinctrl.txt311
-rw-r--r--Documentation/power/devices.txt93
-rw-r--r--Documentation/power/freezing-of-tasks.txt21
-rw-r--r--Documentation/powerpc/firmware-assisted-dump.txt270
-rw-r--r--Documentation/powerpc/mpc52xx.txt12
-rw-r--r--Documentation/powerpc/phyp-assisted-dump.txt127
-rw-r--r--Documentation/remoteproc.txt322
-rw-r--r--Documentation/rpmsg.txt293
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scheduler/sched-stats.txt3
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.lpfc2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid_sas2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.qla2xxx41
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/bfa.txt82
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/libsas.txt15
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/security/00-INDEX2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/security/Smack.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/security/Yama.txt65
-rw-r--r--Documentation/security/keys-trusted-encrypted.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/security/keys.txt6
-rw-r--r--Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt10
-rw-r--r--Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio-Models.txt79
-rw-r--r--Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio.txt7
-rw-r--r--Documentation/spi/spi-summary58
-rw-r--r--Documentation/static-keys.txt286
-rwxr-xr-xDocumentation/target/tcm_mod_builder.py2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/trace/events-power.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/trace/ftrace.txt7
-rw-r--r--Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/usb/power-management.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/usb/proc_usb_info.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx238851
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx884
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.em28xx10
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.saa71341
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.tuner3
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/fimc.txt178
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/gspca.txt1
-rw-r--r--Documentation/video4linux/uvcvideo.txt2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/virtual/kvm/mmu.txt4
-rw-r--r--Documentation/virtual/virtio-spec.txt8
-rw-r--r--Documentation/vm/cleancache.txt43
-rw-r--r--Documentation/vm/page-types.c2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/vm/pagemap.txt4
-rw-r--r--Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.txt8
-rw-r--r--Documentation/watchdog/00-INDEX19
-rw-r--r--Documentation/watchdog/convert_drivers_to_kernel_api.txt4
-rw-r--r--Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-kernel-api.txt13
-rw-r--r--Documentation/zh_CN/HOWTO2
-rw-r--r--Documentation/zh_CN/magic-number.txt2
207 files changed, 8425 insertions, 1097 deletions
diff --git a/Documentation/00-INDEX b/Documentation/00-INDEX
index 65bbd262239..2214f123a97 100644
--- a/Documentation/00-INDEX
+++ b/Documentation/00-INDEX
@@ -7,8 +7,8 @@ Please try and keep the descriptions small enough to fit on one line.
Following translations are available on the WWW:
- - Japanese, maintained by the JF Project (JF@linux.or.jp), at
- http://www.linux.or.jp/JF/
+ - Japanese, maintained by the JF Project (jf@listserv.linux.or.jp), at
+ http://linuxjf.sourceforge.jp/
00-INDEX
- this file.
@@ -104,6 +104,8 @@ cpuidle/
- info on CPU_IDLE, CPU idle state management subsystem.
cputopology.txt
- documentation on how CPU topology info is exported via sysfs.
+crc32.txt
+ - brief tutorial on CRC computation
cris/
- directory with info about Linux on CRIS architecture.
crypto/
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/obsolete/sysfs-class-rfkill b/Documentation/ABI/obsolete/sysfs-class-rfkill
index 4201d5b0551..ff60ad9eca4 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/obsolete/sysfs-class-rfkill
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/obsolete/sysfs-class-rfkill
@@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ Date: 09-Jul-2007
KernelVersion v2.6.22
Contact: linux-wireless@vger.kernel.org
Description: Current state of the transmitter.
- This file is deprecated and sheduled to be removed in 2014,
+ This file is deprecated and scheduled to be removed in 2014,
because its not possible to express the 'soft and hard block'
state of the rfkill driver.
Values: A numeric value.
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/removed/devfs b/Documentation/ABI/removed/devfs
index 8ffd28bf659..0020c49933c 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/removed/devfs
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/removed/devfs
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
What: devfs
Date: July 2005 (scheduled), finally removed in kernel v2.6.18
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
devfs has been unmaintained for a number of years, has unfixable
races, contains a naming policy within the kernel that is
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-driver-usb-usbtmc b/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-driver-usb-usbtmc
index 9a75fb22187..23a43b8207e 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-driver-usb-usbtmc
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-driver-usb-usbtmc
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/interface_capabilities
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/device_capabilities
Date: August 2008
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
These files show the various USB TMC capabilities as described
by the device itself. The full description of the bitfields
@@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ Description:
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/usb488_interface_capabilities
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/usb488_device_capabilities
Date: August 2008
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
These files show the various USB TMC capabilities as described
by the device itself. The full description of the bitfields
@@ -29,7 +29,7 @@ Description:
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/TermChar
Date: August 2008
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
This file is the TermChar value to be sent to the USB TMC
device as described by the document, "Universal Serial Bus Test
@@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ Description:
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/TermCharEnabled
Date: August 2008
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
This file determines if the TermChar is to be sent to the
device on every transaction or not. For more details about
@@ -53,7 +53,7 @@ Description:
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/auto_abort
Date: August 2008
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
This file determines if the the transaction of the USB TMC
device is to be automatically aborted if there is any error.
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-module b/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-module
index 75be4311833..a0dd21c6db5 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-module
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/stable/sysfs-module
@@ -6,7 +6,7 @@ Description:
The name of the module that is in the kernel. This
module name will show up either if the module is built
directly into the kernel, or if it is loaded as a
- dyanmic module.
+ dynamic module.
/sys/module/MODULENAME/parameters
This directory contains individual files that are each
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-block-dm b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-block-dm
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..87ca5691e29
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-block-dm
@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
+What: /sys/block/dm-<num>/dm/name
+Date: January 2009
+KernelVersion: 2.6.29
+Contact: dm-devel@redhat.com
+Description: Device-mapper device name.
+ Read-only string containing mapped device name.
+Users: util-linux, device-mapper udev rules
+
+What: /sys/block/dm-<num>/dm/uuid
+Date: January 2009
+KernelVersion: 2.6.29
+Contact: dm-devel@redhat.com
+Description: Device-mapper device UUID.
+ Read-only string containing DM-UUID or empty string
+ if DM-UUID is not set.
+Users: util-linux, device-mapper udev rules
+
+What: /sys/block/dm-<num>/dm/suspended
+Date: June 2009
+KernelVersion: 2.6.31
+Contact: dm-devel@redhat.com
+Description: Device-mapper device suspend state.
+ Contains the value 1 while the device is suspended.
+ Otherwise it contains 0. Read-only attribute.
+Users: util-linux, device-mapper udev rules
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-rpmsg b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-rpmsg
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..189e419a5a2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-rpmsg
@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
+What: /sys/bus/rpmsg/devices/.../name
+Date: June 2011
+KernelVersion: 3.3
+Contact: Ohad Ben-Cohen <ohad@wizery.com>
+Description:
+ Every rpmsg device is a communication channel with a remote
+ processor. Channels are identified with a (textual) name,
+ which is maximum 32 bytes long (defined as RPMSG_NAME_SIZE in
+ rpmsg.h).
+
+ This sysfs entry contains the name of this channel.
+
+What: /sys/bus/rpmsg/devices/.../src
+Date: June 2011
+KernelVersion: 3.3
+Contact: Ohad Ben-Cohen <ohad@wizery.com>
+Description:
+ Every rpmsg device is a communication channel with a remote
+ processor. Channels have a local ("source") rpmsg address,
+ and remote ("destination") rpmsg address. When an entity
+ starts listening on one end of a channel, it assigns it with
+ a unique rpmsg address (a 32 bits integer). This way when
+ inbound messages arrive to this address, the rpmsg core
+ dispatches them to the listening entity (a kernel driver).
+
+ This sysfs entry contains the src (local) rpmsg address
+ of this channel. If it contains 0xffffffff, then an address
+ wasn't assigned (can happen if no driver exists for this
+ channel).
+
+What: /sys/bus/rpmsg/devices/.../dst
+Date: June 2011
+KernelVersion: 3.3
+Contact: Ohad Ben-Cohen <ohad@wizery.com>
+Description:
+ Every rpmsg device is a communication channel with a remote
+ processor. Channels have a local ("source") rpmsg address,
+ and remote ("destination") rpmsg address. When an entity
+ starts listening on one end of a channel, it assigns it with
+ a unique rpmsg address (a 32 bits integer). This way when
+ inbound messages arrive to this address, the rpmsg core
+ dispatches them to the listening entity.
+
+ This sysfs entry contains the dst (remote) rpmsg address
+ of this channel. If it contains 0xffffffff, then an address
+ wasn't assigned (can happen if the kernel driver that
+ is attached to this channel is exposing a service to the
+ remote processor. This make it a local rpmsg server,
+ and it is listening for inbound messages that may be sent
+ from any remote rpmsg client; it is not bound to a single
+ remote entity).
+
+What: /sys/bus/rpmsg/devices/.../announce
+Date: June 2011
+KernelVersion: 3.3
+Contact: Ohad Ben-Cohen <ohad@wizery.com>
+Description:
+ Every rpmsg device is a communication channel with a remote
+ processor. Channels are identified by a textual name (see
+ /sys/bus/rpmsg/devices/.../name above) and have a local
+ ("source") rpmsg address, and remote ("destination") rpmsg
+ address.
+
+ A channel is first created when an entity, whether local
+ or remote, starts listening on it for messages (and is thus
+ called an rpmsg server).
+
+ When that happens, a "name service" announcement is sent
+ to the other processor, in order to let it know about the
+ creation of the channel (this way remote clients know they
+ can start sending messages).
+
+ This sysfs entry tells us whether the channel is a local
+ server channel that is announced (values are either
+ true or false).
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-usb b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-usb
index b4f548792e3..7c22a532fdf 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-usb
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-usb
@@ -182,3 +182,14 @@ Description:
USB2 hardware LPM is enabled for the device. Developer can
write y/Y/1 or n/N/0 to the file to enable/disable the
feature.
+
+What: /sys/bus/usb/devices/.../removable
+Date: February 2012
+Contact: Matthew Garrett <mjg@redhat.com>
+Description:
+ Some information about whether a given USB device is
+ physically fixed to the platform can be inferred from a
+ combination of hub decriptor bits and platform-specific data
+ such as ACPI. This file will read either "removable" or
+ "fixed" if the information is available, and "unknown"
+ otherwise. \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class
index 4b0cb891e46..676530fcf74 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
What: /sys/class/
Date: Febuary 2006
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
The /sys/class directory will consist of a group of
subdirectories describing individual classes of devices
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-net-mesh b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-net-mesh
index b02001488ee..b218e0f8bdb 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-net-mesh
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-net-mesh
@@ -65,6 +65,13 @@ Description:
Defines the penalty which will be applied to an
originator message's tq-field on every hop.
+What: /sys/class/net/<mesh_iface>/mesh/routing_algo
+Date: Dec 2011
+Contact: Marek Lindner <lindner_marek@yahoo.de>
+Description:
+ Defines the routing procotol this mesh instance
+ uses to find the optimal paths through the mesh.
+
What: /sys/class/net/<mesh_iface>/mesh/vis_mode
Date: May 2010
Contact: Marek Lindner <lindner_marek@yahoo.de>
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices
index 6a25671ee5f..5fcc94358b8 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
What: /sys/devices
Date: February 2006
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description:
The /sys/devices tree contains a snapshot of the
internal state of the kernel device tree. Devices will
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-power b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-power
index 8ffbc25376a..840f7d64d48 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-power
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-power
@@ -165,3 +165,21 @@ Description:
Not all drivers support this attribute. If it isn't supported,
attempts to read or write it will yield I/O errors.
+
+What: /sys/devices/.../power/pm_qos_latency_us
+Date: March 2012
+Contact: Rafael J. Wysocki <rjw@sisk.pl>
+Description:
+ The /sys/devices/.../power/pm_qos_resume_latency_us attribute
+ contains the PM QoS resume latency limit for the given device,
+ which is the maximum allowed time it can take to resume the
+ device, after it has been suspended at run time, from a resume
+ request to the moment the device will be ready to process I/O,
+ in microseconds. If it is equal to 0, however, this means that
+ the PM QoS resume latency may be arbitrary.
+
+ Not all drivers support this attribute. If it isn't supported,
+ it is not present.
+
+ This attribute has no effect on system-wide suspend/resume and
+ hibernation.
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-soc b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-soc
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..6d9cc253f2b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-soc
@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
+What: /sys/devices/socX
+Date: January 2012
+contact: Lee Jones <lee.jones@linaro.org>
+Description:
+ The /sys/devices/ directory contains a sub-directory for each
+ System-on-Chip (SoC) device on a running platform. Information
+ regarding each SoC can be obtained by reading sysfs files. This
+ functionality is only available if implemented by the platform.
+
+ The directory created for each SoC will also house information
+ about devices which are commonly contained in /sys/devices/platform.
+ It has been agreed that if an SoC device exists, its supported
+ devices would be better suited to appear as children of that SoC.
+
+What: /sys/devices/socX/machine
+Date: January 2012
+contact: Lee Jones <lee.jones@linaro.org>
+Description:
+ Read-only attribute common to all SoCs. Contains the SoC machine
+ name (e.g. Ux500).
+
+What: /sys/devices/socX/family
+Date: January 2012
+contact: Lee Jones <lee.jones@linaro.org>
+Description:
+ Read-only attribute common to all SoCs. Contains SoC family name
+ (e.g. DB8500).
+
+What: /sys/devices/socX/soc_id
+Date: January 2012
+contact: Lee Jones <lee.jones@linaro.org>
+Description:
+ Read-only attribute supported by most SoCs. In the case of
+ ST-Ericsson's chips this contains the SoC serial number.
+
+What: /sys/devices/socX/revision
+Date: January 2012
+contact: Lee Jones <lee.jones@linaro.org>
+Description:
+ Read-only attribute supported by most SoCs. Contains the SoC's
+ manufacturing revision number.
+
+What: /sys/devices/socX/process
+Date: January 2012
+contact: Lee Jones <lee.jones@linaro.org>
+Description:
+ Read-only attribute supported ST-Ericsson's silicon. Contains the
+ the process by which the silicon chip was manufactured.
+
+What: /sys/bus/soc
+Date: January 2012
+contact: Lee Jones <lee.jones@linaro.org>
+Description:
+ The /sys/bus/soc/ directory contains the usual sub-folders
+ expected under most buses. /sys/bus/soc/devices is of particular
+ interest, as it contains a symlink for each SoC device found on
+ the system. Each symlink points back into the aforementioned
+ /sys/devices/socX devices.
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-driver-samsung-laptop b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-driver-samsung-laptop
index 0a810231aad..e82e7c2b8f8 100644
--- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-driver-samsung-laptop
+++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-driver-samsung-laptop
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
What: /sys/devices/platform/samsung/performance_level
Date: January 1, 2010
KernelVersion: 2.6.33
-Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Description: Some Samsung laptops have different "performance levels"
that are can be modified by a function key, and by this
sysfs file. These values don't always make a whole lot
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-mm-cleancache b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-mm-cleancache
deleted file mode 100644
index 662ae646ea1..00000000000
--- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-mm-cleancache
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,11 +0,0 @@
-What: /sys/kernel/mm/cleancache/
-Date: April 2011
-Contact: Dan Magenheimer <dan.magenheimer@oracle.com>
-Description:
- /sys/kernel/mm/cleancache/ contains a number of files which
- record a count of various cleancache operations
- (sum across all filesystems):
- succ_gets
- failed_gets
- puts
- flushes
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/80211.tmpl b/Documentation/DocBook/80211.tmpl
index 2014155c899..c5ac6929c41 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/80211.tmpl
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/80211.tmpl
@@ -129,7 +129,6 @@
!Finclude/net/cfg80211.h cfg80211_pmksa
!Finclude/net/cfg80211.h cfg80211_send_rx_auth
!Finclude/net/cfg80211.h cfg80211_send_auth_timeout
-!Finclude/net/cfg80211.h __cfg80211_auth_canceled
!Finclude/net/cfg80211.h cfg80211_send_rx_assoc
!Finclude/net/cfg80211.h cfg80211_send_assoc_timeout
!Finclude/net/cfg80211.h cfg80211_send_deauth
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/filesystems.tmpl b/Documentation/DocBook/filesystems.tmpl
index f51f28531b8..3fca32c4192 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/filesystems.tmpl
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/filesystems.tmpl
@@ -387,7 +387,7 @@ an example.
<title>See also</title>
<para>
<citation>
- <ulink url="ftp://ftp.uk.linux.org/pub/linux/sct/fs/jfs/journal-design.ps.gz">
+ <ulink url="http://kernel.org/pub/linux/kernel/people/sct/ext3/journal-design.ps.gz">
Journaling the Linux ext2fs Filesystem, LinuxExpo 98, Stephen Tweedie
</ulink>
</citation>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/kgdb.tmpl b/Documentation/DocBook/kgdb.tmpl
index d71b57fcf11..4ee4ba3509f 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/kgdb.tmpl
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/kgdb.tmpl
@@ -362,6 +362,23 @@
</para>
</para>
</sect1>
+ <sect1 id="kgdbreboot">
+ <title>Run time parameter: kgdbreboot</title>
+ <para> The kgdbreboot feature allows you to change how the debugger
+ deals with the reboot notification. You have 3 choices for the
+ behavior. The default behavior is always set to 0.</para>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem><para>echo -1 > /sys/module/debug_core/parameters/kgdbreboot</para>
+ <para>Ignore the reboot notification entirely.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem><para>echo 0 > /sys/module/debug_core/parameters/kgdbreboot</para>
+ <para>Send the detach message to any attached debugger client.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem><para>echo 1 > /sys/module/debug_core/parameters/kgdbreboot</para>
+ <para>Enter the debugger on reboot notify.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </sect1>
</chapter>
<chapter id="usingKDB">
<title>Using kdb</title>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl b/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl
index cdd1bb9aac0..31df1aa0071 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl
@@ -22,8 +22,8 @@
<para>
The contents of this file are subject to the Open
Software License version 1.1 that can be found at
- <ulink url="http://www.opensource.org/licenses/osl-1.1.txt">http://www.opensource.org/licenses/osl-1.1.txt</ulink> and is included herein
- by reference.
+ <ulink url="http://fedoraproject.org/wiki/Licensing:OSL1.1">http://fedoraproject.org/wiki/Licensing:OSL1.1</ulink>
+ and is included herein by reference.
</para>
<para>
@@ -945,7 +945,7 @@ and other resources, etc.
<listitem>
<para>
- !BSY &amp;&amp; ERR after CDB tranfer starts but before the
+ !BSY &amp;&amp; ERR after CDB transfer starts but before the
last byte of CDB is transferred. ATA/ATAPI standard states
that &quot;The device shall not terminate the PACKET command
with an error before the last byte of the command packet has
@@ -1050,7 +1050,7 @@ and other resources, etc.
to complete a command. Combined with the fact that MWDMA
and PIO transfer errors aren't allowed to use ICRC bit up to
ATA/ATAPI-7, it seems to imply that ABRT bit alone could
- indicate tranfer errors.
+ indicate transfer errors.
</para>
<para>
However, ATA/ATAPI-8 draft revision 1f removes the part
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/biblio.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/biblio.xml
index cea6fd3ed42..7dc65c592a8 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/biblio.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/biblio.xml
@@ -128,6 +128,26 @@ url="http://www.ijg.org">http://www.ijg.org</ulink>)</corpauthor>
<subtitle>Version 1.02</subtitle>
</biblioentry>
+ <biblioentry id="itu-t81">
+ <abbrev>ITU-T.81</abbrev>
+ <authorgroup>
+ <corpauthor>International Telecommunication Union
+(<ulink url="http://www.itu.int">http://www.itu.int</ulink>)</corpauthor>
+ </authorgroup>
+ <title>ITU-T Recommendation T.81
+"Information Technology &mdash; Digital Compression and Coding of Continous-Tone
+Still Images &mdash; Requirements and Guidelines"</title>
+ </biblioentry>
+
+ <biblioentry id="w3c-jpeg-jfif">
+ <abbrev>W3C JPEG JFIF</abbrev>
+ <authorgroup>
+ <corpauthor>The World Wide Web Consortium (<ulink
+url="http://www.w3.org/Graphics/JPEG">http://www.w3.org</ulink>)</corpauthor>
+ </authorgroup>
+ <title>JPEG JFIF</title>
+ </biblioentry>
+
<biblioentry id="smpte12m">
<abbrev>SMPTE&nbsp;12M</abbrev>
<authorgroup>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/compat.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/compat.xml
index c736380b464..bce97c50391 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/compat.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/compat.xml
@@ -444,7 +444,7 @@ linkend="pixfmt-rgb"><constant>V4L2_PIX_FMT_BGR24</constant></link></para></entr
<entry><para><link
linkend="pixfmt-rgb"><constant>V4L2_PIX_FMT_BGR32</constant></link><footnote>
<para>Presumably all V4L RGB formats are
-little-endian, although some drivers might interpret them according to machine endianess. V4L2 defines little-endian, big-endian and red/blue
+little-endian, although some drivers might interpret them according to machine endianness. V4L2 defines little-endian, big-endian and red/blue
swapped variants. For details see <xref linkend="pixfmt-rgb" />.</para>
</footnote></para></entry>
</row>
@@ -823,7 +823,7 @@ standard); 35468950&nbsp;Hz PAL and SECAM (625-line standards)</entry>
<row>
<entry>sample_format</entry>
<entry>V4L2_PIX_FMT_GREY. The last four bytes (a
-machine endianess integer) contain a frame counter.</entry>
+machine endianness integer) contain a frame counter.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry>start[]</entry>
@@ -2393,6 +2393,20 @@ details.</para>
to the <link linkend="control">User controls class</link>.
</para>
</listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Added the device_caps field to struct v4l2_capabilities and added the new
+ V4L2_CAP_DEVICE_CAPS capability.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>V4L2 in Linux 3.4</title>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Added <link linkend="jpeg-controls">JPEG compression control
+ class</link>.</para>
+ </listitem>
</orderedlist>
</section>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/controls.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/controls.xml
index a1be37897ad..b84f25e9cc8 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/controls.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/controls.xml
@@ -1286,6 +1286,49 @@ produce a slight hiss, but in the encoder itself, guaranteeing a fixed
and reproducible audio bitstream. 0 = unmuted, 1 = muted.</entry>
</row>
<row><entry></entry></row>
+ <row id="v4l2-mpeg-audio-dec-playback">
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_PLAYBACK</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>enum&nbsp;v4l2_mpeg_audio_dec_playback</entry>
+ </row><row><entry spanname="descr">Determines how monolingual audio should be played back.
+Possible values are:</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entrytbl spanname="descr" cols="2">
+ <tbody valign="top">
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_PLAYBACK_AUTO</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>Automatically determines the best playback mode.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_PLAYBACK_STEREO</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>Stereo playback.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_PLAYBACK_LEFT</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>Left channel playback.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_PLAYBACK_RIGHT</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>Right channel playback.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_PLAYBACK_MONO</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>Mono playback.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_PLAYBACK_SWAPPED_STEREO</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>Stereo playback with swapped left and right channels.</entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </entrytbl>
+ </row>
+ <row><entry></entry></row>
+ <row id="v4l2-mpeg-audio-dec-multilingual-playback">
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_MPEG_AUDIO_DEC_MULTILINGUAL_PLAYBACK</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>enum&nbsp;v4l2_mpeg_audio_dec_playback</entry>
+ </row><row><entry spanname="descr">Determines how multilingual audio should be played back.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row><entry></entry></row>
<row id="v4l2-mpeg-video-encoding">
<entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_ENCODING</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
<entry>enum&nbsp;v4l2_mpeg_video_encoding</entry>
@@ -1447,6 +1490,22 @@ of the video. The supplied 32-bit integer is interpreted as follows (bit
</tbody>
</entrytbl>
</row>
+ <row><entry></entry></row>
+ <row id="v4l2-mpeg-video-dec-pts">
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_DEC_PTS</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>integer64</entry>
+ </row><row><entry spanname="descr">This read-only control returns the
+33-bit video Presentation Time Stamp as defined in ITU T-REC-H.222.0 and ISO/IEC 13818-1 of
+the currently displayed frame. This is the same PTS as is used in &VIDIOC-DECODER-CMD;.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row><entry></entry></row>
+ <row id="v4l2-mpeg-video-dec-frame">
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_DEC_FRAME</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>integer64</entry>
+ </row><row><entry spanname="descr">This read-only control returns the
+frame counter of the frame that is currently displayed (decoded). This value is reset to 0 whenever
+the decoder is started.</entry>
+ </row>
<row><entry></entry></row>
@@ -3377,6 +3436,167 @@ interface and may change in the future.</para>
</tbody>
</tgroup>
</table>
+ </section>
+
+ <section id="jpeg-controls">
+ <title>JPEG Control Reference</title>
+ <para>The JPEG class includes controls for common features of JPEG
+ encoders and decoders. Currently it includes features for codecs
+ implementing progressive baseline DCT compression process with
+ Huffman entrophy coding.</para>
+ <table pgwide="1" frame="none" id="jpeg-control-id">
+ <title>JPEG Control IDs</title>
+ <tgroup cols="4">
+ <colspec colname="c1" colwidth="1*" />
+ <colspec colname="c2" colwidth="6*" />
+ <colspec colname="c3" colwidth="2*" />
+ <colspec colname="c4" colwidth="6*" />
+ <spanspec namest="c1" nameend="c2" spanname="id" />
+ <spanspec namest="c2" nameend="c4" spanname="descr" />
+ <thead>
+ <row>
+ <entry spanname="id" align="left">ID</entry>
+ <entry align="left">Type</entry>
+ </row><row rowsep="1"><entry spanname="descr" align="left">Description</entry>
+ </row>
+ </thead>
+ <tbody valign="top">
+ <row><entry></entry></row>
+ <row>
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_JPEG_CLASS</constant>&nbsp;</entry>
+ <entry>class</entry>
+ </row><row><entry spanname="descr">The JPEG class descriptor. Calling
+ &VIDIOC-QUERYCTRL; for this control will return a description of this
+ control class.
+
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING</constant></entry>
+ <entry>menu</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row id="jpeg-chroma-subsampling-control">
+ <entry spanname="descr">The chroma subsampling factors describe how
+ each component of an input image is sampled, in respect to maximum
+ sample rate in each spatial dimension. See <xref linkend="itu-t81"/>,
+ clause A.1.1. for more details. The <constant>
+ V4L2_CID_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING</constant> control determines how
+ Cb and Cr components are downsampled after coverting an input image
+ from RGB to Y'CbCr color space.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entrytbl spanname="descr" cols="2">
+ <tbody valign="top">
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING_444</constant>
+ </entry><entry>No chroma subsampling, each pixel has
+ Y, Cr and Cb values.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING_422</constant>
+ </entry><entry>Horizontally subsample Cr, Cb components
+ by a factor of 2.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING_420</constant>
+ </entry><entry>Subsample Cr, Cb components horizontally
+ and vertically by 2.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING_411</constant>
+ </entry><entry>Horizontally subsample Cr, Cb components
+ by a factor of 4.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING_410</constant>
+ </entry><entry>Subsample Cr, Cb components horizontally
+ by 4 and vertically by 2.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_CHROMA_SUBSAMPLING_GRAY</constant>
+ </entry><entry>Use only luminance component.</entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </entrytbl>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_JPEG_RESTART_INTERVAL</constant>
+ </entry><entry>integer</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row><entry spanname="descr">
+ The restart interval determines an interval of inserting RSTm
+ markers (m = 0..7). The purpose of these markers is to additionally
+ reinitialize the encoder process, in order to process blocks of
+ an image independently.
+ For the lossy compression processes the restart interval unit is
+ MCU (Minimum Coded Unit) and its value is contained in DRI
+ (Define Restart Interval) marker. If <constant>
+ V4L2_CID_JPEG_RESTART_INTERVAL</constant> control is set to 0,
+ DRI and RSTm markers will not be inserted.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row id="jpeg-quality-control">
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_JPEG_COMPRESION_QUALITY</constant></entry>
+ <entry>integer</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry spanname="descr">
+ <constant>V4L2_CID_JPEG_COMPRESION_QUALITY</constant> control
+ determines trade-off between image quality and size.
+ It provides simpler method for applications to control image quality,
+ without a need for direct reconfiguration of luminance and chrominance
+ quantization tables.
+
+ In cases where a driver uses quantization tables configured directly
+ by an application, using interfaces defined elsewhere, <constant>
+ V4L2_CID_JPEG_COMPRESION_QUALITY</constant> control should be set
+ by driver to 0.
+
+ <para>The value range of this control is driver-specific. Only
+ positive, non-zero values are meaningful. The recommended range
+ is 1 - 100, where larger values correspond to better image quality.
+ </para>
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row id="jpeg-active-marker-control">
+ <entry spanname="id"><constant>V4L2_CID_JPEG_ACTIVE_MARKER</constant></entry>
+ <entry>bitmask</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry spanname="descr">Specify which JPEG markers are included
+ in compressed stream. This control is valid only for encoders.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entrytbl spanname="descr" cols="2">
+ <tbody valign="top">
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_ACTIVE_MARKER_APP0</constant></entry>
+ <entry>Application data segment APP<subscript>0</subscript>.</entry>
+ </row><row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_ACTIVE_MARKER_APP1</constant></entry>
+ <entry>Application data segment APP<subscript>1</subscript>.</entry>
+ </row><row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_ACTIVE_MARKER_COM</constant></entry>
+ <entry>Comment segment.</entry>
+ </row><row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_ACTIVE_MARKER_DQT</constant></entry>
+ <entry>Quantization tables segment.</entry>
+ </row><row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_JPEG_ACTIVE_MARKER_DHT</constant></entry>
+ <entry>Huffman tables segment.</entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </entrytbl>
+ </row>
+ <row><entry></entry></row>
+ </tbody>
+ </tgroup>
+ </table>
+ <para>For more details about JPEG specification, refer
+ to <xref linkend="itu-t81"/>, <xref linkend="jfif"/>,
+ <xref linkend="w3c-jpeg-jfif"/>.</para>
</section>
</section>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/selection-api.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/selection-api.xml
index 2f0bdb4d555..b299e477935 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/selection-api.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/selection-api.xml
@@ -52,6 +52,10 @@ cropping and composing rectangles have the same size.</para>
</textobject>
</mediaobject>
</figure>
+
+For complete list of the available selection targets see table <xref
+linkend="v4l2-sel-target"/>
+
</section>
<section>
@@ -186,7 +190,7 @@ V4L2_SEL_TGT_COMPOSE_ACTIVE </constant> target.</para>
<section>
- <title>Scaling control.</title>
+ <title>Scaling control</title>
<para>An application can detect if scaling is performed by comparing the width
and the height of rectangles obtained using <constant> V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_ACTIVE
@@ -200,7 +204,7 @@ the scaling ratios using these values.</para>
<section>
- <title>Comparison with old cropping API.</title>
+ <title>Comparison with old cropping API</title>
<para>The selection API was introduced to cope with deficiencies of previous
<link linkend="crop"> API </link>, that was designed to control simple capture
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/v4l2.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/v4l2.xml
index e97c512861b..8ae38876172 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/v4l2.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/v4l2.xml
@@ -128,6 +128,22 @@ structs, ioctls) must be noted in more detail in the history chapter
applications. -->
<revision>
+ <revnumber>3.4</revnumber>
+ <date>2012-01-25</date>
+ <authorinitials>sn</authorinitials>
+ <revremark>Added <link linkend="jpeg-controls">JPEG compression
+ control class.</link>
+ </revremark>
+ </revision>
+
+ <revision>
+ <revnumber>3.3</revnumber>
+ <date>2012-01-11</date>
+ <authorinitials>hv</authorinitials>
+ <revremark>Added device_caps field to struct v4l2_capabilities.</revremark>
+ </revision>
+
+ <revision>
<revnumber>3.2</revnumber>
<date>2011-08-26</date>
<authorinitials>hv</authorinitials>
@@ -417,7 +433,7 @@ and discussions on the V4L mailing list.</revremark>
</partinfo>
<title>Video for Linux Two API Specification</title>
- <subtitle>Revision 3.2</subtitle>
+ <subtitle>Revision 3.3</subtitle>
<chapter id="common">
&sub-common;
@@ -473,6 +489,7 @@ and discussions on the V4L mailing list.</revremark>
&sub-cropcap;
&sub-dbg-g-chip-ident;
&sub-dbg-g-register;
+ &sub-decoder-cmd;
&sub-dqevent;
&sub-encoder-cmd;
&sub-enumaudio;
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-decoder-cmd.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-decoder-cmd.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..74b87f6e480
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-decoder-cmd.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,256 @@
+<refentry id="vidioc-decoder-cmd">
+ <refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ioctl VIDIOC_DECODER_CMD, VIDIOC_TRY_DECODER_CMD</refentrytitle>
+ &manvol;
+ </refmeta>
+
+ <refnamediv>
+ <refname>VIDIOC_DECODER_CMD</refname>
+ <refname>VIDIOC_TRY_DECODER_CMD</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Execute an decoder command</refpurpose>
+ </refnamediv>
+
+ <refsynopsisdiv>
+ <funcsynopsis>
+ <funcprototype>
+ <funcdef>int <function>ioctl</function></funcdef>
+ <paramdef>int <parameter>fd</parameter></paramdef>
+ <paramdef>int <parameter>request</parameter></paramdef>
+ <paramdef>struct v4l2_decoder_cmd *<parameter>argp</parameter></paramdef>
+ </funcprototype>
+ </funcsynopsis>
+ </refsynopsisdiv>
+
+ <refsect1>
+ <title>Arguments</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><parameter>fd</parameter></term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>&fd;</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><parameter>request</parameter></term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>VIDIOC_DECODER_CMD, VIDIOC_TRY_DECODER_CMD</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><parameter>argp</parameter></term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </refsect1>
+
+ <refsect1>
+ <title>Description</title>
+
+ <note>
+ <title>Experimental</title>
+
+ <para>This is an <link linkend="experimental">experimental</link>
+interface and may change in the future.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>These ioctls control an audio/video (usually MPEG-) decoder.
+<constant>VIDIOC_DECODER_CMD</constant> sends a command to the
+decoder, <constant>VIDIOC_TRY_DECODER_CMD</constant> can be used to
+try a command without actually executing it. To send a command applications
+must initialize all fields of a &v4l2-decoder-cmd; and call
+<constant>VIDIOC_DECODER_CMD</constant> or <constant>VIDIOC_TRY_DECODER_CMD</constant>
+with a pointer to this structure.</para>
+
+ <para>The <structfield>cmd</structfield> field must contain the
+command code. Some commands use the <structfield>flags</structfield> field for
+additional information.
+</para>
+
+ <para>A <function>write</function>() or &VIDIOC-STREAMON; call sends an implicit
+START command to the decoder if it has not been started yet.
+</para>
+
+ <para>A <function>close</function>() or &VIDIOC-STREAMOFF; call of a streaming
+file descriptor sends an implicit immediate STOP command to the decoder, and all
+buffered data is discarded.</para>
+
+ <para>These ioctls are optional, not all drivers may support
+them. They were introduced in Linux 3.3.</para>
+
+ <table pgwide="1" frame="none" id="v4l2-decoder-cmd">
+ <title>struct <structname>v4l2_decoder_cmd</structname></title>
+ <tgroup cols="5">
+ &cs-str;
+ <tbody valign="top">
+ <row>
+ <entry>__u32</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>cmd</structfield></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>The decoder command, see <xref linkend="decoder-cmds" />.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry>__u32</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>flags</structfield></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>Flags to go with the command. If no flags are defined for
+this command, drivers and applications must set this field to zero.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry>union</entry>
+ <entry>(anonymous)</entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>struct</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>start</structfield></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>Structure containing additional data for the
+<constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_START</constant> command.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>__s32</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>speed</structfield></entry>
+ <entry>Playback speed and direction. The playback speed is defined as
+<structfield>speed</structfield>/1000 of the normal speed. So 1000 is normal playback.
+Negative numbers denote reverse playback, so -1000 does reverse playback at normal
+speed. Speeds -1, 0 and 1 have special meanings: speed 0 is shorthand for 1000
+(normal playback). A speed of 1 steps just one frame forward, a speed of -1 steps
+just one frame back.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>__u32</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>format</structfield></entry>
+ <entry>Format restrictions. This field is set by the driver, not the
+application. Possible values are <constant>V4L2_DEC_START_FMT_NONE</constant> if
+there are no format restrictions or <constant>V4L2_DEC_START_FMT_GOP</constant>
+if the decoder operates on full GOPs (<wordasword>Group Of Pictures</wordasword>).
+This is usually the case for reverse playback: the decoder needs full GOPs, which
+it can then play in reverse order. So to implement reverse playback the application
+must feed the decoder the last GOP in the video file, then the GOP before that, etc. etc.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>struct</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>stop</structfield></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>Structure containing additional data for the
+<constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_STOP</constant> command.</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>__u64</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>pts</structfield></entry>
+ <entry>Stop playback at this <structfield>pts</structfield> or immediately
+if the playback is already past that timestamp. Leave to 0 if you want to stop after the
+last frame was decoded.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>struct</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>raw</structfield></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry></entry>
+ <entry>__u32</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>data</structfield>[16]</entry>
+ <entry>Reserved for future extensions. Drivers and
+applications must set the array to zero.</entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </tgroup>
+ </table>
+
+ <table pgwide="1" frame="none" id="decoder-cmds">
+ <title>Decoder Commands</title>
+ <tgroup cols="3">
+ &cs-def;
+ <tbody valign="top">
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_START</constant></entry>
+ <entry>0</entry>
+ <entry>Start the decoder. When the decoder is already
+running or paused, this command will just change the playback speed.
+That means that calling <constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_START</constant> when
+the decoder was paused will <emphasis>not</emphasis> resume the decoder.
+You have to explicitly call <constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_RESUME</constant> for that.
+This command has one flag:
+<constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_START_MUTE_AUDIO</constant>. If set, then audio will
+be muted when playing back at a non-standard speed.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_STOP</constant></entry>
+ <entry>1</entry>
+ <entry>Stop the decoder. When the decoder is already stopped,
+this command does nothing. This command has two flags:
+if <constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_STOP_TO_BLACK</constant> is set, then the decoder will
+set the picture to black after it stopped decoding. Otherwise the last image will
+repeat. If <constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_STOP_IMMEDIATELY</constant> is set, then the decoder
+stops immediately (ignoring the <structfield>pts</structfield> value), otherwise it
+will keep decoding until timestamp >= pts or until the last of the pending data from
+its internal buffers was decoded.
+</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_PAUSE</constant></entry>
+ <entry>2</entry>
+ <entry>Pause the decoder. When the decoder has not been
+started yet, the driver will return an &EPERM;. When the decoder is
+already paused, this command does nothing. This command has one flag:
+if <constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_PAUSE_TO_BLACK</constant> is set, then set the
+decoder output to black when paused.
+</entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_DEC_CMD_RESUME</constant></entry>
+ <entry>3</entry>
+ <entry>Resume decoding after a PAUSE command. When the
+decoder has not been started yet, the driver will return an &EPERM;.
+When the decoder is already running, this command does nothing. No
+flags are defined for this command.</entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </tgroup>
+ </table>
+
+ </refsect1>
+
+ <refsect1>
+ &return-value;
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><errorcode>EINVAL</errorcode></term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The <structfield>cmd</structfield> field is invalid.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><errorcode>EPERM</errorcode></term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The application sent a PAUSE or RESUME command when
+the decoder was not running.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </refsect1>
+</refentry>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-encoder-cmd.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-encoder-cmd.xml
index af7f3f2a36d..f431b3ba79b 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-encoder-cmd.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-encoder-cmd.xml
@@ -74,15 +74,16 @@ only used by the STOP command and contains one bit: If the
encoding will continue until the end of the current <wordasword>Group
Of Pictures</wordasword>, otherwise it will stop immediately.</para>
- <para>A <function>read</function>() call sends a START command to
-the encoder if it has not been started yet. After a STOP command,
+ <para>A <function>read</function>() or &VIDIOC-STREAMON; call sends an implicit
+START command to the encoder if it has not been started yet. After a STOP command,
<function>read</function>() calls will read the remaining data
buffered by the driver. When the buffer is empty,
<function>read</function>() will return zero and the next
<function>read</function>() call will restart the encoder.</para>
- <para>A <function>close</function>() call sends an immediate STOP
-to the encoder, and all buffered data is discarded.</para>
+ <para>A <function>close</function>() or &VIDIOC-STREAMOFF; call of a streaming
+file descriptor sends an implicit immediate STOP to the encoder, and all buffered
+data is discarded.</para>
<para>These ioctls are optional, not all drivers may support
them. They were introduced in Linux 2.6.21.</para>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-jpegcomp.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-jpegcomp.xml
index 01ea24b8438..48748499c09 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-jpegcomp.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-jpegcomp.xml
@@ -57,6 +57,11 @@
<refsect1>
<title>Description</title>
+ <para>These ioctls are <emphasis role="bold">deprecated</emphasis>.
+ New drivers and applications should use <link linkend="jpeg-controls">
+ JPEG class controls</link> for image quality and JPEG markers control.
+ </para>
+
<para>[to do]</para>
<para>Ronald Bultje elaborates:</para>
@@ -86,7 +91,10 @@ to add them.</para>
<row>
<entry>int</entry>
<entry><structfield>quality</structfield></entry>
- <entry></entry>
+ <entry>Deprecated. If <link linkend="jpeg-quality-control"><constant>
+ V4L2_CID_JPEG_IMAGE_QUALITY</constant></link> control is exposed by
+ a driver applications should use it instead and ignore this field.
+ </entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry>int</entry>
@@ -116,7 +124,11 @@ to add them.</para>
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
<entry><structfield>jpeg_markers</structfield></entry>
- <entry>See <xref linkend="jpeg-markers" />.</entry>
+ <entry>See <xref linkend="jpeg-markers"/>. Deprecated.
+ If <link linkend="jpeg-active-marker-control"><constant>
+ V4L2_CID_JPEG_ACTIVE_MARKER</constant></link> control
+ is exposed by a driver applications should use it instead
+ and ignore this field.</entry>
</row>
</tbody>
</tgroup>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-selection.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-selection.xml
index a9d36e0c090..bb04eff75f4 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-selection.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-g-selection.xml
@@ -58,43 +58,43 @@
<para>The ioctls are used to query and configure selection rectangles.</para>
-<para> To query the cropping (composing) rectangle set <structfield>
-&v4l2-selection;::type </structfield> to the respective buffer type. Do not
-use multiplanar buffers. Use <constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_CAPTURE
+<para> To query the cropping (composing) rectangle set &v4l2-selection;
+<structfield> type </structfield> field to the respective buffer type.
+Do not use multiplanar buffers. Use <constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_CAPTURE
</constant> instead of <constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_CAPTURE_MPLANE
</constant>. Use <constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_OUTPUT </constant> instead of
<constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_OUTPUT_MPLANE </constant>. The next step is
-setting <structfield> &v4l2-selection;::target </structfield> to value
-<constant> V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_ACTIVE </constant> (<constant>
+setting the value of &v4l2-selection; <structfield>target</structfield> field
+to <constant> V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_ACTIVE </constant> (<constant>
V4L2_SEL_TGT_COMPOSE_ACTIVE </constant>). Please refer to table <xref
linkend="v4l2-sel-target" /> or <xref linkend="selection-api" /> for additional
-targets. Fields <structfield> &v4l2-selection;::flags </structfield> and
-<structfield> &v4l2-selection;::reserved </structfield> are ignored and they
-must be filled with zeros. The driver fills the rest of the structure or
+targets. The <structfield>flags</structfield> and <structfield>reserved
+</structfield> fields of &v4l2-selection; are ignored and they must be filled
+with zeros. The driver fills the rest of the structure or
returns &EINVAL; if incorrect buffer type or target was used. If cropping
(composing) is not supported then the active rectangle is not mutable and it is
-always equal to the bounds rectangle. Finally, structure <structfield>
-&v4l2-selection;::r </structfield> is filled with the current cropping
+always equal to the bounds rectangle. Finally, the &v4l2-rect;
+<structfield>r</structfield> rectangle is filled with the current cropping
(composing) coordinates. The coordinates are expressed in driver-dependent
units. The only exception are rectangles for images in raw formats, whose
coordinates are always expressed in pixels. </para>
-<para> To change the cropping (composing) rectangle set <structfield>
-&v4l2-selection;::type </structfield> to the respective buffer type. Do not
+<para> To change the cropping (composing) rectangle set the &v4l2-selection;
+<structfield>type</structfield> field to the respective buffer type. Do not
use multiplanar buffers. Use <constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_CAPTURE
</constant> instead of <constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_CAPTURE_MPLANE
</constant>. Use <constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_OUTPUT </constant> instead of
<constant> V4L2_BUF_TYPE_VIDEO_OUTPUT_MPLANE </constant>. The next step is
-setting <structfield> &v4l2-selection;::target </structfield> to value
-<constant> V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_ACTIVE </constant> (<constant>
+setting the value of &v4l2-selection; <structfield>target</structfield> to
+<constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_ACTIVE</constant> (<constant>
V4L2_SEL_TGT_COMPOSE_ACTIVE </constant>). Please refer to table <xref
linkend="v4l2-sel-target" /> or <xref linkend="selection-api" /> for additional
-targets. Set desired active area into the field <structfield>
-&v4l2-selection;::r </structfield>. Field <structfield>
-&v4l2-selection;::reserved </structfield> is ignored and must be filled with
-zeros. The driver may adjust the rectangle coordinates. An application may
-introduce constraints to control rounding behaviour. Set the field
-<structfield> &v4l2-selection;::flags </structfield> to one of values:
+targets. The &v4l2-rect; <structfield>r</structfield> rectangle need to be
+set to the desired active area. Field &v4l2-selection; <structfield> reserved
+</structfield> is ignored and must be filled with zeros. The driver may adjust
+coordinates of the requested rectangle. An application may
+introduce constraints to control rounding behaviour. The &v4l2-selection;
+<structfield>flags</structfield> field must be set to one of the following:
<itemizedlist>
<listitem>
@@ -129,7 +129,7 @@ and vertical offset and sizes are chosen according to following priority:
<orderedlist>
<listitem>
- <para>Satisfy constraints from <structfield>&v4l2-selection;::flags</structfield>.</para>
+ <para>Satisfy constraints from &v4l2-selection; <structfield>flags</structfield>.</para>
</listitem>
<listitem>
<para>Adjust width, height, left, and top to hardware limits and alignments.</para>
@@ -145,7 +145,7 @@ and vertical offset and sizes are chosen according to following priority:
</listitem>
</orderedlist>
-On success the field <structfield> &v4l2-selection;::r </structfield> contains
+On success the &v4l2-rect; <structfield>r</structfield> field contains
the adjusted rectangle. When the parameters are unsuitable the application may
modify the cropping (composing) or image parameters and repeat the cycle until
satisfactory parameters have been negotiated. If constraints flags have to be
@@ -162,38 +162,38 @@ exist no rectangle </emphasis> that satisfies the constraints.</para>
<tbody valign="top">
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_ACTIVE</constant></entry>
- <entry>0</entry>
- <entry>area that is currently cropped by hardware</entry>
+ <entry>0x0000</entry>
+ <entry>The area that is currently cropped by hardware.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_DEFAULT</constant></entry>
- <entry>1</entry>
- <entry>suggested cropping rectangle that covers the "whole picture"</entry>
+ <entry>0x0001</entry>
+ <entry>Suggested cropping rectangle that covers the "whole picture".</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_CROP_BOUNDS</constant></entry>
- <entry>2</entry>
- <entry>limits for the cropping rectangle</entry>
+ <entry>0x0002</entry>
+ <entry>Limits for the cropping rectangle.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_COMPOSE_ACTIVE</constant></entry>
- <entry>256</entry>
- <entry>area to which data are composed by hardware</entry>
+ <entry>0x0100</entry>
+ <entry>The area to which data is composed by hardware.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_COMPOSE_DEFAULT</constant></entry>
- <entry>257</entry>
- <entry>suggested composing rectangle that covers the "whole picture"</entry>
+ <entry>0x0101</entry>
+ <entry>Suggested composing rectangle that covers the "whole picture".</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_COMPOSE_BOUNDS</constant></entry>
- <entry>258</entry>
- <entry>limits for the composing rectangle</entry>
+ <entry>0x0102</entry>
+ <entry>Limits for the composing rectangle.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_TGT_COMPOSE_PADDED</constant></entry>
- <entry>259</entry>
- <entry>the active area and all padding pixels that are inserted or modified by the hardware</entry>
+ <entry>0x0103</entry>
+ <entry>The active area and all padding pixels that are inserted or modified by hardware.</entry>
</row>
</tbody>
</tgroup>
@@ -209,12 +209,14 @@ exist no rectangle </emphasis> that satisfies the constraints.</para>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_FLAG_GE</constant></entry>
<entry>0x00000001</entry>
- <entry>indicate that adjusted rectangle must contain a rectangle from <structfield>&v4l2-selection;::r</structfield></entry>
+ <entry>Indicates that the adjusted rectangle must contain the original
+ &v4l2-selection; <structfield>r</structfield> rectangle.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry><constant>V4L2_SEL_FLAG_LE</constant></entry>
<entry>0x00000002</entry>
- <entry>indicate that adjusted rectangle must be inside a rectangle from <structfield>&v4l2-selection;::r</structfield></entry>
+ <entry>Indicates that the adjusted rectangle must be inside the original
+ &v4l2-rect; <structfield>r</structfield> rectangle.</entry>
</row>
</tbody>
</tgroup>
@@ -245,27 +247,29 @@ exist no rectangle </emphasis> that satisfies the constraints.</para>
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
<entry><structfield>type</structfield></entry>
- <entry>Type of the buffer (from &v4l2-buf-type;)</entry>
+ <entry>Type of the buffer (from &v4l2-buf-type;).</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
<entry><structfield>target</structfield></entry>
- <entry>used to select between <link linkend="v4l2-sel-target"> cropping and composing rectangles </link></entry>
+ <entry>Used to select between <link linkend="v4l2-sel-target"> cropping
+ and composing rectangles</link>.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
<entry><structfield>flags</structfield></entry>
- <entry>control over coordinates adjustments, refer to <link linkend="v4l2-sel-flags">selection flags</link></entry>
+ <entry>Flags controlling the selection rectangle adjustments, refer to
+ <link linkend="v4l2-sel-flags">selection flags</link>.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry>&v4l2-rect;</entry>
<entry><structfield>r</structfield></entry>
- <entry>selection rectangle</entry>
+ <entry>The selection rectangle.</entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
<entry><structfield>reserved[9]</structfield></entry>
- <entry>Reserved fields for future use</entry>
+ <entry>Reserved fields for future use.</entry>
</row>
</tbody>
</tgroup>
@@ -278,24 +282,24 @@ exist no rectangle </emphasis> that satisfies the constraints.</para>
<varlistentry>
<term><errorcode>EINVAL</errorcode></term>
<listitem>
- <para>The buffer <structfield> &v4l2-selection;::type </structfield>
-or <structfield> &v4l2-selection;::target </structfield> is not supported, or
-the <structfield> &v4l2-selection;::flags </structfield> are invalid.</para>
+ <para>Given buffer type <structfield>type</structfield> or
+the selection target <structfield>target</structfield> is not supported,
+or the <structfield>flags</structfield> argument is not valid.</para>
</listitem>
</varlistentry>
<varlistentry>
<term><errorcode>ERANGE</errorcode></term>
<listitem>
- <para>it is not possible to adjust a rectangle <structfield>
-&v4l2-selection;::r </structfield> that satisfies all contraints from
-<structfield> &v4l2-selection;::flags </structfield>.</para>
+ <para>It is not possible to adjust &v4l2-rect; <structfield>
+r</structfield> rectangle to satisfy all contraints given in the
+<structfield>flags</structfield> argument.</para>
</listitem>
</varlistentry>
<varlistentry>
<term><errorcode>EBUSY</errorcode></term>
<listitem>
- <para>it is not possible to apply change of selection rectangle at the moment.
-Usually because streaming is in progress.</para>
+ <para>It is not possible to apply change of the selection rectangle
+at the moment. Usually because streaming is in progress.</para>
</listitem>
</varlistentry>
</variablelist>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-querycap.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-querycap.xml
index e3664d6f2de..4643505cd4c 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-querycap.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-querycap.xml
@@ -124,12 +124,35 @@ printf ("Version: %u.%u.%u\n",
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
<entry><structfield>capabilities</structfield></entry>
- <entry>Device capabilities, see <xref
- linkend="device-capabilities" />.</entry>
+ <entry>Available capabilities of the physical device as a whole, see <xref
+ linkend="device-capabilities" />. The same physical device can export
+ multiple devices in /dev (e.g. /dev/videoX, /dev/vbiY and /dev/radioZ).
+ The <structfield>capabilities</structfield> field should contain a union
+ of all capabilities available around the several V4L2 devices exported
+ to userspace.
+ For all those devices the <structfield>capabilities</structfield> field
+ returns the same set of capabilities. This allows applications to open
+ just one of the devices (typically the video device) and discover whether
+ video, vbi and/or radio are also supported.
+ </entry>
</row>
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
- <entry><structfield>reserved</structfield>[4]</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>device_caps</structfield></entry>
+ <entry>Device capabilities of the opened device, see <xref
+ linkend="device-capabilities" />. Should contain the available capabilities
+ of that specific device node. So, for example, <structfield>device_caps</structfield>
+ of a radio device will only contain radio related capabilities and
+ no video or vbi capabilities. This field is only set if the <structfield>capabilities</structfield>
+ field contains the <constant>V4L2_CAP_DEVICE_CAPS</constant> capability.
+ Only the <structfield>capabilities</structfield> field can have the
+ <constant>V4L2_CAP_DEVICE_CAPS</constant> capability, <structfield>device_caps</structfield>
+ will never set <constant>V4L2_CAP_DEVICE_CAPS</constant>.
+ </entry>
+ </row>
+ <row>
+ <entry>__u32</entry>
+ <entry><structfield>reserved</structfield>[3]</entry>
<entry>Reserved for future extensions. Drivers must set
this array to zero.</entry>
</row>
@@ -276,6 +299,13 @@ linkend="async">asynchronous</link> I/O methods.</entry>
<entry>The device supports the <link
linkend="mmap">streaming</link> I/O method.</entry>
</row>
+ <row>
+ <entry><constant>V4L2_CAP_DEVICE_CAPS</constant></entry>
+ <entry>0x80000000</entry>
+ <entry>The driver fills the <structfield>device_caps</structfield>
+ field. This capability can only appear in the <structfield>capabilities</structfield>
+ field and never in the <structfield>device_caps</structfield> field.</entry>
+ </row>
</tbody>
</tgroup>
</table>
diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-s-hw-freq-seek.xml b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-s-hw-freq-seek.xml
index e013da845b1..18b1a8266f7 100644
--- a/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-s-hw-freq-seek.xml
+++ b/Documentation/DocBook/media/v4l/vidioc-s-hw-freq-seek.xml
@@ -96,8 +96,8 @@ field and the &v4l2-tuner; <structfield>index</structfield> field.</entry>
<row>
<entry>__u32</entry>
<entry><structfield>reserved</structfield>[7]</entry>
- <entry>Reserved for future extensions. Drivers and
- applications must set the array to zero.</entry>
+ <entry>Reserved for future extensions. Applications
+ must set the array to zero.</entry>
</row>
</tbody>
</tgroup>
@@ -112,7 +112,7 @@ field and the &v4l2-tuner; <structfield>index</structfield> field.</entry>
<term><errorcode>EINVAL</errorcode></term>
<listitem>
<para>The <structfield>tuner</structfield> index is out of
-bounds or the value in the <structfield>type</structfield> field is
+bounds, the wrap_around value is not supported or the value in the <structfield>type</structfield> field is
wrong.</para>
</listitem>
</varlistentry>
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/1024x768.S b/Documentation/EDID/1024x768.S
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..4b486fe31b3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/1024x768.S
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+/*
+ 1024x768.S: EDID data set for standard 1024x768 60 Hz monitor
+
+ Copyright (C) 2011 Carsten Emde <C.Emde@osadl.org>
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2
+ of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA.
+*/
+
+/* EDID */
+#define VERSION 1
+#define REVISION 3
+
+/* Display */
+#define CLOCK 65000 /* kHz */
+#define XPIX 1024
+#define YPIX 768
+#define XY_RATIO XY_RATIO_4_3
+#define XBLANK 320
+#define YBLANK 38
+#define XOFFSET 8
+#define XPULSE 144
+#define YOFFSET (63+3)
+#define YPULSE (63+6)
+#define DPI 72
+#define VFREQ 60 /* Hz */
+#define TIMING_NAME "Linux XGA"
+#define ESTABLISHED_TIMINGS_BITS 0x08 /* Bit 3 -> 1024x768 @60 Hz */
+#define HSYNC_POL 0
+#define VSYNC_POL 0
+#define CRC 0x55
+
+#include "edid.S"
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/1280x1024.S b/Documentation/EDID/1280x1024.S
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..a2799fe33a4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/1280x1024.S
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+/*
+ 1280x1024.S: EDID data set for standard 1280x1024 60 Hz monitor
+
+ Copyright (C) 2011 Carsten Emde <C.Emde@osadl.org>
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2
+ of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA.
+*/
+
+/* EDID */
+#define VERSION 1
+#define REVISION 3
+
+/* Display */
+#define CLOCK 108000 /* kHz */
+#define XPIX 1280
+#define YPIX 1024
+#define XY_RATIO XY_RATIO_5_4
+#define XBLANK 408
+#define YBLANK 42
+#define XOFFSET 48
+#define XPULSE 112
+#define YOFFSET (63+1)
+#define YPULSE (63+3)
+#define DPI 72
+#define VFREQ 60 /* Hz */
+#define TIMING_NAME "Linux SXGA"
+#define ESTABLISHED_TIMINGS_BITS 0x00 /* none */
+#define HSYNC_POL 1
+#define VSYNC_POL 1
+#define CRC 0xa0
+
+#include "edid.S"
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/1680x1050.S b/Documentation/EDID/1680x1050.S
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..96f67cafcf2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/1680x1050.S
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+/*
+ 1680x1050.S: EDID data set for standard 1680x1050 60 Hz monitor
+
+ Copyright (C) 2012 Carsten Emde <C.Emde@osadl.org>
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2
+ of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA.
+*/
+
+/* EDID */
+#define VERSION 1
+#define REVISION 3
+
+/* Display */
+#define CLOCK 146250 /* kHz */
+#define XPIX 1680
+#define YPIX 1050
+#define XY_RATIO XY_RATIO_16_10
+#define XBLANK 560
+#define YBLANK 39
+#define XOFFSET 104
+#define XPULSE 176
+#define YOFFSET (63+3)
+#define YPULSE (63+6)
+#define DPI 96
+#define VFREQ 60 /* Hz */
+#define TIMING_NAME "Linux WSXGA"
+#define ESTABLISHED_TIMINGS_BITS 0x00 /* none */
+#define HSYNC_POL 1
+#define VSYNC_POL 1
+#define CRC 0x26
+
+#include "edid.S"
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/1920x1080.S b/Documentation/EDID/1920x1080.S
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..36ed5d571d0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/1920x1080.S
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+/*
+ 1920x1080.S: EDID data set for standard 1920x1080 60 Hz monitor
+
+ Copyright (C) 2012 Carsten Emde <C.Emde@osadl.org>
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2
+ of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA.
+*/
+
+/* EDID */
+#define VERSION 1
+#define REVISION 3
+
+/* Display */
+#define CLOCK 148500 /* kHz */
+#define XPIX 1920
+#define YPIX 1080
+#define XY_RATIO XY_RATIO_16_9
+#define XBLANK 280
+#define YBLANK 45
+#define XOFFSET 88
+#define XPULSE 44
+#define YOFFSET (63+4)
+#define YPULSE (63+5)
+#define DPI 96
+#define VFREQ 60 /* Hz */
+#define TIMING_NAME "Linux FHD"
+#define ESTABLISHED_TIMINGS_BITS 0x00 /* none */
+#define HSYNC_POL 1
+#define VSYNC_POL 1
+#define CRC 0x05
+
+#include "edid.S"
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/HOWTO.txt b/Documentation/EDID/HOWTO.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..75a9f2a0c43
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/HOWTO.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+In the good old days when graphics parameters were configured explicitly
+in a file called xorg.conf, even broken hardware could be managed.
+
+Today, with the advent of Kernel Mode Setting, a graphics board is
+either correctly working because all components follow the standards -
+or the computer is unusable, because the screen remains dark after
+booting or it displays the wrong area. Cases when this happens are:
+- The graphics board does not recognize the monitor.
+- The graphics board is unable to detect any EDID data.
+- The graphics board incorrectly forwards EDID data to the driver.
+- The monitor sends no or bogus EDID data.
+- A KVM sends its own EDID data instead of querying the connected monitor.
+Adding the kernel parameter "nomodeset" helps in most cases, but causes
+restrictions later on.
+
+As a remedy for such situations, the kernel configuration item
+CONFIG_DRM_LOAD_EDID_FIRMWARE was introduced. It allows to provide an
+individually prepared or corrected EDID data set in the /lib/firmware
+directory from where it is loaded via the firmware interface. The code
+(see drivers/gpu/drm/drm_edid_load.c) contains built-in data sets for
+commonly used screen resolutions (1024x768, 1280x1024, 1680x1050,
+1920x1080) as binary blobs, but the kernel source tree does not contain
+code to create these data. In order to elucidate the origin of the
+built-in binary EDID blobs and to facilitate the creation of individual
+data for a specific misbehaving monitor, commented sources and a
+Makefile environment are given here.
+
+To create binary EDID and C source code files from the existing data
+material, simply type "make".
+
+If you want to create your own EDID file, copy the file 1024x768.S and
+replace the settings with your own data. The CRC value in the last line
+ #define CRC 0x55
+is a bit tricky. After a first version of the binary data set is
+created, it must be be checked with the "edid-decode" utility which will
+most probably complain about a wrong CRC. Fortunately, the utility also
+displays the correct CRC which must then be inserted into the source
+file. After the make procedure is repeated, the EDID data set is ready
+to be used.
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/Makefile b/Documentation/EDID/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..17763ca3f12
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+
+SOURCES := $(wildcard [0-9]*x[0-9]*.S)
+
+BIN := $(patsubst %.S, %.bin, $(SOURCES))
+
+IHEX := $(patsubst %.S, %.bin.ihex, $(SOURCES))
+
+CODE := $(patsubst %.S, %.c, $(SOURCES))
+
+all: $(BIN) $(IHEX) $(CODE)
+
+clean:
+ @rm -f *.o *.bin.ihex *.bin *.c
+
+%.o: %.S
+ @cc -c $^
+
+%.bin: %.o
+ @objcopy -Obinary $^ $@
+
+%.bin.ihex: %.o
+ @objcopy -Oihex $^ $@
+ @dos2unix $@ 2>/dev/null
+
+%.c: %.bin
+ @echo "{" >$@; hexdump -f hex $^ >>$@; echo "};" >>$@
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/edid.S b/Documentation/EDID/edid.S
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..ea97ae275fc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/edid.S
@@ -0,0 +1,261 @@
+/*
+ edid.S: EDID data template
+
+ Copyright (C) 2012 Carsten Emde <C.Emde@osadl.org>
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2
+ of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA.
+*/
+
+
+/* Manufacturer */
+#define MFG_LNX1 'L'
+#define MFG_LNX2 'N'
+#define MFG_LNX3 'X'
+#define SERIAL 0
+#define YEAR 2012
+#define WEEK 5
+
+/* EDID 1.3 standard definitions */
+#define XY_RATIO_16_10 0b00
+#define XY_RATIO_4_3 0b01
+#define XY_RATIO_5_4 0b10
+#define XY_RATIO_16_9 0b11
+
+#define mfgname2id(v1,v2,v3) \
+ ((((v1-'@')&0x1f)<<10)+(((v2-'@')&0x1f)<<5)+((v3-'@')&0x1f))
+#define swap16(v1) ((v1>>8)+((v1&0xff)<<8))
+#define msbs2(v1,v2) ((((v1>>8)&0x0f)<<4)+((v2>>8)&0x0f))
+#define msbs4(v1,v2,v3,v4) \
+ (((v1&0x03)>>2)+((v2&0x03)>>4)+((v3&0x03)>>6)+((v4&0x03)>>8))
+#define pixdpi2mm(pix,dpi) ((pix*25)/dpi)
+#define xsize pixdpi2mm(XPIX,DPI)
+#define ysize pixdpi2mm(YPIX,DPI)
+
+ .data
+
+/* Fixed header pattern */
+header: .byte 0x00,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0x00
+
+mfg_id: .word swap16(mfgname2id(MFG_LNX1, MFG_LNX2, MFG_LNX3))
+
+prod_code: .word 0
+
+/* Serial number. 32 bits, little endian. */
+serial_number: .long SERIAL
+
+/* Week of manufacture */
+week: .byte WEEK
+
+/* Year of manufacture, less 1990. (1990-2245)
+ If week=255, it is the model year instead */
+year: .byte YEAR-1990
+
+version: .byte VERSION /* EDID version, usually 1 (for 1.3) */
+revision: .byte REVISION /* EDID revision, usually 3 (for 1.3) */
+
+/* If Bit 7=1 Digital input. If set, the following bit definitions apply:
+ Bits 6-1 Reserved, must be 0
+ Bit 0 Signal is compatible with VESA DFP 1.x TMDS CRGB,
+ 1 pixel per clock, up to 8 bits per color, MSB aligned,
+ If Bit 7=0 Analog input. If clear, the following bit definitions apply:
+ Bits 6-5 Video white and sync levels, relative to blank
+ 00=+0.7/-0.3 V; 01=+0.714/-0.286 V;
+ 10=+1.0/-0.4 V; 11=+0.7/0 V
+ Bit 4 Blank-to-black setup (pedestal) expected
+ Bit 3 Separate sync supported
+ Bit 2 Composite sync (on HSync) supported
+ Bit 1 Sync on green supported
+ Bit 0 VSync pulse must be serrated when somposite or
+ sync-on-green is used. */
+video_parms: .byte 0x6d
+
+/* Maximum horizontal image size, in centimetres
+ (max 292 cm/115 in at 16:9 aspect ratio) */
+max_hor_size: .byte xsize/10
+
+/* Maximum vertical image size, in centimetres.
+ If either byte is 0, undefined (e.g. projector) */
+max_vert_size: .byte ysize/10
+
+/* Display gamma, minus 1, times 100 (range 1.00-3.5 */
+gamma: .byte 120
+
+/* Bit 7 DPMS standby supported
+ Bit 6 DPMS suspend supported
+ Bit 5 DPMS active-off supported
+ Bits 4-3 Display type: 00=monochrome; 01=RGB colour;
+ 10=non-RGB multicolour; 11=undefined
+ Bit 2 Standard sRGB colour space. Bytes 25-34 must contain
+ sRGB standard values.
+ Bit 1 Preferred timing mode specified in descriptor block 1.
+ Bit 0 GTF supported with default parameter values. */
+dsp_features: .byte 0xea
+
+/* Chromaticity coordinates. */
+/* Red and green least-significant bits
+ Bits 7-6 Red x value least-significant 2 bits
+ Bits 5-4 Red y value least-significant 2 bits
+ Bits 3-2 Green x value lst-significant 2 bits
+ Bits 1-0 Green y value least-significant 2 bits */
+red_green_lsb: .byte 0x5e
+
+/* Blue and white least-significant 2 bits */
+blue_white_lsb: .byte 0xc0
+
+/* Red x value most significant 8 bits.
+ 0-255 encodes 0-0.996 (255/256); 0-0.999 (1023/1024) with lsbits */
+red_x_msb: .byte 0xa4
+
+/* Red y value most significant 8 bits */
+red_y_msb: .byte 0x59
+
+/* Green x and y value most significant 8 bits */
+green_x_y_msb: .byte 0x4a,0x98
+
+/* Blue x and y value most significant 8 bits */
+blue_x_y_msb: .byte 0x25,0x20
+
+/* Default white point x and y value most significant 8 bits */
+white_x_y_msb: .byte 0x50,0x54
+
+/* Established timings */
+/* Bit 7 720x400 @ 70 Hz
+ Bit 6 720x400 @ 88 Hz
+ Bit 5 640x480 @ 60 Hz
+ Bit 4 640x480 @ 67 Hz
+ Bit 3 640x480 @ 72 Hz
+ Bit 2 640x480 @ 75 Hz
+ Bit 1 800x600 @ 56 Hz
+ Bit 0 800x600 @ 60 Hz */
+estbl_timing1: .byte 0x00
+
+/* Bit 7 800x600 @ 72 Hz
+ Bit 6 800x600 @ 75 Hz
+ Bit 5 832x624 @ 75 Hz
+ Bit 4 1024x768 @ 87 Hz, interlaced (1024x768)
+ Bit 3 1024x768 @ 60 Hz
+ Bit 2 1024x768 @ 72 Hz
+ Bit 1 1024x768 @ 75 Hz
+ Bit 0 1280x1024 @ 75 Hz */
+estbl_timing2: .byte ESTABLISHED_TIMINGS_BITS
+
+/* Bit 7 1152x870 @ 75 Hz (Apple Macintosh II)
+ Bits 6-0 Other manufacturer-specific display mod */
+estbl_timing3: .byte 0x00
+
+/* Standard timing */
+/* X resolution, less 31, divided by 8 (256-2288 pixels) */
+std_xres: .byte (XPIX/8)-31
+/* Y resolution, X:Y pixel ratio
+ Bits 7-6 X:Y pixel ratio: 00=16:10; 01=4:3; 10=5:4; 11=16:9.
+ Bits 5-0 Vertical frequency, less 60 (60-123 Hz) */
+std_vres: .byte (XY_RATIO<<6)+VFREQ-60
+ .fill 7,2,0x0101 /* Unused */
+
+descriptor1:
+/* Pixel clock in 10 kHz units. (0.-655.35 MHz, little-endian) */
+clock: .word CLOCK/10
+
+/* Horizontal active pixels 8 lsbits (0-4095) */
+x_act_lsb: .byte XPIX&0xff
+/* Horizontal blanking pixels 8 lsbits (0-4095)
+ End of active to start of next active. */
+x_blk_lsb: .byte XBLANK&0xff
+/* Bits 7-4 Horizontal active pixels 4 msbits
+ Bits 3-0 Horizontal blanking pixels 4 msbits */
+x_msbs: .byte msbs2(XPIX,XBLANK)
+
+/* Vertical active lines 8 lsbits (0-4095) */
+y_act_lsb: .byte YPIX&0xff
+/* Vertical blanking lines 8 lsbits (0-4095) */
+y_blk_lsb: .byte YBLANK&0xff
+/* Bits 7-4 Vertical active lines 4 msbits
+ Bits 3-0 Vertical blanking lines 4 msbits */
+y_msbs: .byte msbs2(YPIX,YBLANK)
+
+/* Horizontal sync offset pixels 8 lsbits (0-1023) From blanking start */
+x_snc_off_lsb: .byte XOFFSET&0xff
+/* Horizontal sync pulse width pixels 8 lsbits (0-1023) */
+x_snc_pls_lsb: .byte XPULSE&0xff
+/* Bits 7-4 Vertical sync offset lines 4 lsbits -63)
+ Bits 3-0 Vertical sync pulse width lines 4 lsbits -63) */
+y_snc_lsb: .byte ((YOFFSET-63)<<4)+(YPULSE-63)
+/* Bits 7-6 Horizontal sync offset pixels 2 msbits
+ Bits 5-4 Horizontal sync pulse width pixels 2 msbits
+ Bits 3-2 Vertical sync offset lines 2 msbits
+ Bits 1-0 Vertical sync pulse width lines 2 msbits */
+xy_snc_msbs: .byte msbs4(XOFFSET,XPULSE,YOFFSET,YPULSE)
+
+/* Horizontal display size, mm, 8 lsbits (0-4095 mm, 161 in) */
+x_dsp_size: .byte xsize&0xff
+
+/* Vertical display size, mm, 8 lsbits (0-4095 mm, 161 in) */
+y_dsp_size: .byte ysize&0xff
+
+/* Bits 7-4 Horizontal display size, mm, 4 msbits
+ Bits 3-0 Vertical display size, mm, 4 msbits */
+dsp_size_mbsb: .byte msbs2(xsize,ysize)
+
+/* Horizontal border pixels (each side; total is twice this) */
+x_border: .byte 0
+/* Vertical border lines (each side; total is twice this) */
+y_border: .byte 0
+
+/* Bit 7 Interlaced
+ Bits 6-5 Stereo mode: 00=No stereo; other values depend on bit 0:
+ Bit 0=0: 01=Field sequential, sync=1 during right; 10=similar,
+ sync=1 during left; 11=4-way interleaved stereo
+ Bit 0=1 2-way interleaved stereo: 01=Right image on even lines;
+ 10=Left image on even lines; 11=side-by-side
+ Bits 4-3 Sync type: 00=Analog composite; 01=Bipolar analog composite;
+ 10=Digital composite (on HSync); 11=Digital separate
+ Bit 2 If digital separate: Vertical sync polarity (1=positive)
+ Other types: VSync serrated (HSync during VSync)
+ Bit 1 If analog sync: Sync on all 3 RGB lines (else green only)
+ Digital: HSync polarity (1=positive)
+ Bit 0 2-way line-interleaved stereo, if bits 4-3 are not 00. */
+features: .byte 0x18+(VSYNC_POL<<2)+(HSYNC_POL<<1)
+
+descriptor2: .byte 0,0 /* Not a detailed timing descriptor */
+ .byte 0 /* Must be zero */
+ .byte 0xff /* Descriptor is monitor serial number (text) */
+ .byte 0 /* Must be zero */
+start1: .ascii "Linux #0"
+end1: .byte 0x0a /* End marker */
+ .fill 12-(end1-start1), 1, 0x20 /* Padded spaces */
+descriptor3: .byte 0,0 /* Not a detailed timing descriptor */
+ .byte 0 /* Must be zero */
+ .byte 0xfd /* Descriptor is monitor range limits */
+ .byte 0 /* Must be zero */
+start2: .byte VFREQ-1 /* Minimum vertical field rate (1-255 Hz) */
+ .byte VFREQ+1 /* Maximum vertical field rate (1-255 Hz) */
+ .byte (CLOCK/(XPIX+XBLANK))-1 /* Minimum horizontal line rate
+ (1-255 kHz) */
+ .byte (CLOCK/(XPIX+XBLANK))+1 /* Maximum horizontal line rate
+ (1-255 kHz) */
+ .byte (CLOCK/10000)+1 /* Maximum pixel clock rate, rounded up
+ to 10 MHz multiple (10-2550 MHz) */
+ .byte 0 /* No extended timing information type */
+end2: .byte 0x0a /* End marker */
+ .fill 12-(end2-start2), 1, 0x20 /* Padded spaces */
+descriptor4: .byte 0,0 /* Not a detailed timing descriptor */
+ .byte 0 /* Must be zero */
+ .byte 0xfc /* Descriptor is text */
+ .byte 0 /* Must be zero */
+start3: .ascii TIMING_NAME
+end3: .byte 0x0a /* End marker */
+ .fill 12-(end3-start3), 1, 0x20 /* Padded spaces */
+extensions: .byte 0 /* Number of extensions to follow */
+checksum: .byte CRC /* Sum of all bytes must be 0 */
diff --git a/Documentation/EDID/hex b/Documentation/EDID/hex
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..8873ebb618a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/EDID/hex
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+"\t" 8/1 "0x%02x, " "\n"
diff --git a/Documentation/IRQ-domain.txt b/Documentation/IRQ-domain.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..27dcaabfb4d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/IRQ-domain.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,117 @@
+irq_domain interrupt number mapping library
+
+The current design of the Linux kernel uses a single large number
+space where each separate IRQ source is assigned a different number.
+This is simple when there is only one interrupt controller, but in
+systems with multiple interrupt controllers the kernel must ensure
+that each one gets assigned non-overlapping allocations of Linux
+IRQ numbers.
+
+The irq_alloc_desc*() and irq_free_desc*() APIs provide allocation of
+irq numbers, but they don't provide any support for reverse mapping of
+the controller-local IRQ (hwirq) number into the Linux IRQ number
+space.
+
+The irq_domain library adds mapping between hwirq and IRQ numbers on
+top of the irq_alloc_desc*() API. An irq_domain to manage mapping is
+preferred over interrupt controller drivers open coding their own
+reverse mapping scheme.
+
+irq_domain also implements translation from Device Tree interrupt
+specifiers to hwirq numbers, and can be easily extended to support
+other IRQ topology data sources.
+
+=== irq_domain usage ===
+An interrupt controller driver creates and registers an irq_domain by
+calling one of the irq_domain_add_*() functions (each mapping method
+has a different allocator function, more on that later). The function
+will return a pointer to the irq_domain on success. The caller must
+provide the allocator function with an irq_domain_ops structure with
+the .map callback populated as a minimum.
+
+In most cases, the irq_domain will begin empty without any mappings
+between hwirq and IRQ numbers. Mappings are added to the irq_domain
+by calling irq_create_mapping() which accepts the irq_domain and a
+hwirq number as arguments. If a mapping for the hwirq doesn't already
+exist then it will allocate a new Linux irq_desc, associate it with
+the hwirq, and call the .map() callback so the driver can perform any
+required hardware setup.
+
+When an interrupt is received, irq_find_mapping() function should
+be used to find the Linux IRQ number from the hwirq number.
+
+If the driver has the Linux IRQ number or the irq_data pointer, and
+needs to know the associated hwirq number (such as in the irq_chip
+callbacks) then it can be directly obtained from irq_data->hwirq.
+
+=== Types of irq_domain mappings ===
+There are several mechanisms available for reverse mapping from hwirq
+to Linux irq, and each mechanism uses a different allocation function.
+Which reverse map type should be used depends on the use case. Each
+of the reverse map types are described below:
+
+==== Linear ====
+irq_domain_add_linear()
+
+The linear reverse map maintains a fixed size table indexed by the
+hwirq number. When a hwirq is mapped, an irq_desc is allocated for
+the hwirq, and the IRQ number is stored in the table.
+
+The Linear map is a good choice when the maximum number of hwirqs is
+fixed and a relatively small number (~ < 256). The advantages of this
+map are fixed time lookup for IRQ numbers, and irq_descs are only
+allocated for in-use IRQs. The disadvantage is that the table must be
+as large as the largest possible hwirq number.
+
+The majority of drivers should use the linear map.
+
+==== Tree ====
+irq_domain_add_tree()
+
+The irq_domain maintains a radix tree map from hwirq numbers to Linux
+IRQs. When an hwirq is mapped, an irq_desc is allocated and the
+hwirq is used as the lookup key for the radix tree.
+
+The tree map is a good choice if the hwirq number can be very large
+since it doesn't need to allocate a table as large as the largest
+hwirq number. The disadvantage is that hwirq to IRQ number lookup is
+dependent on how many entries are in the table.
+
+Very few drivers should need this mapping. At the moment, powerpc
+iseries is the only user.
+
+==== No Map ===-
+irq_domain_add_nomap()
+
+The No Map mapping is to be used when the hwirq number is
+programmable in the hardware. In this case it is best to program the
+Linux IRQ number into the hardware itself so that no mapping is
+required. Calling irq_create_direct_mapping() will allocate a Linux
+IRQ number and call the .map() callback so that driver can program the
+Linux IRQ number into the hardware.
+
+Most drivers cannot use this mapping.
+
+==== Legacy ====
+irq_domain_add_legacy()
+irq_domain_add_legacy_isa()
+
+The Legacy mapping is a special case for drivers that already have a
+range of irq_descs allocated for the hwirqs. It is used when the
+driver cannot be immediately converted to use the linear mapping. For
+example, many embedded system board support files use a set of #defines
+for IRQ numbers that are passed to struct device registrations. In that
+case the Linux IRQ numbers cannot be dynamically assigned and the legacy
+mapping should be used.
+
+The legacy map assumes a contiguous range of IRQ numbers has already
+been allocated for the controller and that the IRQ number can be
+calculated by adding a fixed offset to the hwirq number, and
+visa-versa. The disadvantage is that it requires the interrupt
+controller to manage IRQ allocations and it requires an irq_desc to be
+allocated for every hwirq, even if it is unused.
+
+The legacy map should only be used if fixed IRQ mappings must be
+supported. For example, ISA controllers would use the legacy map for
+mapping Linux IRQs 0-15 so that existing ISA drivers get the correct IRQ
+numbers.
diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/RTFP.txt b/Documentation/RCU/RTFP.txt
index c43460dade0..7c1dfb19fc4 100644
--- a/Documentation/RCU/RTFP.txt
+++ b/Documentation/RCU/RTFP.txt
@@ -1,9 +1,10 @@
-Read the F-ing Papers!
+Read the Fscking Papers!
This document describes RCU-related publications, and is followed by
the corresponding bibtex entries. A number of the publications may
-be found at http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/.
+be found at http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/. For others, browsers
+and search engines will usually find what you are looking for.
The first thing resembling RCU was published in 1980, when Kung and Lehman
[Kung80] recommended use of a garbage collector to defer destruction
@@ -160,7 +161,26 @@ which Mathieu Desnoyers is now maintaining [MathieuDesnoyers2009URCU]
[MathieuDesnoyersPhD]. TINY_RCU [PaulEMcKenney2009BloatWatchRCU] made
its appearance, as did expedited RCU [PaulEMcKenney2009expeditedRCU].
The problem of resizeable RCU-protected hash tables may now be on a path
-to a solution [JoshTriplett2009RPHash].
+to a solution [JoshTriplett2009RPHash]. A few academic researchers are now
+using RCU to solve their parallel problems [HariKannan2009DynamicAnalysisRCU].
+
+2010 produced a simpler preemptible-RCU implementation
+based on TREE_RCU [PaulEMcKenney2010SimpleOptRCU], lockdep-RCU
+[PaulEMcKenney2010LockdepRCU], another resizeable RCU-protected hash
+table [HerbertXu2010RCUResizeHash] (this one consuming more memory,
+but allowing arbitrary changes in hash function, as required for DoS
+avoidance in the networking code), realization of the 2009 RCU-protected
+hash table with atomic node move [JoshTriplett2010RPHash], an update on
+the RCU API [PaulEMcKenney2010RCUAPI].
+
+2011 marked the inclusion of Nick Piggin's fully lockless dentry search
+[LinusTorvalds2011Linux2:6:38:rc1:NPigginVFS], an RCU-protected red-black
+tree using software transactional memory to protect concurrent updates
+(strange, but true!) [PhilHoward2011RCUTMRBTree], yet another variant of
+RCU-protected resizeable hash tables [Triplett:2011:RPHash], the 3.0 RCU
+trainwreck [PaulEMcKenney2011RCU3.0trainwreck], and Neil Brown's "Meet the
+Lockers" LWN article [NeilBrown2011MeetTheLockers].
+
Bibtex Entries
@@ -173,6 +193,14 @@ Bibtex Entries
,volume="5"
,number="3"
,pages="354-382"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://portal.acm.org/citation.cfm?id=320619&dl=GUIDE,}
+[Viewed December 3, 2007]"
+,annotation={
+ Use garbage collector to clean up data after everyone is done with it.
+ .
+ Oldest use of something vaguely resembling RCU that I have found.
+}
}
@techreport{Manber82
@@ -184,6 +212,31 @@ Bibtex Entries
,number="82-01-01"
,month="January"
,pages="28"
+,annotation={
+ .
+ Superseded by Manber84.
+ .
+ Describes concurrent AVL tree implementation. Uses a
+ garbage-collection mechanism to handle concurrent use and deletion
+ of nodes in the tree, but lacks the summary-of-execution-history
+ concept of read-copy locking.
+ .
+ Keeps full list of processes that were active when a given
+ node was to be deleted, and waits until all such processes have
+ -terminated- before allowing this node to be reused. This is
+ not described in great detail -- one could imagine using process
+ IDs for this if the ID space was large enough that overlapping
+ never occurred.
+ .
+ This restriction makes this algorithm unsuitable for use in
+ systems comprised of long-lived processes. It also produces
+ completely unacceptable overhead in systems with large numbers
+ of processes. Finally, it is specific to AVL trees.
+ .
+ Cites Kung80, so not an independent invention, but the first
+ RCU-like usage that does not rely on an automatic garbage
+ collector.
+}
}
@article{Manber84
@@ -195,6 +248,74 @@ Bibtex Entries
,volume="9"
,number="3"
,pages="439-455"
+,annotation={
+ Describes concurrent AVL tree implementation. Uses a
+ garbage-collection mechanism to handle concurrent use and deletion
+ of nodes in the tree, but lacks the summary-of-execution-history
+ concept of read-copy locking.
+ .
+ Keeps full list of processes that were active when a given
+ node was to be deleted, and waits until all such processes have
+ -terminated- before allowing this node to be reused. This is
+ not described in great detail -- one could imagine using process
+ IDs for this if the ID space was large enough that overlapping
+ never occurred.
+ .
+ This restriction makes this algorithm unsuitable for use in
+ systems comprised of long-lived processes. It also produces
+ completely unacceptable overhead in systems with large numbers
+ of processes. Finally, it is specific to AVL trees.
+}
+}
+
+@Conference{RichardRashid87a
+,Author="Richard Rashid and Avadis Tevanian and Michael Young and
+David Golub and Robert Baron and David Black and William Bolosky and
+Jonathan Chew"
+,Title="Machine-Independent Virtual Memory Management for Paged
+Uniprocessor and Multiprocessor Architectures"
+,Booktitle="{2\textsuperscript{nd} Symposium on Architectural Support
+for Programming Languages and Operating Systems}"
+,Publisher="Association for Computing Machinery"
+,Month="October"
+,Year="1987"
+,pages="31-39"
+,Address="Palo Alto, CA"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.cse.ucsc.edu/~randal/221/rashid-machvm.pdf}
+[Viewed February 17, 2005]"
+,annotation={
+ Describes lazy TLB flush, where one waits for each CPU to pass
+ through a scheduling-clock interrupt before reusing a given range
+ of virtual address. Does not describe how one determines that
+ all CPUs have in fact taken such an interrupt, though there are
+ no shortage of straightforward methods for accomplishing this.
+ .
+ Note that it does not make sense to just wait a fixed amount of
+ time, since a given CPU might have interrupts disabled for an
+ extended amount of time.
+}
+}
+
+@article{BarbaraLiskov1988ArgusCACM
+,author = {Barbara Liskov}
+,title = {Distributed programming in {Argus}}
+,journal = {Commun. ACM}
+,volume = {31}
+,number = {3}
+,year = {1988}
+,issn = {0001-0782}
+,pages = {300--312}
+,doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/42392.42399}
+,publisher = {ACM}
+,address = {New York, NY, USA}
+,annotation= {
+ At the top of page 307: "Conflicts with deposits and withdrawals
+ are necessary if the reported total is to be up to date. They
+ could be avoided by having total return a sum that is slightly
+ out of date." Relies on semantics -- approximate numerical
+ values sometimes OK.
+}
}
@techreport{Hennessy89
@@ -216,6 +337,13 @@ Bibtex Entries
,year="1990"
,number="CS-TR-2222.1"
,month="June"
+,annotation={
+ Concurrent access to skip lists. Has both weak and strong search.
+ Uses concept of ``garbage queue'', but has no real way of cleaning
+ the garbage efficiently.
+ .
+ Appears to be an independent invention of an RCU-like mechanism.
+}
}
@Book{Adams91
@@ -223,20 +351,15 @@ Bibtex Entries
,title="Concurrent Programming, Principles, and Practices"
,Publisher="Benjamin Cummins"
,Year="1991"
+,annotation={
+ Has a few paragraphs describing ``chaotic relaxation'', a
+ numerical analysis technique that allows multiprocessors to
+ avoid synchronization overhead by using possibly-stale data.
+ .
+ Seems like this is descended from yet another independent
+ invention of RCU-like function -- but this is restricted
+ in that reclamation is not necessary.
}
-
-@phdthesis{HMassalinPhD
-,author="H. Massalin"
-,title="Synthesis: An Efficient Implementation of Fundamental Operating
-System Services"
-,school="Columbia University"
-,address="New York, NY"
-,year="1992"
-,annotation="
- Mondo optimizing compiler.
- Wait-free stuff.
- Good advice: defer work to avoid synchronization.
-"
}
@unpublished{Jacobson93
@@ -244,7 +367,13 @@ System Services"
,title="Avoid Read-Side Locking Via Delayed Free"
,year="1993"
,month="September"
-,note="Verbal discussion"
+,note="private communication"
+,annotation={
+ Use fixed time delay to approximate grace period. Very simple,
+ but subject to random memory corruption under heavy load.
+ .
+ Independent invention of RCU-like mechanism.
+}
}
@Conference{AjuJohn95
@@ -256,6 +385,17 @@ System Services"
,Year="1995"
,pages="11-23"
,Address="New Orleans, LA"
+,note="Available:
+\url{https://www.usenix.org/publications/library/proceedings/neworl/full_papers/john.a}
+[Viewed October 1, 2010]"
+,annotation={
+ Age vnodes out of the cache, and have a fixed time set by a kernel
+ parameter. Not clear that all races were in fact correctly handled.
+ Used a 20-minute time by default, which would most definitely not
+ be suitable during DoS attacks or virus scans.
+ .
+ Apparently independent invention of RCU-like mechanism.
+}
}
@conference{Pu95a,
@@ -301,31 +441,47 @@ Utilizing Execution History and Thread Monitoring"
,institution="US Patent and Trademark Office"
,address="Washington, DC"
,year="1995"
-,number="US Patent 5,442,758 (contributed under GPL)"
+,number="US Patent 5,442,758"
,month="August"
+,annotation={
+ Describes the parallel RCU infrastructure. Includes NUMA aspect
+ (structure of bitmap can reflect bus structure of computer system).
+ .
+ Another independent invention of an RCU-like mechanism, but the
+ "real" RCU this time!
+}
}
@techreport{Slingwine97
,author="John D. Slingwine and Paul E. McKenney"
-,title="Method for maintaining data coherency using thread
-activity summaries in a multicomputer system"
+,title="Method for Maintaining Data Coherency Using Thread Activity
+Summaries in a Multicomputer System"
,institution="US Patent and Trademark Office"
,address="Washington, DC"
,year="1997"
-,number="US Patent 5,608,893 (contributed under GPL)"
+,number="US Patent 5,608,893"
,month="March"
+,pages="19"
+,annotation={
+ Describes use of RCU to synchronize data between a pair of
+ SMP/NUMA computer systems.
+}
}
@techreport{Slingwine98
,author="John D. Slingwine and Paul E. McKenney"
-,title="Apparatus and method for achieving reduced overhead
-mutual exclusion and maintaining coherency in a multiprocessor
-system utilizing execution history and thread monitoring"
+,title="Apparatus and Method for Achieving Reduced Overhead Mutual
+Exclusion and Maintaining Coherency in a Multiprocessor System
+Utilizing Execution History and Thread Monitoring"
,institution="US Patent and Trademark Office"
,address="Washington, DC"
,year="1998"
-,number="US Patent 5,727,209 (contributed under GPL)"
+,number="US Patent 5,727,209"
,month="March"
+,annotation={
+ Describes doing an atomic update by copying the data item and
+ then substituting it into the data structure.
+}
}
@Conference{McKenney98
@@ -337,6 +493,15 @@ Problems"
,Year="1998"
,pages="509-518"
,Address="Las Vegas, NV"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/rclockpdcsproof.pdf}
+[Viewed December 3, 2007]"
+,annotation={
+ Describes and analyzes RCU mechanism in DYNIX/ptx. Describes
+ application to linked list update and log-buffer flushing.
+ Defines 'quiescent state'. Includes both measured and analytic
+ evaluation.
+}
}
@Conference{Gamsa99
@@ -349,18 +514,76 @@ Operating System Design and Implementation}"
,Year="1999"
,pages="87-100"
,Address="New Orleans, LA"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.usenix.org/events/osdi99/full_papers/gamsa/gamsa.pdf}
+[Viewed August 30, 2006]"
+,annotation={
+ Use of RCU-like facility in K42/Tornado. Another independent
+ invention of RCU.
+ See especially pages 7-9 (Section 5).
+}
+}
+
+@unpublished{RustyRussell2000a
+,Author="Rusty Russell"
+,Title="Re: modular net drivers"
+,month="June"
+,year="2000"
+,day="23"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://oss.sgi.com/projects/netdev/archive/2000-06/msg00250.html}
+[Viewed April 10, 2006]"
+,annotation={
+ Proto-RCU proposal from Phil Rumpf and Rusty Russell.
+ Yet another independent invention of RCU.
+ Outline of algorithm to unload modules...
+ .
+ Appeared on net-dev mailing list.
+}
+}
+
+@unpublished{RustyRussell2000b
+,Author="Rusty Russell"
+,Title="Re: modular net drivers"
+,month="June"
+,year="2000"
+,day="24"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://oss.sgi.com/projects/netdev/archive/2000-06/msg00254.html}
+[Viewed April 10, 2006]"
+,annotation={
+ Proto-RCU proposal from Phil Rumpf and Rusty Russell.
+ .
+ Appeared on net-dev mailing list.
+}
+}
+
+@unpublished{McKenney01b
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Dipankar Sarma"
+,Title="Read-Copy Update Mutual Exclusion in {Linux}"
+,month="February"
+,year="2001"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lse.sourceforge.net/locking/rcu/rcupdate_doc.html}
+[Viewed October 18, 2004]"
+,annotation={
+ Prototypical Linux documentation for RCU.
+}
}
@techreport{Slingwine01
,author="John D. Slingwine and Paul E. McKenney"
-,title="Apparatus and method for achieving reduced overhead
-mutual exclusion and maintaining coherency in a multiprocessor
-system utilizing execution history and thread monitoring"
+,title="Apparatus and Method for Achieving Reduced Overhead Mutual
+Exclusion and Maintaining Coherency in a Multiprocessor System
+Utilizing Execution History and Thread Monitoring"
,institution="US Patent and Trademark Office"
,address="Washington, DC"
,year="2001"
-,number="US Patent 5,219,690 (contributed under GPL)"
+,number="US Patent 6,219,690"
,month="April"
+,annotation={
+ 'Change in mode' aspect of RCU. Can be thought of as a lazy barrier.
+}
}
@Conference{McKenney01a
@@ -372,14 +595,61 @@ Orran Krieger and Rusty Russell and Dipankar Sarma and Maneesh Soni"
,Year="2001"
,note="Available:
\url{http://www.linuxsymposium.org/2001/abstracts/readcopy.php}
-\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/rclock/rclock_OLS.2001.05.01c.pdf}
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/rclock_OLS.2001.05.01c.pdf}
[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
-annotation="
-Described RCU, and presented some patches implementing and using it in
-the Linux kernel.
+,annotation={
+ Described RCU, and presented some patches implementing and using
+ it in the Linux kernel.
+}
+}
+
+@unpublished{McKenney01f
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{RFC:} patch to allow lock-free traversal of lists with insertion"
+,month="October"
+,year="2001"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=100259266316456&w=2}
+[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Memory-barrier and Alpha thread. 100 messages, not too bad...
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Spraul01
+,Author="Manfred Spraul"
+,Title="Re: {RFC:} patch to allow lock-free traversal of lists with insertion"
+,month="October"
+,year="2001"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=100264675012867&w=2}
+[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Suggested burying memory barriers in Linux's list-manipulation
+ primitives.
"
}
+@unpublished{LinusTorvalds2001a
+,Author="Linus Torvalds"
+,Title="{Re:} {[Lse-tech]} {Re:} {RFC:} patch to allow lock-free traversal of lists with insertion"
+,month="October"
+,year="2001"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2001/10/13/105}
+[Viewed August 21, 2004]"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Blanchard02a
+,Author="Anton Blanchard"
+,Title="some RCU dcache and ratcache results"
+,month="March"
+,year="2002"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=101637107412972&w=2}
+[Viewed October 18, 2004]"
+}
+
@Conference{Linder02a
,Author="Hanna Linder and Dipankar Sarma and Maneesh Soni"
,Title="Scalability of the Directory Entry Cache"
@@ -387,6 +657,10 @@ the Linux kernel.
,Month="June"
,Year="2002"
,pages="289-300"
+,annotation="
+ Measured scalability of Linux 2.4 kernel's directory-entry cache
+ (dcache), and measured some scalability enhancements.
+"
}
@Conference{McKenney02a
@@ -400,49 +674,76 @@ Andrea Arcangeli and Andi Kleen and Orran Krieger and Rusty Russell"
,note="Available:
\url{http://www.linux.org.uk/~ajh/ols2002_proceedings.pdf.gz}
[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Presented and compared a number of RCU implementations for the
+ Linux kernel.
+"
}
-@conference{Michael02a
-,author="Maged M. Michael"
-,title="Safe Memory Reclamation for Dynamic Lock-Free Objects Using Atomic
-Reads and Writes"
-,Year="2002"
-,Month="August"
-,booktitle="{Proceedings of the 21\textsuperscript{st} Annual ACM
-Symposium on Principles of Distributed Computing}"
-,pages="21-30"
+@unpublished{Sarma02a
+,Author="Dipankar Sarma"
+,Title="specweb99: dcache scalability results"
+,month="July"
+,year="2002"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=102645767914212&w=2}
+[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
,annotation="
- Each thread keeps an array of pointers to items that it is
- currently referencing. Sort of an inside-out garbage collection
- mechanism, but one that requires the accessing code to explicitly
- state its needs. Also requires read-side memory barriers on
- most architectures.
+ Compare fastwalk and RCU for dcache. RCU won.
"
}
-@conference{Michael02b
-,author="Maged M. Michael"
-,title="High Performance Dynamic Lock-Free Hash Tables and List-Based Sets"
-,Year="2002"
-,Month="August"
-,booktitle="{Proceedings of the 14\textsuperscript{th} Annual ACM
-Symposium on Parallel
-Algorithms and Architecture}"
-,pages="73-82"
+@unpublished{Barbieri02
+,Author="Luca Barbieri"
+,Title="Re: {[PATCH]} Initial support for struct {vfs\_cred}"
+,month="August"
+,year="2002"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=103082050621241&w=2}
+[Viewed: June 23, 2004]"
,annotation="
- Like the title says...
+ Suggested RCU for vfs\_shared\_cred.
"
}
-@InProceedings{HerlihyLM02
-,author={Maurice Herlihy and Victor Luchangco and Mark Moir}
-,title="The Repeat Offender Problem: A Mechanism for Supporting Dynamic-Sized,
-Lock-Free Data Structures"
-,booktitle={Proceedings of 16\textsuperscript{th} International
-Symposium on Distributed Computing}
-,year=2002
+@unpublished{Dickins02a
+,author="Hugh Dickins"
+,title="Use RCU for System-V IPC"
+,year="2002"
+,month="October"
+,note="private communication"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Sarma02b
+,Author="Dipankar Sarma"
+,Title="Some dcache\_rcu benchmark numbers"
,month="October"
-,pages="339-353"
+,year="2002"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=103462075416638&w=2}
+[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Performance of dcache RCU on kernbench for 16x NUMA-Q and 1x,
+ 2x, and 4x systems. RCU does no harm, and helps on 16x.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{LinusTorvalds2003a
+,Author="Linus Torvalds"
+,Title="Re: {[PATCH]} small fixes in brlock.h"
+,month="March"
+,year="2003"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2003/3/9/205}
+[Viewed March 13, 2006]"
+,annotation="
+ Linus suggests replacing brlock with RCU and/or seqlocks:
+ .
+ 'It's entirely possible that the current user could be replaced
+ by RCU and/or seqlocks, and we could get rid of brlocks entirely.'
+ .
+ Steve Hemminger responds by replacing them with RCU.
+"
}
@article{Appavoo03a
@@ -457,6 +758,20 @@ B. Rosenburg and M. Stumm and J. Xenidis"
,volume="42"
,number="1"
,pages="60-76"
+,annotation="
+ Use of RCU to enable hot-swapping for autonomic behavior in K42.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Seigh03
+,author="Joseph W. {Seigh II}"
+,title="Read Copy Update"
+,Year="2003"
+,Month="March"
+,note="email correspondence"
+,annotation="
+ Described the relationship of the VM/XA passive serialization to RCU.
+"
}
@Conference{Arcangeli03
@@ -470,6 +785,27 @@ Dipankar Sarma"
,year="2003"
,month="June"
,pages="297-310"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/rcu.FREENIX.2003.06.14.pdf}
+[Viewed November 21, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ Compared updated RCU implementations for the Linux kernel, and
+ described System V IPC use of RCU, including order-of-magnitude
+ performance improvements.
+"
+}
+
+@Conference{Soules03a
+,Author="Craig A. N. Soules and Jonathan Appavoo and Kevin Hui and
+Dilma {Da Silva} and Gregory R. Ganger and Orran Krieger and
+Michael Stumm and Robert W. Wisniewski and Marc Auslander and
+Michal Ostrowski and Bryan Rosenburg and Jimi Xenidis"
+,Title="System Support for Online Reconfiguration"
+,Booktitle="Proceedings of the 2003 USENIX Annual Technical Conference"
+,Publisher="USENIX Association"
+,year="2003"
+,month="June"
+,pages="141-154"
}
@article{McKenney03a
@@ -481,6 +817,22 @@ Dipankar Sarma"
,volume="1"
,number="114"
,pages="18-26"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article/6993}
+[Viewed November 14, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ Reader-friendly intro to RCU, with the infamous old-man-and-brat
+ cartoon.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Sarma03a
+,Author="Dipankar Sarma"
+,Title="RCU low latency patches"
+,month="December"
+,year="2003"
+,note="Message ID: 20031222180114.GA2248@in.ibm.com"
+,annotation="dipankar/ct.2004.03.27/RCUll.2003.12.22.patch"
}
@techreport{Friedberg03a
@@ -489,9 +841,14 @@ Dipankar Sarma"
,institution="US Patent and Trademark Office"
,address="Washington, DC"
,year="2003"
-,number="US Patent 6,662,184 (contributed under GPL)"
+,number="US Patent 6,662,184"
,month="December"
,pages="112"
+,annotation="
+ Applies RCU to a wildcard-search Patricia tree in order to permit
+ synchronization-free lookup. RCU is used to retain removed nodes
+ for a grace period before freeing them.
+"
}
@article{McKenney04a
@@ -503,6 +860,12 @@ Dipankar Sarma"
,volume="1"
,number="118"
,pages="38-46"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.linuxjournal.com/node/7124}
+[Viewed December 26, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ Reader friendly intro to dcache and RCU.
+"
}
@Conference{McKenney04b
@@ -514,8 +877,83 @@ Dipankar Sarma"
,Address="Adelaide, Australia"
,note="Available:
\url{http://www.linux.org.au/conf/2004/abstracts.html#90}
-\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/rclock/lockperf.2004.01.17a.pdf}
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/lockperf.2004.01.17a.pdf}
[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Compares performance of RCU to that of other locking primitives
+ over a number of CPUs (x86, Opteron, Itanium, and PPC).
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Sarma04a
+,Author="Dipankar Sarma"
+,Title="{[PATCH]} {RCU} for low latency (experimental)"
+,month="March"
+,year="2004"
+,note="\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=108003746402892&w=2}"
+,annotation="Head of thread: dipankar/2004.03.23/rcu-low-lat.1.patch"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Sarma04b
+,Author="Dipankar Sarma"
+,Title="Re: {[PATCH]} {RCU} for low latency (experimental)"
+,month="March"
+,year="2004"
+,note="\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=108016474829546&w=2}"
+,annotation="dipankar/rcuth.2004.03.24/rcu-throttle.patch"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Spraul04a
+,Author="Manfred Spraul"
+,Title="[RFC] 0/5 rcu lock update"
+,month="May"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=108546407726602&w=2}
+[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Hierarchical-bitmap patch for RCU infrastructure.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Steiner04a
+,Author="Jack Steiner"
+,Title="Re: [Lse-tech] [RFC, PATCH] 1/5 rcu lock update:
+Add per-cpu batch counter"
+,month="May"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=108551764515332&w=2}
+[Viewed June 23, 2004]"
+,annotation={
+ RCU runs reasonably on a 512-CPU SGI using Manfred Spraul's patches,
+ which may be found at:
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/20/49 (split vars into cachelines)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/22/114 (cpu_quiet() patch)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/25/24 (0/5)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/25/23 (1/5)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/25/265 (works for Jack)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/25/20 (2/5)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/25/22 (3/5)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/25/19 (4/5)
+ https://lkml.org/lkml/2004/5/25/21 (5/5)
+}
+}
+
+@Conference{Sarma04c
+,Author="Dipankar Sarma and Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Making {RCU} Safe for Deep Sub-Millisecond Response
+Realtime Applications"
+,Booktitle="Proceedings of the 2004 USENIX Annual Technical Conference
+(FREENIX Track)"
+,Publisher="USENIX Association"
+,year="2004"
+,month="June"
+,pages="182-191"
+,annotation="
+ Describes and compares a number of modifications to the Linux RCU
+ implementation that make it friendly to realtime applications.
+"
}
@phdthesis{PaulEdwardMcKenneyPhD
@@ -529,17 +967,118 @@ Oregon Health and Sciences University"
,note="Available:
\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/RCUdissertation.2004.07.14e1.pdf}
[Viewed October 15, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Describes RCU implementations and presents design patterns
+ corresponding to common uses of RCU in several operating-system
+ kernels.
+"
}
-@Conference{Sarma04c
-,Author="Dipankar Sarma and Paul E. McKenney"
-,Title="Making RCU Safe for Deep Sub-Millisecond Response Realtime Applications"
-,Booktitle="Proceedings of the 2004 USENIX Annual Technical Conference
-(FREENIX Track)"
-,Publisher="USENIX Association"
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2004rcu:dereference
+,Author="Dipankar Sarma"
+,Title="{Re: RCU : Abstracted RCU dereferencing [5/5]}"
+,month="August"
,year="2004"
-,month="June"
-,pages="182-191"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2004/8/6/237}
+[Viewed June 8, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ Introduce rcu_dereference().
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{JimHouston04a
+,Author="Jim Houston"
+,Title="{[RFC\&PATCH] Alternative {RCU} implementation}"
+,month="August"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2004/8/30/87}
+[Viewed February 17, 2005]"
+,annotation="
+ Uses active code in rcu_read_lock() and rcu_read_unlock() to
+ make RCU happen, allowing RCU to function on CPUs that do not
+ receive a scheduling-clock interrupt.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{TomHart04a
+,Author="Thomas E. Hart"
+,Title="Master's Thesis: Applying Lock-free Techniques to the {Linux} Kernel"
+,month="October"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.cs.toronto.edu/~tomhart/masters_thesis.html}
+[Viewed October 15, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Proposes comparing RCU to lock-free methods for the Linux kernel.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Vaddagiri04a
+,Author="Srivatsa Vaddagiri"
+,Title="Subject: [RFC] Use RCU for tcp\_ehash lookup"
+,month="October"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?t=109395731700004&r=1&w=2}
+[Viewed October 18, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Srivatsa's RCU patch for tcp_ehash lookup.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Thirumalai04a
+,Author="Ravikiran Thirumalai"
+,Title="Subject: [patchset] Lockfree fd lookup 0 of 5"
+,month="October"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?t=109144217400003&r=1&w=2}
+[Viewed October 18, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Ravikiran's lockfree FD patch.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{Thirumalai04b
+,Author="Ravikiran Thirumalai"
+,Title="Subject: Re: [patchset] Lockfree fd lookup 0 of 5"
+,month="October"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=109152521410459&w=2}
+[Viewed October 18, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ Ravikiran's lockfree FD patch.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2004rcu:assign:pointer
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{[PATCH 1/3] RCU: \url{rcu_assign_pointer()} removal of memory barriers}"
+,month="October"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2004/10/23/241}
+[Viewed June 8, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ Introduce rcu_assign_pointer().
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{JamesMorris04a
+,Author="James Morris"
+,Title="{[PATCH 2/3] SELinux} scalability - convert {AVC} to {RCU}"
+,day="15"
+,month="November"
+,year="2004"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://marc.theaimsgroup.com/?l=linux-kernel&m=110054979416004&w=2}
+[Viewed December 10, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ James Morris posts Kaigai Kohei's patch to LKML.
+"
}
@unpublished{JamesMorris04b
@@ -550,6 +1089,85 @@ Oregon Health and Sciences University"
,note="Available:
\url{http://www.livejournal.com/users/james_morris/2153.html}
[Viewed December 10, 2004]"
+,annotation="
+ RCU helps SELinux performance. ;-) Made LWN.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulMcKenney2005RCUSemantics
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Jonathan Walpole"
+,Title="{RCU} Semantics: A First Attempt"
+,month="January"
+,year="2005"
+,day="30"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/rcu-semantics.2005.01.30a.pdf}
+[Viewed December 6, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ Early derivation of RCU semantics.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulMcKenney2005e
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Real-Time Preemption and {RCU}"
+,month="March"
+,year="2005"
+,day="17"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2005/3/17/199}
+[Viewed September 5, 2005]"
+,annotation="
+ First posting showing how RCU can be safely adapted for
+ preemptable RCU read side critical sections.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{EsbenNeilsen2005a
+,Author="Esben Neilsen"
+,Title="Re: Real-Time Preemption and {RCU}"
+,month="March"
+,year="2005"
+,day="18"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2005/3/18/122}
+[Viewed March 30, 2006]"
+,annotation="
+ Esben Neilsen suggests read-side suppression of grace-period
+ processing for crude-but-workable realtime RCU. The downside
+ is indefinite grace periods...But this is OK for experimentation
+ and testing.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{TomHart05a
+,Author="Thomas E. Hart and Paul E. McKenney and Angela Demke Brown"
+,Title="Efficient Memory Reclamation is Necessary for Fast Lock-Free
+Data Structures"
+,month="March"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{ftp://ftp.cs.toronto.edu/csrg-technical-reports/515/}
+[Viewed March 4, 2005]"
+,annotation="
+ Comparison of RCU, QBSR, and EBSR. RCU wins for read-mostly
+ workloads. ;-)
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{JonCorbet2005DeprecateSyncKernel
+,Author="Jonathan Corbet"
+,Title="API change: synchronize_kernel() deprecated"
+,month="May"
+,day="3"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lwn.net/Articles/134484/}
+[Viewed May 3, 2005]"
+,annotation="
+ Jon Corbet describes deprecation of synchronize_kernel()
+ in favor of synchronize_rcu() and synchronize_sched().
+"
}
@unpublished{PaulMcKenney05a
@@ -568,7 +1186,7 @@ Oregon Health and Sciences University"
@conference{PaulMcKenney05b
,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Dipankar Sarma"
-,Title="Towards Hard Realtime Response from the Linux Kernel on SMP Hardware"
+,Title="Towards Hard Realtime Response from the {Linux} Kernel on {SMP} Hardware"
,Booktitle="linux.conf.au 2005"
,month="April"
,year="2005"
@@ -578,6 +1196,103 @@ Oregon Health and Sciences University"
[Viewed May 13, 2005]"
,annotation="
Realtime turns into making RCU yet more realtime friendly.
+ http://lca2005.linux.org.au/Papers/Paul%20McKenney/Towards%20Hard%20Realtime%20Response%20from%20the%20Linux%20Kernel/LKS.2005.04.22a.pdf
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenneyHomePage
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{Paul} {E.} {McKenney}"
+,month="May"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/}
+[Viewed May 25, 2005]"
+,annotation="
+ Paul McKenney's home page.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenneyRCUPage
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Read-Copy Update {(RCU)}"
+,month="May"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU}
+[Viewed May 25, 2005]"
+,annotation="
+ Paul McKenney's RCU page.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{JosephSeigh2005a
+,Author="Joseph Seigh"
+,Title="{RCU}+{SMR} (hazard pointers)"
+,month="July"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Personal communication"
+,annotation="
+ Joe Seigh announcing his atomic-ptr-plus project.
+ http://sourceforge.net/projects/atomic-ptr-plus/
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{JosephSeigh2005b
+,Author="Joseph Seigh"
+,Title="Lock-free synchronization primitives"
+,month="July"
+,day="6"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/atomic-ptr-plus/}
+[Viewed August 8, 2005]"
+,annotation="
+ Joe Seigh's atomic-ptr-plus project.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulMcKenney2005c
+,Author="Paul E.McKenney"
+,Title="{[RFC,PATCH] RCU} and {CONFIG\_PREEMPT\_RT} sane patch"
+,month="August"
+,day="1"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2005/8/1/155}
+[Viewed March 14, 2006]"
+,annotation="
+ First operating counter-based realtime RCU patch posted to LKML.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulMcKenney2005d
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Re: [Fwd: Re: [patch] Real-Time Preemption, -RT-2.6.13-rc4-V0.7.52-01]"
+,month="August"
+,day="8"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2005/8/8/108}
+[Viewed March 14, 2006]"
+,annotation="
+ First operating counter-based realtime RCU patch posted to LKML,
+ but fixed so that various unusual combinations of configuration
+ parameters all function properly.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulMcKenney2005rcutorture
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{[PATCH]} {RCU} torture testing"
+,month="October"
+,day="1"
+,year="2005"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2005/10/1/70}
+[Viewed March 14, 2006]"
+,annotation="
+ First rcutorture patch.
"
}
@@ -591,22 +1306,39 @@ Distributed Processing Symposium"
,year="2006"
,day="25-29"
,address="Rhodes, Greece"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/hart_ipdps06.pdf}
+[Viewed April 28, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Compares QSBR, HPBR, EBR, and lock-free reference counting.
+ http://www.cs.toronto.edu/~tomhart/perflab/ipdps06.tgz
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{NickPiggin2006radixtree
+,Author="Nick Piggin"
+,Title="[patch 3/3] radix-tree: {RCU} lockless readside"
+,month="June"
+,day="20"
+,year="2006"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2006/6/20/238}
+[Viewed March 25, 2008]"
,annotation="
- Compares QSBR (AKA "classic RCU"), HPBR, EBR, and lock-free
- reference counting.
+ RCU-protected radix tree.
"
}
@Conference{PaulEMcKenney2006b
,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Dipankar Sarma and Ingo Molnar and
Suparna Bhattacharya"
-,Title="Extending RCU for Realtime and Embedded Workloads"
+,Title="Extending {RCU} for Realtime and Embedded Workloads"
,Booktitle="{Ottawa Linux Symposium}"
,Month="July"
,Year="2006"
,pages="v2 123-138"
,note="Available:
-\url{http://www.linuxsymposium.org/2006/index_2006.php}
+\url{http://www.linuxsymposium.org/2006/view_abstract.php?content_key=184}
\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/OLSrtRCU.2006.08.11a.pdf}
[Viewed January 1, 2007]"
,annotation="
@@ -614,6 +1346,37 @@ Suparna Bhattacharya"
"
}
+@unpublished{WikipediaRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Chris Purcell and Algae and Ben Schumin and
+Gaius Cornelius and Qwertyus and Neil Conway and Sbw and Blainster and
+Canis Rufus and Zoicon5 and Anome and Hal Eisen"
+,Title="Read-Copy Update"
+,month="July"
+,day="8"
+,year="2006"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Read-copy-update}
+[Viewed August 21, 2006]"
+,annotation="
+ Wikipedia RCU page as of July 8 2006.
+"
+}
+
+@Conference{NickPiggin2006LocklessPageCache
+,Author="Nick Piggin"
+,Title="A Lockless Pagecache in Linux---Introduction, Progress, Performance"
+,Booktitle="{Ottawa Linux Symposium}"
+,Month="July"
+,Year="2006"
+,pages="v2 249-254"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.linuxsymposium.org/2006/view_abstract.php?content_key=184}
+[Viewed January 11, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ Uses RCU-protected radix tree for a lockless page cache.
+"
+}
+
@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2006c
,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
,Title="Sleepable {RCU}"
@@ -637,29 +1400,301 @@ Revised:
,day="18"
,year="2006"
,note="Available:
-\url{http://www.nada.kth.se/~snilsson/public/papers/trash/trash.pdf}
-[Viewed February 24, 2007]"
+\url{http://www.nada.kth.se/~snilsson/publications/TRASH/trash.pdf}
+[Viewed March 4, 2011]"
,annotation="
RCU-protected dynamic trie-hash combination.
"
}
-@unpublished{ThomasEHart2007a
-,Author="Thomas E. Hart and Paul E. McKenney and Angela Demke Brown and Jonathan Walpole"
-,Title="Performance of memory reclamation for lockless synchronization"
-,journal="J. Parallel Distrib. Comput."
+@unpublished{ChristophHellwig2006RCU2SRCU
+,Author="Christoph Hellwig"
+,Title="Re: {[-mm PATCH 1/4]} {RCU}: split classic rcu"
+,month="September"
+,day="28"
+,year="2006"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2006/9/28/160}
+[Viewed March 27, 2008]"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenneyRCUusagePage
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{RCU} {Linux} Usage"
+,month="October"
+,year="2006"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/linuxusage.html}
+[Viewed January 14, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ Paul McKenney's RCU page showing graphs plotting Linux-kernel
+ usage of RCU.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenneyRCUusageRawDataPage
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Read-Copy Update {(RCU)} Usage in {Linux} Kernel"
+,month="October"
+,year="2006"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/linuxusage/rculocktab.html}
+[Viewed January 14, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ Paul McKenney's RCU page showing Linux usage of RCU in tabular
+ form, with links to corresponding cscope databases.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{GauthamShenoy2006RCUrwlock
+,Author="Gautham R. Shenoy"
+,Title="[PATCH 4/5] lock\_cpu\_hotplug: Redesign - Lightweight implementation of lock\_cpu\_hotplug"
+,month="October"
+,year="2006"
+,day=26
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2006/10/26/73}
+[Viewed January 26, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ RCU-based reader-writer lock that allows readers to proceed with
+ no memory barriers or atomic instruction in absence of writers.
+ If writer do show up, readers must of course wait as required by
+ the semantics of reader-writer locking. This is a recursive
+ lock.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{JensAxboe2006SlowSRCU
+,Author="Jens Axboe"
+,Title="Re: [patch] cpufreq: mark \url{cpufreq_tsc()} as
+\url{core_initcall_sync}"
+,month="November"
+,year="2006"
+,day=17
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2006/11/17/56}
+[Viewed May 28, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ SRCU's grace periods are too slow for Jens, even after a
+ factor-of-three speedup.
+ Sped-up version of SRCU at http://lkml.org/lkml/2006/11/17/359.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{OlegNesterov2006QRCU
+,Author="Oleg Nesterov"
+,Title="Re: [patch] cpufreq: mark {\tt cpufreq\_tsc()} as
+{\tt core\_initcall\_sync}"
+,month="November"
+,year="2006"
+,day=19
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2006/11/19/69}
+[Viewed May 28, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ First cut of QRCU. Expanded/corrected versions followed.
+ Used to be OlegNesterov2007QRCU, now time-corrected.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{OlegNesterov2006aQRCU
+,Author="Oleg Nesterov"
+,Title="Re: [RFC, PATCH 1/2] qrcu: {"quick"} srcu implementation"
+,month="November"
+,year="2006"
+,day=30
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2006/11/29/330}
+[Viewed November 26, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Expanded/corrected version of QRCU.
+ Used to be OlegNesterov2007aQRCU, now time-corrected.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{EvgeniyPolyakov2006RCUslowdown
+,Author="Evgeniy Polyakov"
+,Title="Badness in postponing work"
+,month="December"
+,year="2006"
+,day=05
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.ioremap.net/node/41}
+[Viewed October 28, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Using RCU as a pure delay leads to a 2.5x slowdown in skbs in
+ the Linux kernel.
+"
+}
+
+@inproceedings{ChrisMatthews2006ClusteredObjectsRCU
+,author = {Matthews, Chris and Coady, Yvonne and Appavoo, Jonathan}
+,title = {Portability events: a programming model for scalable system infrastructures}
+,booktitle = {PLOS '06: Proceedings of the 3rd workshop on Programming languages and operating systems}
+,year = {2006}
+,isbn = {1-59593-577-0}
+,pages = {11}
+,location = {San Jose, California}
+,doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/1215995.1216006}
+,publisher = {ACM}
+,address = {New York, NY, USA}
+,annotation={
+ Uses K42's RCU-like functionality to manage clustered-object
+ lifetimes.
+}}
+
+@article{DilmaDaSilva2006K42
+,author = {Silva, Dilma Da and Krieger, Orran and Wisniewski, Robert W. and Waterland, Amos and Tam, David and Baumann, Andrew}
+,title = {K42: an infrastructure for operating system research}
+,journal = {SIGOPS Oper. Syst. Rev.}
+,volume = {40}
+,number = {2}
+,year = {2006}
+,issn = {0163-5980}
+,pages = {34--42}
+,doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/1131322.1131333}
+,publisher = {ACM}
+,address = {New York, NY, USA}
+,annotation={
+ Describes relationship of K42 generations to RCU.
+}}
+
+# CoreyMinyard2007list_splice_rcu
+@unpublished{CoreyMinyard2007list:splice:rcu
+,Author="Corey Minyard and Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{[PATCH]} add an {RCU} version of list splicing"
+,month="January"
+,year="2007"
+,day=3
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2007/1/3/112}
+[Viewed May 28, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ Patch for list_splice_rcu().
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007rcubarrier
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{RCU} and Unloadable Modules"
+,month="January"
+,day="14"
+,year="2007"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lwn.net/Articles/217484/}
+[Viewed November 22, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ LWN article introducing the rcu_barrier() primitive.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PeterZijlstra2007SyncBarrier
+,Author="Peter Zijlstra and Ingo Molnar"
+,Title="{[PATCH 3/7]} barrier: a scalable synchonisation barrier"
+,month="January"
+,year="2007"
+,day=28
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2007/1/28/34}
+[Viewed March 27, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ RCU-like implementation for frequent updaters and rare readers(!).
+ Subsumed into QRCU. Maybe...
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007BoostRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Priority-Boosting {RCU} Read-Side Critical Sections"
+,month="February"
+,day="5"
+,year="2007"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lwn.net/Articles/220677/}
+Revised:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/RCUbooststate.2007.04.16a.pdf}
+[Viewed September 7, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ LWN article introducing RCU priority boosting.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulMcKenney2007QRCUpatch
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{[PATCH]} {QRCU} with lockless fastpath"
+,month="February"
+,year="2007"
+,day=24
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2007/2/25/18}
+[Viewed March 27, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Patch for QRCU supplying lock-free fast path.
+"
+}
+
+@article{JonathanAppavoo2007K42RCU
+,author = {Appavoo, Jonathan and Silva, Dilma Da and Krieger, Orran and Auslander, Marc and Ostrowski, Michal and Rosenburg, Bryan and Waterland, Amos and Wisniewski, Robert W. and Xenidis, Jimi and Stumm, Michael and Soares, Livio}
+,title = {Experience distributing objects in an SMMP OS}
+,journal = {ACM Trans. Comput. Syst.}
+,volume = {25}
+,number = {3}
+,year = {2007}
+,issn = {0734-2071}
+,pages = {6/1--6/52}
+,doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/1275517.1275518}
+,publisher = {ACM}
+,address = {New York, NY, USA}
+,annotation={
+ Role of RCU in K42.
+}}
+
+@conference{RobertOlsson2007Trash
+,Author="Robert Olsson and Stefan Nilsson"
+,Title="{TRASH}: A dynamic {LC}-trie and hash data structure"
+,booktitle="Workshop on High Performance Switching and Routing (HPSR'07)"
+,month="May"
+,year="2007"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://ieeexplore.ieee.org/xpl/freeabs_all.jsp?arnumber=4281239}
+[Viewed October 1, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ RCU-protected dynamic trie-hash combination.
+"
+}
+
+@conference{PeterZijlstra2007ConcurrentPagecacheRCU
+,Author="Peter Zijlstra"
+,Title="Concurrent Pagecache"
+,Booktitle="Linux Symposium"
+,month="June"
,year="2007"
-,note="To appear in J. Parallel Distrib. Comput.
- \url{doi=10.1016/j.jpdc.2007.04.010}"
+,address="Ottawa, Canada"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://ols.108.redhat.com/2007/Reprints/zijlstra-Reprint.pdf}
+[Viewed April 14, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Page-cache modifications permitting RCU readers and concurrent
+ updates.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007whatisRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="What is {RCU}?"
+,year="2007"
+,month="07"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/whatisRCU.html}
+[Viewed July 6, 2007]"
,annotation={
- Compares QSBR (AKA "classic RCU"), HPBR, EBR, and lock-free
- reference counting. Journal version of ThomasEHart2006a.
+ Describes RCU in Linux kernel.
}
}
@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007QRCUspin
,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
-,Title="Using Promela and Spin to verify parallel algorithms"
+,Title="Using {Promela} and {Spin} to verify parallel algorithms"
,month="August"
,day="1"
,year="2007"
@@ -669,6 +1704,50 @@ Revised:
,annotation="
LWN article describing Promela and spin, and also using Oleg
Nesterov's QRCU as an example (with Paul McKenney's fastpath).
+ Merged patch at: http://lkml.org/lkml/2007/2/25/18
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007WG21DDOatomics
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Hans-J. Boehm and Lawrence Crowl"
+,Title="C++ Data-Dependency Ordering: Atomics and Memory Model"
+,month="August"
+,day="3"
+,year="2007"
+,note="Preprint:
+\url{http://open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/papers/2008/n2664.htm}
+[Viewed December 7, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ RCU for C++, parts 1 and 2.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007WG21DDOannotation
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Lawrence Crowl"
+,Title="C++ Data-Dependency Ordering: Function Annotation"
+,month="September"
+,day="18"
+,year="2008"
+,note="Preprint:
+\url{http://open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/papers/2008/n2782.htm}
+[Viewed December 7, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ RCU for C++, part 2, updated many times.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007PreemptibleRCUPatch
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="[PATCH RFC 0/9] {RCU}: Preemptible {RCU}"
+,month="September"
+,day="10"
+,year="2007"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2007/9/10/213}
+[Viewed October 25, 2007]"
+,annotation="
+ Final patch for preemptable RCU to -rt. (Later patches were
+ to mainline, eventually incorporated.)
"
}
@@ -686,10 +1765,46 @@ Revised:
"
}
+@article{ThomasEHart2007a
+,Author="Thomas E. Hart and Paul E. McKenney and Angela Demke Brown and Jonathan Walpole"
+,Title="Performance of memory reclamation for lockless synchronization"
+,journal="J. Parallel Distrib. Comput."
+,volume={67}
+,number="12"
+,year="2007"
+,issn="0743-7315"
+,pages="1270--1285"
+,doi="http://dx.doi.org/10.1016/j.jpdc.2007.04.010"
+,publisher="Academic Press, Inc."
+,address="Orlando, FL, USA"
+,annotation={
+ Compares QSBR, HPBR, EBR, and lock-free reference counting.
+ Journal version of ThomasEHart2006a.
+}
+}
+
+@unpublished{MathieuDesnoyers2007call:rcu:schedNeeded
+,Author="Mathieu Desnoyers"
+,Title="Re: [patch 1/2] {Linux} Kernel Markers - Support Multiple Probes"
+,month="December"
+,day="20"
+,year="2007"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2007/12/20/244}
+[Viewed March 27, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Request for call_rcu_sched() and rcu_barrier_sched().
+"
+}
+
+
########################################################################
#
# "What is RCU?" LWN series.
#
+# http://lwn.net/Articles/262464/ (What is RCU, Fundamentally?)
+# http://lwn.net/Articles/263130/ (What is RCU's Usage?)
+# http://lwn.net/Articles/264090/ (What is RCU's API?)
@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2007WhatIsRCUFundamentally
,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Jonathan Walpole"
@@ -723,7 +1838,7 @@ Revised:
3. RCU is a Bulk Reference-Counting Mechanism
4. RCU is a Poor Man's Garbage Collector
5. RCU is a Way of Providing Existence Guarantees
- 6. RCU is a Way of Waiting for Things to Finish
+ 6. RCU is a Way of Waiting for Things to Finish
"
}
@@ -747,20 +1862,96 @@ Revised:
#
########################################################################
+
+@unpublished{SteveRostedt2008dyntickRCUpatch
+,Author="Steven Rostedt and Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="{[PATCH]} add support for dynamic ticks and preempt rcu"
+,month="January"
+,day="29"
+,year="2008"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2008/1/29/208}
+[Viewed March 27, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Patch that prevents preemptible RCU from unnecessarily waking
+ up dynticks-idle CPUs.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2008LKMLDependencyOrdering
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Re: [PATCH 02/22 -v7] Add basic support for gcc profiler instrumentation"
+,month="February"
+,day="1"
+,year="2008"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2008/2/2/255}
+[Viewed October 18, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Explanation of compilers violating dependency ordering.
+"
+}
+
+@Conference{PaulEMcKenney2008Beijing
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Introducing Technology Into {Linux} Or:
+Introducing your technology Into {Linux} will require introducing a
+lot of {Linux} into your technology!!!"
+,Booktitle="2008 Linux Developer Symposium - China"
+,Publisher="OSS China"
+,Month="February"
+,Year="2008"
+,Address="Beijing, China"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/TechIntroLinux.2008.02.19a.pdf}
+[Viewed August 12, 2008]"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2008dynticksRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney and Steven Rostedt"
+,Title="Integrating and Validating dynticks and Preemptable RCU"
+,month="April"
+,day="24"
+,year="2008"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lwn.net/Articles/279077/}
+[Viewed April 24, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Describes use of Promela and Spin to validate (and fix!) the
+ dynticks/RCU interface.
+"
+}
+
@article{DinakarGuniguntala2008IBMSysJ
,author="D. Guniguntala and P. E. McKenney and J. Triplett and J. Walpole"
,title="The read-copy-update mechanism for supporting real-time applications on shared-memory multiprocessor systems with {Linux}"
,Year="2008"
-,Month="April"
+,Month="April-June"
,journal="IBM Systems Journal"
,volume="47"
,number="2"
-,pages="@@-@@"
+,pages="221-236"
,annotation="
RCU, realtime RCU, sleepable RCU, performance.
"
}
+@unpublished{LaiJiangshan2008NewClassicAlgorithm
+,Author="Lai Jiangshan"
+,Title="[{RFC}][{PATCH}] rcu classic: new algorithm for callbacks-processing"
+,month="June"
+,day="3"
+,year="2008"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2008/6/2/539}
+[Viewed December 10, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Updated RCU classic algorithm. Introduced multi-tailed list
+ for RCU callbacks and also pulling common code into
+ __call_rcu().
+"
+}
+
@article{PaulEMcKenney2008RCUOSR
,author="Paul E. McKenney and Jonathan Walpole"
,title="Introducing technology into the {Linux} kernel: a case study"
@@ -778,6 +1969,52 @@ Revised:
}
}
+@unpublished{ManfredSpraul2008StateMachineRCU
+,Author="Manfred Spraul"
+,Title="[{RFC}, {PATCH}] state machine based rcu"
+,month="August"
+,day="21"
+,year="2008"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2008/8/21/336}
+[Viewed December 8, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ State-based RCU. One key thing that this patch does is to
+ separate the dynticks handling of NMIs and IRQs.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{ManfredSpraul2008dyntickIRQNMI
+,Author="Manfred Spraul"
+,Title="Re: [{RFC}, {PATCH}] v4 scalable classic {RCU} implementation"
+,month="September"
+,day="6"
+,year="2008"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2008/9/6/86}
+[Viewed December 8, 2008]"
+,annotation="
+ Manfred notes a fix required to my attempt to separate irq
+ and NMI processing for hierarchical RCU's dynticks interface.
+"
+}
+
+@techreport{PaulEMcKenney2008cyclicRCU
+,author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,title="Efficient Support of Consistent Cyclic Search With Read-Copy Update"
+,institution="US Patent and Trademark Office"
+,address="Washington, DC"
+,year="2008"
+,number="US Patent 7,426,511"
+,month="September"
+,pages="23"
+,annotation="
+ Maintains an additional level of indirection to allow
+ readers to confine themselves to the desired snapshot of the
+ data structure. Only permits one update at a time.
+"
+}
+
@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2008HierarchicalRCU
,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
,Title="Hierarchical {RCU}"
@@ -793,6 +2030,21 @@ Revised:
"
}
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2009BloatwatchRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Re: [PATCH fyi] RCU: the bloatwatch edition"
+,month="January"
+,day="14"
+,year="2009"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2009/1/14/449}
+[Viewed January 15, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ Small-footprint implementation of RCU for uniprocessor
+ embedded applications -- and also for exposition purposes.
+"
+}
+
@conference{PaulEMcKenney2009MaliciousURCU
,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
,Title="Using a Malicious User-Level {RCU} to Torture {RCU}-Based Algorithms"
@@ -816,15 +2068,17 @@ Revised:
,year="2009"
,note="Available:
\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2009/2/5/572}
-\url{git://lttng.org/userspace-rcu.git}
+\url{http://lttng.org/urcu}
[Viewed February 20, 2009]"
,annotation="
Mathieu Desnoyers's user-space RCU implementation.
git://lttng.org/userspace-rcu.git
+ http://lttng.org/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=userspace-rcu.git
+ http://lttng.org/urcu
"
}
-@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2009BloatWatchRCU
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2009LWNBloatWatchRCU
,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
,Title="{RCU}: The {Bloatwatch} Edition"
,month="March"
@@ -852,14 +2106,29 @@ Revised:
"
}
-@unpublished{JoshTriplett2009RPHash
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2009fastRTRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="[{PATCH} {RFC} -tip 0/4] {RCU} cleanups and simplified preemptable {RCU}"
+,month="July"
+,day="23"
+,year="2009"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2009/7/23/294}
+[Viewed August 15, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ First posting of simple and fast preemptable RCU.
+"
+}
+
+@InProceedings{JoshTriplett2009RPHash
,Author="Josh Triplett"
,Title="Scalable concurrent hash tables via relativistic programming"
,month="September"
,year="2009"
-,note="Linux Plumbers Conference presentation"
+,booktitle="Linux Plumbers Conference 2009"
,annotation="
RP fun with hash tables.
+ See also JoshTriplett2010RPHash
"
}
@@ -872,4 +2141,323 @@ Revised:
,note="Available:
\url{http://www.lttng.org/pub/thesis/desnoyers-dissertation-2009-12.pdf}
[Viewed December 9, 2009]"
+,annotation={
+ Chapter 6 (page 97) covers user-level RCU.
+}
+}
+
+@unpublished{RelativisticProgrammingWiki
+,Author="Josh Triplett and Paul E. McKenney and Jonathan Walpole"
+,Title="Relativistic Programming"
+,month="September"
+,year="2009"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://wiki.cs.pdx.edu/rp/}
+[Viewed December 9, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ Main Relativistic Programming Wiki.
+"
+}
+
+@conference{PaulEMcKenney2009DeterministicRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Deterministic Synchronization in Multicore Systems: the Role of {RCU}"
+,Booktitle="Eleventh Real Time Linux Workshop"
+,month="September"
+,year="2009"
+,address="Dresden, Germany"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/realtime/paper/DetSyncRCU.2009.08.18a.pdf}
+[Viewed January 14, 2009]"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2009HuntingHeisenbugs
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Hunting Heisenbugs"
+,month="November"
+,year="2009"
+,day="1"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://paulmck.livejournal.com/14639.html}
+[Viewed June 4, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ Day-one bug in Tree RCU that took forever to track down.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{MathieuDesnoyers2009defer:rcu
+,Author="Mathieu Desnoyers"
+,Title="Kernel RCU: shrink the size of the struct rcu\_head"
+,month="December"
+,year="2009"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lkml.org/lkml/2009/10/18/129}
+[Viewed December 29, 2009]"
+,annotation="
+ Mathieu proposed defer_rcu() with fixed-size per-thread pool
+ of RCU callbacks.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{MathieuDesnoyers2009VerifPrePub
+,Author="Mathieu Desnoyers and Paul E. McKenney and Michel R. Dagenais"
+,Title="Multi-Core Systems Modeling for Formal Verification of Parallel Algorithms"
+,month="December"
+,year="2009"
+,note="Submitted to IEEE TPDS"
+,annotation="
+ OOMem model for Mathieu's user-level RCU mechanical proof of
+ correctness.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{MathieuDesnoyers2009URCUPrePub
+,Author="Mathieu Desnoyers and Paul E. McKenney and Alan Stern and Michel R. Dagenais and Jonathan Walpole"
+,Title="User-Level Implementations of Read-Copy Update"
+,month="December"
+,year="2010"
+,url=\url{http://www.computer.org/csdl/trans/td/2012/02/ttd2012020375-abs.html}
+,annotation="
+ RCU overview, desiderata, semi-formal semantics, user-level RCU
+ usage scenarios, three classes of RCU implementation, wait-free
+ RCU updates, RCU grace-period batching, update overhead,
+ http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/urcu-main-accepted.2011.08.30a.pdf
+ http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/urcu-supp-accepted.2011.08.30a.pdf
+ Superseded by MathieuDesnoyers2012URCU.
+"
+}
+
+@inproceedings{HariKannan2009DynamicAnalysisRCU
+,author = {Kannan, Hari}
+,title = {Ordering decoupled metadata accesses in multiprocessors}
+,booktitle = {MICRO 42: Proceedings of the 42nd Annual IEEE/ACM International Symposium on Microarchitecture}
+,year = {2009}
+,isbn = {978-1-60558-798-1}
+,pages = {381--390}
+,location = {New York, New York}
+,doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/1669112.1669161}
+,publisher = {ACM}
+,address = {New York, NY, USA}
+,annotation={
+ Uses RCU to protect metadata used in dynamic analysis.
+}}
+
+@conference{PaulEMcKenney2010SimpleOptRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Simplicity Through Optimization"
+,Booktitle="linux.conf.au 2010"
+,month="January"
+,year="2010"
+,address="Wellington, New Zealand"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/SimplicityThruOptimization.2010.01.21f.pdf}
+[Viewed October 10, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ TREE_PREEMPT_RCU optimizations greatly simplified the old
+ PREEMPT_RCU implementation.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2010LockdepRCU
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="Lockdep-{RCU}"
+,month="February"
+,year="2010"
+,day="1"
+,note="Available:
+\url{https://lwn.net/Articles/371986/}
+[Viewed June 4, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ CONFIG_PROVE_RCU, or at least an early version.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{AviKivity2010KVM2RCU
+,Author="Avi Kivity"
+,Title="[{PATCH} 37/40] {KVM}: Bump maximum vcpu count to 64"
+,month="February"
+,year="2010"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://www.mail-archive.com/kvm@vger.kernel.org/msg28640.html}
+[Viewed March 20, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ Use of RCU permits KVM to increase the size of guest OSes from
+ 16 CPUs to 64 CPUs.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{HerbertXu2010RCUResizeHash
+,Author="Herbert Xu"
+,Title="bridge: Add core IGMP snooping support"
+,month="February"
+,year="2010"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://kerneltrap.com/mailarchive/linux-netdev/2010/2/26/6270589}
+[Viewed March 20, 2011]"
+,annotation={
+ Use a pair of list_head structures to support RCU-protected
+ resizable hash tables.
+}}
+
+@article{JoshTriplett2010RPHash
+,author="Josh Triplett and Paul E. McKenney and Jonathan Walpole"
+,title="Scalable Concurrent Hash Tables via Relativistic Programming"
+,journal="ACM Operating Systems Review"
+,year=2010
+,volume=44
+,number=3
+,month="July"
+,annotation={
+ RP fun with hash tables.
+ http://portal.acm.org/citation.cfm?id=1842733.1842750
+}}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2010RCUAPI
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="The {RCU} {API}, 2010 Edition"
+,month="December"
+,day="8"
+,year="2010"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lwn.net/Articles/418853/}
+[Viewed December 8, 2010]"
+,annotation="
+ Includes updated software-engineering features.
+"
+}
+
+@mastersthesis{AndrejPodzimek2010masters
+,author="Andrej Podzimek"
+,title="Read-Copy-Update for OpenSolaris"
+,school="Charles University in Prague"
+,year="2010"
+,note="Available:
+\url{https://andrej.podzimek.org/thesis.pdf}
+[Viewed January 31, 2011]"
+,annotation={
+ Reviews RCU implementations and creates a few for OpenSolaris.
+ Drives quiescent-state detection from RCU read-side primitives,
+ in a manner roughly similar to that of Jim Houston.
+}}
+
+@unpublished{LinusTorvalds2011Linux2:6:38:rc1:NPigginVFS
+,Author="Linus Torvalds"
+,Title="Linux 2.6.38-rc1"
+,month="January"
+,year="2011"
+,note="Available:
+\url{https://lkml.org/lkml/2011/1/18/322}
+[Viewed March 4, 2011]"
+,annotation={
+ "The RCU-based name lookup is at the other end of the spectrum - the
+ absolute anti-gimmick. It's some seriously good stuff, and gets rid of
+ the last main global lock that really tends to hurt some kernel loads.
+ The dentry lock is no longer a big serializing issue. What's really
+ nice about it is that it actually improves performance a lot even for
+ single-threaded loads (on an SMP kernel), because it gets rid of some
+ of the most expensive parts of path component lookup, which was the
+ d_lock on every component lookup. So I'm seeing improvements of 30-50%
+ on some seriously pathname-lookup intensive loads."
+}}
+
+@techreport{JoshTriplett2011RPScalableCorrectOrdering
+,author = {Josh Triplett and Philip W. Howard and Paul E. McKenney and Jonathan Walpole}
+,title = {Scalable Correct Memory Ordering via Relativistic Programming}
+,year = {2011}
+,number = {11-03}
+,institution = {Portland State University}
+,note = {\url{http://www.cs.pdx.edu/pdfs/tr1103.pdf}}
+}
+
+@inproceedings{PhilHoward2011RCUTMRBTree
+,author = {Philip W. Howard and Jonathan Walpole}
+,title = {A Relativistic Enhancement to Software Transactional Memory}
+,booktitle = {Proceedings of the 3rd USENIX conference on Hot topics in parallelism}
+,series = {HotPar'11}
+,year = {2011}
+,location = {Berkeley, CA}
+,pages = {1--6}
+,numpages = {6}
+,url = {http://www.usenix.org/event/hotpar11/tech/final_files/Howard.pdf}
+,publisher = {USENIX Association}
+,address = {Berkeley, CA, USA}
+}
+
+@techreport{PaulEMcKenney2011cyclicparallelRCU
+,author="Paul E. McKenney and Jonathan Walpole"
+,title="Efficient Support of Consistent Cyclic Search With Read-Copy Update and Parallel Updates"
+,institution="US Patent and Trademark Office"
+,address="Washington, DC"
+,year="2011"
+,number="US Patent 7,953,778"
+,month="May"
+,pages="34"
+,annotation="
+ Maintains an array of generation numbers to track in-flight
+ updates and keeps an additional level of indirection to allow
+ readers to confine themselves to the desired snapshot of the
+ data structure.
+"
+}
+
+@inproceedings{Triplett:2011:RPHash
+,author = {Triplett, Josh and McKenney, Paul E. and Walpole, Jonathan}
+,title = {Resizable, Scalable, Concurrent Hash Tables via Relativistic Programming}
+,booktitle = {Proceedings of the 2011 USENIX Annual Technical Conference}
+,month = {June}
+,year = {2011}
+,pages = {145--158}
+,numpages = {14}
+,url={http://www.usenix.org/event/atc11/tech/final_files/atc11_proceedings.pdf}
+,publisher = {The USENIX Association}
+,address = {Portland, OR USA}
+}
+
+@unpublished{PaulEMcKenney2011RCU3.0trainwreck
+,Author="Paul E. McKenney"
+,Title="3.0 and {RCU:} what went wrong"
+,month="July"
+,day="27"
+,year="2011"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lwn.net/Articles/453002/}
+[Viewed July 27, 2011]"
+,annotation="
+ Analysis of the RCU trainwreck in Linux kernel 3.0.
+"
+}
+
+@unpublished{NeilBrown2011MeetTheLockers
+,Author="Neil Brown"
+,Title="Meet the Lockers"
+,month="August"
+,day="3"
+,year="2011"
+,note="Available:
+\url{http://lwn.net/Articles/453685/}
+[Viewed September 2, 2011]"
+,annotation="
+ The Locker family as an analogy for locking, reference counting,
+ RCU, and seqlock.
+"
+}
+
+@article{MathieuDesnoyers2012URCU
+,Author="Mathieu Desnoyers and Paul E. McKenney and Alan Stern and Michel R. Dagenais and Jonathan Walpole"
+,Title="User-Level Implementations of Read-Copy Update"
+,journal="IEEE Transactions on Parallel and Distributed Systems"
+,volume={23}
+,year="2012"
+,issn="1045-9219"
+,pages="375-382"
+,doi="http://doi.ieeecomputersociety.org/10.1109/TPDS.2011.159"
+,publisher="IEEE Computer Society"
+,address="Los Alamitos, CA, USA"
+,annotation={
+ RCU overview, desiderata, semi-formal semantics, user-level RCU
+ usage scenarios, three classes of RCU implementation, wait-free
+ RCU updates, RCU grace-period batching, update overhead,
+ http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/urcu-main-accepted.2011.08.30a.pdf
+ http://www.rdrop.com/users/paulmck/RCU/urcu-supp-accepted.2011.08.30a.pdf
+}
}
diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/checklist.txt b/Documentation/RCU/checklist.txt
index bff2d8be1e1..5c8d7496809 100644
--- a/Documentation/RCU/checklist.txt
+++ b/Documentation/RCU/checklist.txt
@@ -180,6 +180,20 @@ over a rather long period of time, but improvements are always welcome!
operations that would not normally be undertaken while a real-time
workload is running.
+ In particular, if you find yourself invoking one of the expedited
+ primitives repeatedly in a loop, please do everyone a favor:
+ Restructure your code so that it batches the updates, allowing
+ a single non-expedited primitive to cover the entire batch.
+ This will very likely be faster than the loop containing the
+ expedited primitive, and will be much much easier on the rest
+ of the system, especially to real-time workloads running on
+ the rest of the system.
+
+ In addition, it is illegal to call the expedited forms from
+ a CPU-hotplug notifier, or while holding a lock that is acquired
+ by a CPU-hotplug notifier. Failing to observe this restriction
+ will result in deadlock.
+
7. If the updater uses call_rcu() or synchronize_rcu(), then the
corresponding readers must use rcu_read_lock() and
rcu_read_unlock(). If the updater uses call_rcu_bh() or
diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt b/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt
index 083d88cbc08..523364e4e1f 100644
--- a/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt
+++ b/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt
@@ -12,14 +12,38 @@ CONFIG_RCU_CPU_STALL_TIMEOUT
This kernel configuration parameter defines the period of time
that RCU will wait from the beginning of a grace period until it
issues an RCU CPU stall warning. This time period is normally
- ten seconds.
+ sixty seconds.
-RCU_SECONDS_TILL_STALL_RECHECK
+ This configuration parameter may be changed at runtime via the
+ /sys/module/rcutree/parameters/rcu_cpu_stall_timeout, however
+ this parameter is checked only at the beginning of a cycle.
+ So if you are 30 seconds into a 70-second stall, setting this
+ sysfs parameter to (say) five will shorten the timeout for the
+ -next- stall, or the following warning for the current stall
+ (assuming the stall lasts long enough). It will not affect the
+ timing of the next warning for the current stall.
- This macro defines the period of time that RCU will wait after
- issuing a stall warning until it issues another stall warning
- for the same stall. This time period is normally set to three
- times the check interval plus thirty seconds.
+ Stall-warning messages may be enabled and disabled completely via
+ /sys/module/rcutree/parameters/rcu_cpu_stall_suppress.
+
+CONFIG_RCU_CPU_STALL_VERBOSE
+
+ This kernel configuration parameter causes the stall warning to
+ also dump the stacks of any tasks that are blocking the current
+ RCU-preempt grace period.
+
+RCU_CPU_STALL_INFO
+
+ This kernel configuration parameter causes the stall warning to
+ print out additional per-CPU diagnostic information, including
+ information on scheduling-clock ticks and RCU's idle-CPU tracking.
+
+RCU_STALL_DELAY_DELTA
+
+ Although the lockdep facility is extremely useful, it does add
+ some overhead. Therefore, under CONFIG_PROVE_RCU, the
+ RCU_STALL_DELAY_DELTA macro allows five extra seconds before
+ giving an RCU CPU stall warning message.
RCU_STALL_RAT_DELAY
@@ -64,6 +88,54 @@ INFO: rcu_bh_state detected stalls on CPUs/tasks: { } (detected by 4, 2502 jiffi
This is rare, but does happen from time to time in real life.
+If the CONFIG_RCU_CPU_STALL_INFO kernel configuration parameter is set,
+more information is printed with the stall-warning message, for example:
+
+ INFO: rcu_preempt detected stall on CPU
+ 0: (63959 ticks this GP) idle=241/3fffffffffffffff/0
+ (t=65000 jiffies)
+
+In kernels with CONFIG_RCU_FAST_NO_HZ, even more information is
+printed:
+
+ INFO: rcu_preempt detected stall on CPU
+ 0: (64628 ticks this GP) idle=dd5/3fffffffffffffff/0 drain=0 . timer=-1
+ (t=65000 jiffies)
+
+The "(64628 ticks this GP)" indicates that this CPU has taken more
+than 64,000 scheduling-clock interrupts during the current stalled
+grace period. If the CPU was not yet aware of the current grace
+period (for example, if it was offline), then this part of the message
+indicates how many grace periods behind the CPU is.
+
+The "idle=" portion of the message prints the dyntick-idle state.
+The hex number before the first "/" is the low-order 12 bits of the
+dynticks counter, which will have an even-numbered value if the CPU is
+in dyntick-idle mode and an odd-numbered value otherwise. The hex
+number between the two "/"s is the value of the nesting, which will
+be a small positive number if in the idle loop and a very large positive
+number (as shown above) otherwise.
+
+For CONFIG_RCU_FAST_NO_HZ kernels, the "drain=0" indicates that the
+CPU is not in the process of trying to force itself into dyntick-idle
+state, the "." indicates that the CPU has not given up forcing RCU
+into dyntick-idle mode (it would be "H" otherwise), and the "timer=-1"
+indicates that the CPU has not recented forced RCU into dyntick-idle
+mode (it would otherwise indicate the number of microseconds remaining
+in this forced state).
+
+
+Multiple Warnings From One Stall
+
+If a stall lasts long enough, multiple stall-warning messages will be
+printed for it. The second and subsequent messages are printed at
+longer intervals, so that the time between (say) the first and second
+message will be about three times the interval between the beginning
+of the stall and the first message.
+
+
+What Causes RCU CPU Stall Warnings?
+
So your kernel printed an RCU CPU stall warning. The next question is
"What caused it?" The following problems can result in RCU CPU stall
warnings:
@@ -128,4 +200,5 @@ is occurring, which will usually be in the function nearest the top of
that portion of the stack which remains the same from trace to trace.
If you can reliably trigger the stall, ftrace can be quite helpful.
-RCU bugs can often be debugged with the help of CONFIG_RCU_TRACE.
+RCU bugs can often be debugged with the help of CONFIG_RCU_TRACE
+and with RCU's event tracing.
diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/torture.txt b/Documentation/RCU/torture.txt
index d67068d0d2b..375d3fb7143 100644
--- a/Documentation/RCU/torture.txt
+++ b/Documentation/RCU/torture.txt
@@ -69,6 +69,13 @@ onoff_interval
CPU-hotplug operations regardless of what value is
specified for onoff_interval.
+onoff_holdoff The number of seconds to wait until starting CPU-hotplug
+ operations. This would normally only be used when
+ rcutorture was built into the kernel and started
+ automatically at boot time, in which case it is useful
+ in order to avoid confusing boot-time code with CPUs
+ coming and going.
+
shuffle_interval
The number of seconds to keep the test threads affinitied
to a particular subset of the CPUs, defaults to 3 seconds.
@@ -79,6 +86,24 @@ shutdown_secs The number of seconds to run the test before terminating
zero, which disables test termination and system shutdown.
This capability is useful for automated testing.
+stall_cpu The number of seconds that a CPU should be stalled while
+ within both an rcu_read_lock() and a preempt_disable().
+ This stall happens only once per rcutorture run.
+ If you need multiple stalls, use modprobe and rmmod to
+ repeatedly run rcutorture. The default for stall_cpu
+ is zero, which prevents rcutorture from stalling a CPU.
+
+ Note that attempts to rmmod rcutorture while the stall
+ is ongoing will hang, so be careful what value you
+ choose for this module parameter! In addition, too-large
+ values for stall_cpu might well induce failures and
+ warnings in other parts of the kernel. You have been
+ warned!
+
+stall_cpu_holdoff
+ The number of seconds to wait after rcutorture starts
+ before stalling a CPU. Defaults to 10 seconds.
+
stat_interval The number of seconds between output of torture
statistics (via printk()). Regardless of the interval,
statistics are printed when the module is unloaded.
@@ -271,11 +296,13 @@ The following script may be used to torture RCU:
#!/bin/sh
modprobe rcutorture
- sleep 100
+ sleep 3600
rmmod rcutorture
dmesg | grep torture:
The output can be manually inspected for the error flag of "!!!".
One could of course create a more elaborate script that automatically
-checked for such errors. The "rmmod" command forces a "SUCCESS" or
-"FAILURE" indication to be printk()ed.
+checked for such errors. The "rmmod" command forces a "SUCCESS",
+"FAILURE", or "RCU_HOTPLUG" indication to be printk()ed. The first
+two are self-explanatory, while the last indicates that while there
+were no RCU failures, CPU-hotplug problems were detected.
diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/trace.txt b/Documentation/RCU/trace.txt
index 49587abfc2f..f6f15ce3990 100644
--- a/Documentation/RCU/trace.txt
+++ b/Documentation/RCU/trace.txt
@@ -33,23 +33,23 @@ rcu/rcuboost:
The output of "cat rcu/rcudata" looks as follows:
rcu_sched:
- 0 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=545/1/0 df=50 of=0 ri=0 ql=163 qs=NRW. kt=0/W/0 ktl=ebc3 b=10 ci=153737 co=0 ca=0
- 1 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=967/1/0 df=58 of=0 ri=0 ql=634 qs=NRW. kt=0/W/1 ktl=58c b=10 ci=191037 co=0 ca=0
- 2 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=1081/1/0 df=175 of=0 ri=0 ql=74 qs=N.W. kt=0/W/2 ktl=da94 b=10 ci=75991 co=0 ca=0
- 3 c=20942 g=20943 pq=1 pgp=20942 qp=1 dt=1846/0/0 df=404 of=0 ri=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/3 ktl=d1cd b=10 ci=72261 co=0 ca=0
- 4 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=369/1/0 df=83 of=0 ri=0 ql=48 qs=N.W. kt=0/W/4 ktl=e0e7 b=10 ci=128365 co=0 ca=0
- 5 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=381/1/0 df=64 of=0 ri=0 ql=169 qs=NRW. kt=0/W/5 ktl=fb2f b=10 ci=164360 co=0 ca=0
- 6 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=1037/1/0 df=183 of=0 ri=0 ql=62 qs=N.W. kt=0/W/6 ktl=d2ad b=10 ci=65663 co=0 ca=0
- 7 c=20897 g=20897 pq=1 pgp=20896 qp=0 dt=1572/0/0 df=382 of=0 ri=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/7 ktl=cf15 b=10 ci=75006 co=0 ca=0
+ 0 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=545/1/0 df=50 of=0 ql=163 qs=NRW. kt=0/W/0 ktl=ebc3 b=10 ci=153737 co=0 ca=0
+ 1 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=967/1/0 df=58 of=0 ql=634 qs=NRW. kt=0/W/1 ktl=58c b=10 ci=191037 co=0 ca=0
+ 2 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=1081/1/0 df=175 of=0 ql=74 qs=N.W. kt=0/W/2 ktl=da94 b=10 ci=75991 co=0 ca=0
+ 3 c=20942 g=20943 pq=1 pgp=20942 qp=1 dt=1846/0/0 df=404 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/3 ktl=d1cd b=10 ci=72261 co=0 ca=0
+ 4 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=369/1/0 df=83 of=0 ql=48 qs=N.W. kt=0/W/4 ktl=e0e7 b=10 ci=128365 co=0 ca=0
+ 5 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=381/1/0 df=64 of=0 ql=169 qs=NRW. kt=0/W/5 ktl=fb2f b=10 ci=164360 co=0 ca=0
+ 6 c=20972 g=20973 pq=1 pgp=20973 qp=0 dt=1037/1/0 df=183 of=0 ql=62 qs=N.W. kt=0/W/6 ktl=d2ad b=10 ci=65663 co=0 ca=0
+ 7 c=20897 g=20897 pq=1 pgp=20896 qp=0 dt=1572/0/0 df=382 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/7 ktl=cf15 b=10 ci=75006 co=0 ca=0
rcu_bh:
- 0 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=545/1/0 df=6 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/0 ktl=ebc3 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
- 1 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=967/1/0 df=3 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/1 ktl=58c b=10 ci=151 co=0 ca=0
- 2 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=1081/1/0 df=6 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/2 ktl=da94 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
- 3 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=1846/0/0 df=8 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/3 ktl=d1cd b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
- 4 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=369/1/0 df=6 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/4 ktl=e0e7 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
- 5 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=381/1/0 df=4 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/5 ktl=fb2f b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
- 6 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=1037/1/0 df=6 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/6 ktl=d2ad b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
- 7 c=1474 g=1474 pq=1 pgp=1473 qp=0 dt=1572/0/0 df=8 of=0 ri=1 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/7 ktl=cf15 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
+ 0 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=545/1/0 df=6 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/0 ktl=ebc3 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
+ 1 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=967/1/0 df=3 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/1 ktl=58c b=10 ci=151 co=0 ca=0
+ 2 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=1081/1/0 df=6 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/2 ktl=da94 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
+ 3 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=1846/0/0 df=8 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/3 ktl=d1cd b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
+ 4 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=369/1/0 df=6 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/4 ktl=e0e7 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
+ 5 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=381/1/0 df=4 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/5 ktl=fb2f b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
+ 6 c=1480 g=1480 pq=1 pgp=1480 qp=0 dt=1037/1/0 df=6 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/6 ktl=d2ad b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
+ 7 c=1474 g=1474 pq=1 pgp=1473 qp=0 dt=1572/0/0 df=8 of=0 ql=0 qs=.... kt=0/W/7 ktl=cf15 b=10 ci=0 co=0 ca=0
The first section lists the rcu_data structures for rcu_sched, the second
for rcu_bh. Note that CONFIG_TREE_PREEMPT_RCU kernels will have an
@@ -119,10 +119,6 @@ o "of" is the number of times that some other CPU has forced a
CPU is offline when it is really alive and kicking) is a fatal
error, so it makes sense to err conservatively.
-o "ri" is the number of times that RCU has seen fit to send a
- reschedule IPI to this CPU in order to get it to report a
- quiescent state.
-
o "ql" is the number of RCU callbacks currently residing on
this CPU. This is the total number of callbacks, regardless
of what state they are in (new, waiting for grace period to
diff --git a/Documentation/arm/kernel_user_helpers.txt b/Documentation/arm/kernel_user_helpers.txt
index a17df9f91d1..5673594717c 100644
--- a/Documentation/arm/kernel_user_helpers.txt
+++ b/Documentation/arm/kernel_user_helpers.txt
@@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ inline (either in the code emitted directly by the compiler, or part of
the implementation of a library call) when optimizing for a recent enough
processor that has the necessary native support, but only if resulting
binaries are already to be incompatible with earlier ARM processors due to
-useage of similar native instructions for other things. In other words
+usage of similar native instructions for other things. In other words
don't make binaries unable to run on earlier processors just for the sake
of not using these kernel helpers if your compiled code is not going to
use new instructions for other purpose.
diff --git a/Documentation/backlight/lp855x-driver.txt b/Documentation/backlight/lp855x-driver.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..f5e4caafab7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/backlight/lp855x-driver.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
+Kernel driver lp855x
+====================
+
+Backlight driver for LP855x ICs
+
+Supported chips:
+ Texas Instruments LP8550, LP8551, LP8552, LP8553 and LP8556
+
+Author: Milo(Woogyom) Kim <milo.kim@ti.com>
+
+Description
+-----------
+
+* Brightness control
+
+Brightness can be controlled by the pwm input or the i2c command.
+The lp855x driver supports both cases.
+
+* Device attributes
+
+1) bl_ctl_mode
+Backlight control mode.
+Value : pwm based or register based
+
+2) chip_id
+The lp855x chip id.
+Value : lp8550/lp8551/lp8552/lp8553/lp8556
+
+Platform data for lp855x
+------------------------
+
+For supporting platform specific data, the lp855x platform data can be used.
+
+* name : Backlight driver name. If it is not defined, default name is set.
+* mode : Brightness control mode. PWM or register based.
+* device_control : Value of DEVICE CONTROL register.
+* initial_brightness : Initial value of backlight brightness.
+* pwm_data : Platform specific pwm generation functions.
+ Only valid when brightness is pwm input mode.
+ Functions should be implemented by PWM driver.
+ - pwm_set_intensity() : set duty of PWM
+ - pwm_get_intensity() : get current duty of PWM
+* load_new_rom_data :
+ 0 : use default configuration data
+ 1 : update values of eeprom or eprom registers on loading driver
+* size_program : Total size of lp855x_rom_data.
+* rom_data : List of new eeprom/eprom registers.
+
+example 1) lp8552 platform data : i2c register mode with new eeprom data
+
+#define EEPROM_A5_ADDR 0xA5
+#define EEPROM_A5_VAL 0x4f /* EN_VSYNC=0 */
+
+static struct lp855x_rom_data lp8552_eeprom_arr[] = {
+ {EEPROM_A5_ADDR, EEPROM_A5_VAL},
+};
+
+static struct lp855x_platform_data lp8552_pdata = {
+ .name = "lcd-bl",
+ .mode = REGISTER_BASED,
+ .device_control = I2C_CONFIG(LP8552),
+ .initial_brightness = INITIAL_BRT,
+ .load_new_rom_data = 1,
+ .size_program = ARRAY_SIZE(lp8552_eeprom_arr),
+ .rom_data = lp8552_eeprom_arr,
+};
+
+example 2) lp8556 platform data : pwm input mode with default rom data
+
+static struct lp855x_platform_data lp8556_pdata = {
+ .mode = PWM_BASED,
+ .device_control = PWM_CONFIG(LP8556),
+ .initial_brightness = INITIAL_BRT,
+ .pwm_data = {
+ .pwm_set_intensity = platform_pwm_set_intensity,
+ .pwm_get_intensity = platform_pwm_get_intensity,
+ },
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/cgroups/blkio-controller.txt b/Documentation/cgroups/blkio-controller.txt
index 84f0a15fc21..b4b1fb3a83f 100644
--- a/Documentation/cgroups/blkio-controller.txt
+++ b/Documentation/cgroups/blkio-controller.txt
@@ -94,11 +94,11 @@ Throttling/Upper Limit policy
Hierarchical Cgroups
====================
-- Currently none of the IO control policy supports hierarhical groups. But
- cgroup interface does allow creation of hierarhical cgroups and internally
+- Currently none of the IO control policy supports hierarchical groups. But
+ cgroup interface does allow creation of hierarchical cgroups and internally
IO policies treat them as flat hierarchy.
- So this patch will allow creation of cgroup hierarhcy but at the backend
+ So this patch will allow creation of cgroup hierarchcy but at the backend
everything will be treated as flat. So if somebody created a hierarchy like
as follows.
@@ -266,7 +266,7 @@ Proportional weight policy files
- blkio.idle_time
- Debugging aid only enabled if CONFIG_DEBUG_BLK_CGROUP=y.
This is the amount of time spent by the IO scheduler idling for a
- given cgroup in anticipation of a better request than the exising ones
+ given cgroup in anticipation of a better request than the existing ones
from other queues/cgroups. This is in nanoseconds. If this is read
when the cgroup is in an idling state, the stat will only report the
idle_time accumulated till the last idle period and will not include
@@ -283,34 +283,34 @@ Throttling/Upper limit policy files
-----------------------------------
- blkio.throttle.read_bps_device
- Specifies upper limit on READ rate from the device. IO rate is
- specified in bytes per second. Rules are per deivce. Following is
+ specified in bytes per second. Rules are per device. Following is
the format.
echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_bytes_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.read_bps_device
- blkio.throttle.write_bps_device
- Specifies upper limit on WRITE rate to the device. IO rate is
- specified in bytes per second. Rules are per deivce. Following is
+ specified in bytes per second. Rules are per device. Following is
the format.
echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_bytes_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.write_bps_device
- blkio.throttle.read_iops_device
- Specifies upper limit on READ rate from the device. IO rate is
- specified in IO per second. Rules are per deivce. Following is
+ specified in IO per second. Rules are per device. Following is
the format.
echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_io_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.read_iops_device
- blkio.throttle.write_iops_device
- Specifies upper limit on WRITE rate to the device. IO rate is
- specified in io per second. Rules are per deivce. Following is
+ specified in io per second. Rules are per device. Following is
the format.
echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_io_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.write_iops_device
Note: If both BW and IOPS rules are specified for a device, then IO is
- subjectd to both the constraints.
+ subjected to both the constraints.
- blkio.throttle.io_serviced
- Number of IOs (bio) completed to/from the disk by the group (as
diff --git a/Documentation/cgroups/cgroups.txt b/Documentation/cgroups/cgroups.txt
index a7c96ae5557..8e74980ab38 100644
--- a/Documentation/cgroups/cgroups.txt
+++ b/Documentation/cgroups/cgroups.txt
@@ -558,8 +558,7 @@ Each subsystem may export the following methods. The only mandatory
methods are create/destroy. Any others that are null are presumed to
be successful no-ops.
-struct cgroup_subsys_state *create(struct cgroup_subsys *ss,
- struct cgroup *cgrp)
+struct cgroup_subsys_state *create(struct cgroup *cgrp)
(cgroup_mutex held by caller)
Called to create a subsystem state object for a cgroup. The
@@ -574,7 +573,7 @@ identified by the passed cgroup object having a NULL parent (since
it's the root of the hierarchy) and may be an appropriate place for
initialization code.
-void destroy(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *cgrp)
+void destroy(struct cgroup *cgrp)
(cgroup_mutex held by caller)
The cgroup system is about to destroy the passed cgroup; the subsystem
@@ -585,7 +584,7 @@ cgroup->parent is still valid. (Note - can also be called for a
newly-created cgroup if an error occurs after this subsystem's
create() method has been called for the new cgroup).
-int pre_destroy(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *cgrp);
+int pre_destroy(struct cgroup *cgrp);
Called before checking the reference count on each subsystem. This may
be useful for subsystems which have some extra references even if
@@ -593,8 +592,7 @@ there are not tasks in the cgroup. If pre_destroy() returns error code,
rmdir() will fail with it. From this behavior, pre_destroy() can be
called multiple times against a cgroup.
-int can_attach(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *cgrp,
- struct cgroup_taskset *tset)
+int can_attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset)
(cgroup_mutex held by caller)
Called prior to moving one or more tasks into a cgroup; if the
@@ -615,8 +613,7 @@ fork. If this method returns 0 (success) then this should remain valid
while the caller holds cgroup_mutex and it is ensured that either
attach() or cancel_attach() will be called in future.
-void cancel_attach(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *cgrp,
- struct cgroup_taskset *tset)
+void cancel_attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset)
(cgroup_mutex held by caller)
Called when a task attach operation has failed after can_attach() has succeeded.
@@ -625,23 +622,22 @@ function, so that the subsystem can implement a rollback. If not, not necessary.
This will be called only about subsystems whose can_attach() operation have
succeeded. The parameters are identical to can_attach().
-void attach(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *cgrp,
- struct cgroup_taskset *tset)
+void attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset)
(cgroup_mutex held by caller)
Called after the task has been attached to the cgroup, to allow any
post-attachment activity that requires memory allocations or blocking.
The parameters are identical to can_attach().
-void fork(struct cgroup_subsy *ss, struct task_struct *task)
+void fork(struct task_struct *task)
Called when a task is forked into a cgroup.
-void exit(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct task_struct *task)
+void exit(struct task_struct *task)
Called during task exit.
-int populate(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *cgrp)
+int populate(struct cgroup *cgrp)
(cgroup_mutex held by caller)
Called after creation of a cgroup to allow a subsystem to populate
@@ -651,7 +647,7 @@ include/linux/cgroup.h for details). Note that although this
method can return an error code, the error code is currently not
always handled well.
-void post_clone(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *cgrp)
+void post_clone(struct cgroup *cgrp)
(cgroup_mutex held by caller)
Called during cgroup_create() to do any parameter
@@ -659,7 +655,7 @@ initialization which might be required before a task could attach. For
example in cpusets, no task may attach before 'cpus' and 'mems' are set
up.
-void bind(struct cgroup_subsys *ss, struct cgroup *root)
+void bind(struct cgroup *root)
(cgroup_mutex and ss->hierarchy_mutex held by caller)
Called when a cgroup subsystem is rebound to a different hierarchy
diff --git a/Documentation/clk.txt b/Documentation/clk.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..1943fae014f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/clk.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,233 @@
+ The Common Clk Framework
+ Mike Turquette <mturquette@ti.com>
+
+This document endeavours to explain the common clk framework details,
+and how to port a platform over to this framework. It is not yet a
+detailed explanation of the clock api in include/linux/clk.h, but
+perhaps someday it will include that information.
+
+ Part 1 - introduction and interface split
+
+The common clk framework is an interface to control the clock nodes
+available on various devices today. This may come in the form of clock
+gating, rate adjustment, muxing or other operations. This framework is
+enabled with the CONFIG_COMMON_CLK option.
+
+The interface itself is divided into two halves, each shielded from the
+details of its counterpart. First is the common definition of struct
+clk which unifies the framework-level accounting and infrastructure that
+has traditionally been duplicated across a variety of platforms. Second
+is a common implementation of the clk.h api, defined in
+drivers/clk/clk.c. Finally there is struct clk_ops, whose operations
+are invoked by the clk api implementation.
+
+The second half of the interface is comprised of the hardware-specific
+callbacks registered with struct clk_ops and the corresponding
+hardware-specific structures needed to model a particular clock. For
+the remainder of this document any reference to a callback in struct
+clk_ops, such as .enable or .set_rate, implies the hardware-specific
+implementation of that code. Likewise, references to struct clk_foo
+serve as a convenient shorthand for the implementation of the
+hardware-specific bits for the hypothetical "foo" hardware.
+
+Tying the two halves of this interface together is struct clk_hw, which
+is defined in struct clk_foo and pointed to within struct clk. This
+allows easy for navigation between the two discrete halves of the common
+clock interface.
+
+ Part 2 - common data structures and api
+
+Below is the common struct clk definition from
+include/linux/clk-private.h, modified for brevity:
+
+ struct clk {
+ const char *name;
+ const struct clk_ops *ops;
+ struct clk_hw *hw;
+ char **parent_names;
+ struct clk **parents;
+ struct clk *parent;
+ struct hlist_head children;
+ struct hlist_node child_node;
+ ...
+ };
+
+The members above make up the core of the clk tree topology. The clk
+api itself defines several driver-facing functions which operate on
+struct clk. That api is documented in include/linux/clk.h.
+
+Platforms and devices utilizing the common struct clk use the struct
+clk_ops pointer in struct clk to perform the hardware-specific parts of
+the operations defined in clk.h:
+
+ struct clk_ops {
+ int (*prepare)(struct clk_hw *hw);
+ void (*unprepare)(struct clk_hw *hw);
+ int (*enable)(struct clk_hw *hw);
+ void (*disable)(struct clk_hw *hw);
+ int (*is_enabled)(struct clk_hw *hw);
+ unsigned long (*recalc_rate)(struct clk_hw *hw,
+ unsigned long parent_rate);
+ long (*round_rate)(struct clk_hw *hw, unsigned long,
+ unsigned long *);
+ int (*set_parent)(struct clk_hw *hw, u8 index);
+ u8 (*get_parent)(struct clk_hw *hw);
+ int (*set_rate)(struct clk_hw *hw, unsigned long);
+ void (*init)(struct clk_hw *hw);
+ };
+
+ Part 3 - hardware clk implementations
+
+The strength of the common struct clk comes from its .ops and .hw pointers
+which abstract the details of struct clk from the hardware-specific bits, and
+vice versa. To illustrate consider the simple gateable clk implementation in
+drivers/clk/clk-gate.c:
+
+struct clk_gate {
+ struct clk_hw hw;
+ void __iomem *reg;
+ u8 bit_idx;
+ ...
+};
+
+struct clk_gate contains struct clk_hw hw as well as hardware-specific
+knowledge about which register and bit controls this clk's gating.
+Nothing about clock topology or accounting, such as enable_count or
+notifier_count, is needed here. That is all handled by the common
+framework code and struct clk.
+
+Let's walk through enabling this clk from driver code:
+
+ struct clk *clk;
+ clk = clk_get(NULL, "my_gateable_clk");
+
+ clk_prepare(clk);
+ clk_enable(clk);
+
+The call graph for clk_enable is very simple:
+
+clk_enable(clk);
+ clk->ops->enable(clk->hw);
+ [resolves to...]
+ clk_gate_enable(hw);
+ [resolves struct clk gate with to_clk_gate(hw)]
+ clk_gate_set_bit(gate);
+
+And the definition of clk_gate_set_bit:
+
+static void clk_gate_set_bit(struct clk_gate *gate)
+{
+ u32 reg;
+
+ reg = __raw_readl(gate->reg);
+ reg |= BIT(gate->bit_idx);
+ writel(reg, gate->reg);
+}
+
+Note that to_clk_gate is defined as:
+
+#define to_clk_gate(_hw) container_of(_hw, struct clk_gate, clk)
+
+This pattern of abstraction is used for every clock hardware
+representation.
+
+ Part 4 - supporting your own clk hardware
+
+When implementing support for a new type of clock it only necessary to
+include the following header:
+
+#include <linux/clk-provider.h>
+
+include/linux/clk.h is included within that header and clk-private.h
+must never be included from the code which implements the operations for
+a clock. More on that below in Part 5.
+
+To construct a clk hardware structure for your platform you must define
+the following:
+
+struct clk_foo {
+ struct clk_hw hw;
+ ... hardware specific data goes here ...
+};
+
+To take advantage of your data you'll need to support valid operations
+for your clk:
+
+struct clk_ops clk_foo_ops {
+ .enable = &clk_foo_enable;
+ .disable = &clk_foo_disable;
+};
+
+Implement the above functions using container_of:
+
+#define to_clk_foo(_hw) container_of(_hw, struct clk_foo, hw)
+
+int clk_foo_enable(struct clk_hw *hw)
+{
+ struct clk_foo *foo;
+
+ foo = to_clk_foo(hw);
+
+ ... perform magic on foo ...
+
+ return 0;
+};
+
+Below is a matrix detailing which clk_ops are mandatory based upon the
+hardware capbilities of that clock. A cell marked as "y" means
+mandatory, a cell marked as "n" implies that either including that
+callback is invalid or otherwise uneccesary. Empty cells are either
+optional or must be evaluated on a case-by-case basis.
+
+ clock hardware characteristics
+ -----------------------------------------------------------
+ | gate | change rate | single parent | multiplexer | root |
+ |------|-------------|---------------|-------------|------|
+.prepare | | | | | |
+.unprepare | | | | | |
+ | | | | | |
+.enable | y | | | | |
+.disable | y | | | | |
+.is_enabled | y | | | | |
+ | | | | | |
+.recalc_rate | | y | | | |
+.round_rate | | y | | | |
+.set_rate | | y | | | |
+ | | | | | |
+.set_parent | | | n | y | n |
+.get_parent | | | n | y | n |
+ | | | | | |
+.init | | | | | |
+ -----------------------------------------------------------
+
+Finally, register your clock at run-time with a hardware-specific
+registration function. This function simply populates struct clk_foo's
+data and then passes the common struct clk parameters to the framework
+with a call to:
+
+clk_register(...)
+
+See the basic clock types in drivers/clk/clk-*.c for examples.
+
+ Part 5 - static initialization of clock data
+
+For platforms with many clocks (often numbering into the hundreds) it
+may be desirable to statically initialize some clock data. This
+presents a problem since the definition of struct clk should be hidden
+from everyone except for the clock core in drivers/clk/clk.c.
+
+To get around this problem struct clk's definition is exposed in
+include/linux/clk-private.h along with some macros for more easily
+initializing instances of the basic clock types. These clocks must
+still be initialized with the common clock framework via a call to
+__clk_init.
+
+clk-private.h must NEVER be included by code which implements struct
+clk_ops callbacks, nor must it be included by any logic which pokes
+around inside of struct clk at run-time. To do so is a layering
+violation.
+
+To better enforce this policy, always follow this simple rule: any
+statically initialized clock data MUST be defined in a separate file
+from the logic that implements its ops. Basically separate the logic
+from the data and all is well.
diff --git a/Documentation/crc32.txt b/Documentation/crc32.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..a08a7dd9d62
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/crc32.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,182 @@
+A brief CRC tutorial.
+
+A CRC is a long-division remainder. You add the CRC to the message,
+and the whole thing (message+CRC) is a multiple of the given
+CRC polynomial. To check the CRC, you can either check that the
+CRC matches the recomputed value, *or* you can check that the
+remainder computed on the message+CRC is 0. This latter approach
+is used by a lot of hardware implementations, and is why so many
+protocols put the end-of-frame flag after the CRC.
+
+It's actually the same long division you learned in school, except that
+- We're working in binary, so the digits are only 0 and 1, and
+- When dividing polynomials, there are no carries. Rather than add and
+ subtract, we just xor. Thus, we tend to get a bit sloppy about
+ the difference between adding and subtracting.
+
+Like all division, the remainder is always smaller than the divisor.
+To produce a 32-bit CRC, the divisor is actually a 33-bit CRC polynomial.
+Since it's 33 bits long, bit 32 is always going to be set, so usually the
+CRC is written in hex with the most significant bit omitted. (If you're
+familiar with the IEEE 754 floating-point format, it's the same idea.)
+
+Note that a CRC is computed over a string of *bits*, so you have
+to decide on the endianness of the bits within each byte. To get
+the best error-detecting properties, this should correspond to the
+order they're actually sent. For example, standard RS-232 serial is
+little-endian; the most significant bit (sometimes used for parity)
+is sent last. And when appending a CRC word to a message, you should
+do it in the right order, matching the endianness.
+
+Just like with ordinary division, you proceed one digit (bit) at a time.
+Each step of the division you take one more digit (bit) of the dividend
+and append it to the current remainder. Then you figure out the
+appropriate multiple of the divisor to subtract to being the remainder
+back into range. In binary, this is easy - it has to be either 0 or 1,
+and to make the XOR cancel, it's just a copy of bit 32 of the remainder.
+
+When computing a CRC, we don't care about the quotient, so we can
+throw the quotient bit away, but subtract the appropriate multiple of
+the polynomial from the remainder and we're back to where we started,
+ready to process the next bit.
+
+A big-endian CRC written this way would be coded like:
+for (i = 0; i < input_bits; i++) {
+ multiple = remainder & 0x80000000 ? CRCPOLY : 0;
+ remainder = (remainder << 1 | next_input_bit()) ^ multiple;
+}
+
+Notice how, to get at bit 32 of the shifted remainder, we look
+at bit 31 of the remainder *before* shifting it.
+
+But also notice how the next_input_bit() bits we're shifting into
+the remainder don't actually affect any decision-making until
+32 bits later. Thus, the first 32 cycles of this are pretty boring.
+Also, to add the CRC to a message, we need a 32-bit-long hole for it at
+the end, so we have to add 32 extra cycles shifting in zeros at the
+end of every message,
+
+These details lead to a standard trick: rearrange merging in the
+next_input_bit() until the moment it's needed. Then the first 32 cycles
+can be precomputed, and merging in the final 32 zero bits to make room
+for the CRC can be skipped entirely. This changes the code to:
+
+for (i = 0; i < input_bits; i++) {
+ remainder ^= next_input_bit() << 31;
+ multiple = (remainder & 0x80000000) ? CRCPOLY : 0;
+ remainder = (remainder << 1) ^ multiple;
+}
+
+With this optimization, the little-endian code is particularly simple:
+for (i = 0; i < input_bits; i++) {
+ remainder ^= next_input_bit();
+ multiple = (remainder & 1) ? CRCPOLY : 0;
+ remainder = (remainder >> 1) ^ multiple;
+}
+
+The most significant coefficient of the remainder polynomial is stored
+in the least significant bit of the binary "remainder" variable.
+The other details of endianness have been hidden in CRCPOLY (which must
+be bit-reversed) and next_input_bit().
+
+As long as next_input_bit is returning the bits in a sensible order, we don't
+*have* to wait until the last possible moment to merge in additional bits.
+We can do it 8 bits at a time rather than 1 bit at a time:
+for (i = 0; i < input_bytes; i++) {
+ remainder ^= next_input_byte() << 24;
+ for (j = 0; j < 8; j++) {
+ multiple = (remainder & 0x80000000) ? CRCPOLY : 0;
+ remainder = (remainder << 1) ^ multiple;
+ }
+}
+
+Or in little-endian:
+for (i = 0; i < input_bytes; i++) {
+ remainder ^= next_input_byte();
+ for (j = 0; j < 8; j++) {
+ multiple = (remainder & 1) ? CRCPOLY : 0;
+ remainder = (remainder >> 1) ^ multiple;
+ }
+}
+
+If the input is a multiple of 32 bits, you can even XOR in a 32-bit
+word at a time and increase the inner loop count to 32.
+
+You can also mix and match the two loop styles, for example doing the
+bulk of a message byte-at-a-time and adding bit-at-a-time processing
+for any fractional bytes at the end.
+
+To reduce the number of conditional branches, software commonly uses
+the byte-at-a-time table method, popularized by Dilip V. Sarwate,
+"Computation of Cyclic Redundancy Checks via Table Look-Up", Comm. ACM
+v.31 no.8 (August 1998) p. 1008-1013.
+
+Here, rather than just shifting one bit of the remainder to decide
+in the correct multiple to subtract, we can shift a byte at a time.
+This produces a 40-bit (rather than a 33-bit) intermediate remainder,
+and the correct multiple of the polynomial to subtract is found using
+a 256-entry lookup table indexed by the high 8 bits.
+
+(The table entries are simply the CRC-32 of the given one-byte messages.)
+
+When space is more constrained, smaller tables can be used, e.g. two
+4-bit shifts followed by a lookup in a 16-entry table.
+
+It is not practical to process much more than 8 bits at a time using this
+technique, because tables larger than 256 entries use too much memory and,
+more importantly, too much of the L1 cache.
+
+To get higher software performance, a "slicing" technique can be used.
+See "High Octane CRC Generation with the Intel Slicing-by-8 Algorithm",
+ftp://download.intel.com/technology/comms/perfnet/download/slicing-by-8.pdf
+
+This does not change the number of table lookups, but does increase
+the parallelism. With the classic Sarwate algorithm, each table lookup
+must be completed before the index of the next can be computed.
+
+A "slicing by 2" technique would shift the remainder 16 bits at a time,
+producing a 48-bit intermediate remainder. Rather than doing a single
+lookup in a 65536-entry table, the two high bytes are looked up in
+two different 256-entry tables. Each contains the remainder required
+to cancel out the corresponding byte. The tables are different because the
+polynomials to cancel are different. One has non-zero coefficients from
+x^32 to x^39, while the other goes from x^40 to x^47.
+
+Since modern processors can handle many parallel memory operations, this
+takes barely longer than a single table look-up and thus performs almost
+twice as fast as the basic Sarwate algorithm.
+
+This can be extended to "slicing by 4" using 4 256-entry tables.
+Each step, 32 bits of data is fetched, XORed with the CRC, and the result
+broken into bytes and looked up in the tables. Because the 32-bit shift
+leaves the low-order bits of the intermediate remainder zero, the
+final CRC is simply the XOR of the 4 table look-ups.
+
+But this still enforces sequential execution: a second group of table
+look-ups cannot begin until the previous groups 4 table look-ups have all
+been completed. Thus, the processor's load/store unit is sometimes idle.
+
+To make maximum use of the processor, "slicing by 8" performs 8 look-ups
+in parallel. Each step, the 32-bit CRC is shifted 64 bits and XORed
+with 64 bits of input data. What is important to note is that 4 of
+those 8 bytes are simply copies of the input data; they do not depend
+on the previous CRC at all. Thus, those 4 table look-ups may commence
+immediately, without waiting for the previous loop iteration.
+
+By always having 4 loads in flight, a modern superscalar processor can
+be kept busy and make full use of its L1 cache.
+
+Two more details about CRC implementation in the real world:
+
+Normally, appending zero bits to a message which is already a multiple
+of a polynomial produces a larger multiple of that polynomial. Thus,
+a basic CRC will not detect appended zero bits (or bytes). To enable
+a CRC to detect this condition, it's common to invert the CRC before
+appending it. This makes the remainder of the message+crc come out not
+as zero, but some fixed non-zero value. (The CRC of the inversion
+pattern, 0xffffffff.)
+
+The same problem applies to zero bits prepended to the message, and a
+similar solution is used. Instead of starting the CRC computation with
+a remainder of 0, an initial remainder of all ones is used. As long as
+you start the same way on decoding, it doesn't make a difference.
diff --git a/Documentation/device-mapper/dm-raid.txt b/Documentation/device-mapper/dm-raid.txt
index 2a8c11331d2..946c73342cd 100644
--- a/Documentation/device-mapper/dm-raid.txt
+++ b/Documentation/device-mapper/dm-raid.txt
@@ -28,7 +28,7 @@ The target is named "raid" and it accepts the following parameters:
raid6_nc RAID6 N continue
- rotating parity N (right-to-left) with data continuation
- Refererence: Chapter 4 of
+ Reference: Chapter 4 of
http://www.snia.org/sites/default/files/SNIA_DDF_Technical_Position_v2.0.pdf
<#raid_params>: The number of parameters that follow.
diff --git a/Documentation/device-mapper/persistent-data.txt b/Documentation/device-mapper/persistent-data.txt
index 0e5df9b04ad..a333bcb3a6c 100644
--- a/Documentation/device-mapper/persistent-data.txt
+++ b/Documentation/device-mapper/persistent-data.txt
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ Introduction
The more-sophisticated device-mapper targets require complex metadata
that is managed in kernel. In late 2010 we were seeing that various
-different targets were rolling their own data strutures, for example:
+different targets were rolling their own data structures, for example:
- Mikulas Patocka's multisnap implementation
- Heinz Mauelshagen's thin provisioning target
diff --git a/Documentation/device-mapper/thin-provisioning.txt b/Documentation/device-mapper/thin-provisioning.txt
index 801d9d1cf82..3370bc4d7b9 100644
--- a/Documentation/device-mapper/thin-provisioning.txt
+++ b/Documentation/device-mapper/thin-provisioning.txt
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
Introduction
============
-This document descibes a collection of device-mapper targets that
+This document describes a collection of device-mapper targets that
between them implement thin-provisioning and snapshots.
The main highlight of this implementation, compared to the previous
@@ -75,10 +75,12 @@ less sharing than average you'll need a larger-than-average metadata device.
As a guide, we suggest you calculate the number of bytes to use in the
metadata device as 48 * $data_dev_size / $data_block_size but round it up
-to 2MB if the answer is smaller. The largest size supported is 16GB.
+to 2MB if the answer is smaller. If you're creating large numbers of
+snapshots which are recording large amounts of change, you may find you
+need to increase this.
-If you're creating large numbers of snapshots which are recording large
-amounts of change, you may need find you need to increase this.
+The largest size supported is 16GB: If the device is larger,
+a warning will be issued and the excess space will not be used.
Reloading a pool table
----------------------
@@ -167,6 +169,38 @@ ii) Using an internal snapshot.
dmsetup create snap --table "0 2097152 thin /dev/mapper/pool 1"
+External snapshots
+------------------
+
+You can use an external _read only_ device as an origin for a
+thinly-provisioned volume. Any read to an unprovisioned area of the
+thin device will be passed through to the origin. Writes trigger
+the allocation of new blocks as usual.
+
+One use case for this is VM hosts that want to run guests on
+thinly-provisioned volumes but have the base image on another device
+(possibly shared between many VMs).
+
+You must not write to the origin device if you use this technique!
+Of course, you may write to the thin device and take internal snapshots
+of the thin volume.
+
+i) Creating a snapshot of an external device
+
+ This is the same as creating a thin device.
+ You don't mention the origin at this stage.
+
+ dmsetup message /dev/mapper/pool 0 "create_thin 0"
+
+ii) Using a snapshot of an external device.
+
+ Append an extra parameter to the thin target specifying the origin:
+
+ dmsetup create snap --table "0 2097152 thin /dev/mapper/pool 0 /dev/image"
+
+ N.B. All descendants (internal snapshots) of this snapshot require the
+ same extra origin parameter.
+
Deactivation
------------
@@ -189,7 +223,13 @@ i) Constructor
<low water mark (blocks)> [<number of feature args> [<arg>]*]
Optional feature arguments:
- - 'skip_block_zeroing': skips the zeroing of newly-provisioned blocks.
+
+ skip_block_zeroing: Skip the zeroing of newly-provisioned blocks.
+
+ ignore_discard: Disable discard support.
+
+ no_discard_passdown: Don't pass discards down to the underlying
+ data device, but just remove the mapping.
Data block size must be between 64KB (128 sectors) and 1GB
(2097152 sectors) inclusive.
@@ -237,16 +277,6 @@ iii) Messages
Deletes a thin device. Irreversible.
- trim <dev id> <new size in sectors>
-
- Delete mappings from the end of a thin device. Irreversible.
- You might want to use this if you're reducing the size of
- your thinly-provisioned device. In many cases, due to the
- sharing of blocks between devices, it is not possible to
- determine in advance how much space 'trim' will release. (In
- future a userspace tool might be able to perform this
- calculation.)
-
set_transaction_id <current id> <new id>
Userland volume managers, such as LVM, need a way to
@@ -262,7 +292,7 @@ iii) Messages
i) Constructor
- thin <pool dev> <dev id>
+ thin <pool dev> <dev id> [<external origin dev>]
pool dev:
the thin-pool device, e.g. /dev/mapper/my_pool or 253:0
@@ -271,6 +301,11 @@ i) Constructor
the internal device identifier of the device to be
activated.
+ external origin dev:
+ an optional block device outside the pool to be treated as a
+ read-only snapshot origin: reads to unprovisioned areas of the
+ thin target will be mapped to this device.
+
The pool doesn't store any size against the thin devices. If you
load a thin target that is smaller than you've been using previously,
then you'll have no access to blocks mapped beyond the end. If you
diff --git a/Documentation/device-mapper/verity.txt b/Documentation/device-mapper/verity.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..32e48797a14
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/device-mapper/verity.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,194 @@
+dm-verity
+==========
+
+Device-Mapper's "verity" target provides transparent integrity checking of
+block devices using a cryptographic digest provided by the kernel crypto API.
+This target is read-only.
+
+Construction Parameters
+=======================
+ <version> <dev> <hash_dev> <hash_start>
+ <data_block_size> <hash_block_size>
+ <num_data_blocks> <hash_start_block>
+ <algorithm> <digest> <salt>
+
+<version>
+ This is the version number of the on-disk format.
+
+ 0 is the original format used in the Chromium OS.
+ The salt is appended when hashing, digests are stored continuously and
+ the rest of the block is padded with zeros.
+
+ 1 is the current format that should be used for new devices.
+ The salt is prepended when hashing and each digest is
+ padded with zeros to the power of two.
+
+<dev>
+ This is the device containing the data the integrity of which needs to be
+ checked. It may be specified as a path, like /dev/sdaX, or a device number,
+ <major>:<minor>.
+
+<hash_dev>
+ This is the device that that supplies the hash tree data. It may be
+ specified similarly to the device path and may be the same device. If the
+ same device is used, the hash_start should be outside of the dm-verity
+ configured device size.
+
+<data_block_size>
+ The block size on a data device. Each block corresponds to one digest on
+ the hash device.
+
+<hash_block_size>
+ The size of a hash block.
+
+<num_data_blocks>
+ The number of data blocks on the data device. Additional blocks are
+ inaccessible. You can place hashes to the same partition as data, in this
+ case hashes are placed after <num_data_blocks>.
+
+<hash_start_block>
+ This is the offset, in <hash_block_size>-blocks, from the start of hash_dev
+ to the root block of the hash tree.
+
+<algorithm>
+ The cryptographic hash algorithm used for this device. This should
+ be the name of the algorithm, like "sha1".
+
+<digest>
+ The hexadecimal encoding of the cryptographic hash of the root hash block
+ and the salt. This hash should be trusted as there is no other authenticity
+ beyond this point.
+
+<salt>
+ The hexadecimal encoding of the salt value.
+
+Theory of operation
+===================
+
+dm-verity is meant to be setup as part of a verified boot path. This
+may be anything ranging from a boot using tboot or trustedgrub to just
+booting from a known-good device (like a USB drive or CD).
+
+When a dm-verity device is configured, it is expected that the caller
+has been authenticated in some way (cryptographic signatures, etc).
+After instantiation, all hashes will be verified on-demand during
+disk access. If they cannot be verified up to the root node of the
+tree, the root hash, then the I/O will fail. This should identify
+tampering with any data on the device and the hash data.
+
+Cryptographic hashes are used to assert the integrity of the device on a
+per-block basis. This allows for a lightweight hash computation on first read
+into the page cache. Block hashes are stored linearly-aligned to the nearest
+block the size of a page.
+
+Hash Tree
+---------
+
+Each node in the tree is a cryptographic hash. If it is a leaf node, the hash
+is of some block data on disk. If it is an intermediary node, then the hash is
+of a number of child nodes.
+
+Each entry in the tree is a collection of neighboring nodes that fit in one
+block. The number is determined based on block_size and the size of the
+selected cryptographic digest algorithm. The hashes are linearly-ordered in
+this entry and any unaligned trailing space is ignored but included when
+calculating the parent node.
+
+The tree looks something like:
+
+alg = sha256, num_blocks = 32768, block_size = 4096
+
+ [ root ]
+ / . . . \
+ [entry_0] [entry_1]
+ / . . . \ . . . \
+ [entry_0_0] . . . [entry_0_127] . . . . [entry_1_127]
+ / ... \ / . . . \ / \
+ blk_0 ... blk_127 blk_16256 blk_16383 blk_32640 . . . blk_32767
+
+
+On-disk format
+==============
+
+Below is the recommended on-disk format. The verity kernel code does not
+read the on-disk header. It only reads the hash blocks which directly
+follow the header. It is expected that a user-space tool will verify the
+integrity of the verity_header and then call dmsetup with the correct
+parameters. Alternatively, the header can be omitted and the dmsetup
+parameters can be passed via the kernel command-line in a rooted chain
+of trust where the command-line is verified.
+
+The on-disk format is especially useful in cases where the hash blocks
+are on a separate partition. The magic number allows easy identification
+of the partition contents. Alternatively, the hash blocks can be stored
+in the same partition as the data to be verified. In such a configuration
+the filesystem on the partition would be sized a little smaller than
+the full-partition, leaving room for the hash blocks.
+
+struct superblock {
+ uint8_t signature[8]
+ "verity\0\0";
+
+ uint8_t version;
+ 1 - current format
+
+ uint8_t data_block_bits;
+ log2(data block size)
+
+ uint8_t hash_block_bits;
+ log2(hash block size)
+
+ uint8_t pad1[1];
+ zero padding
+
+ uint16_t salt_size;
+ big-endian salt size
+
+ uint8_t pad2[2];
+ zero padding
+
+ uint32_t data_blocks_hi;
+ big-endian high 32 bits of the 64-bit number of data blocks
+
+ uint32_t data_blocks_lo;
+ big-endian low 32 bits of the 64-bit number of data blocks
+
+ uint8_t algorithm[16];
+ cryptographic algorithm
+
+ uint8_t salt[384];
+ salt (the salt size is specified above)
+
+ uint8_t pad3[88];
+ zero padding to 512-byte boundary
+}
+
+Directly following the header (and with sector number padded to the next hash
+block boundary) are the hash blocks which are stored a depth at a time
+(starting from the root), sorted in order of increasing index.
+
+Status
+======
+V (for Valid) is returned if every check performed so far was valid.
+If any check failed, C (for Corruption) is returned.
+
+Example
+=======
+
+Setup a device:
+ dmsetup create vroot --table \
+ "0 2097152 "\
+ "verity 1 /dev/sda1 /dev/sda2 4096 4096 2097152 1 "\
+ "4392712ba01368efdf14b05c76f9e4df0d53664630b5d48632ed17a137f39076 "\
+ "1234000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000"
+
+A command line tool veritysetup is available to compute or verify
+the hash tree or activate the kernel driver. This is available from
+the LVM2 upstream repository and may be supplied as a package called
+device-mapper-verity-tools:
+ git://sources.redhat.com/git/lvm2
+ http://sourceware.org/git/?p=lvm2.git
+ http://sourceware.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb.cgi/LVM2/verity?cvsroot=lvm2
+
+veritysetup -a vroot /dev/sda1 /dev/sda2 \
+ 4392712ba01368efdf14b05c76f9e4df0d53664630b5d48632ed17a137f39076
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-aic.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-aic.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..aabca4f8340
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-aic.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,38 @@
+* Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC)
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "atmel,<chip>-aic"
+- interrupt-controller: Identifies the node as an interrupt controller.
+- interrupt-parent: For single AIC system, it is an empty property.
+- #interrupt-cells: The number of cells to define the interrupts. It sould be 2.
+ The first cell is the IRQ number (aka "Peripheral IDentifier" on datasheet).
+ The second cell is used to specify flags:
+ bits[3:0] trigger type and level flags:
+ 1 = low-to-high edge triggered.
+ 2 = high-to-low edge triggered.
+ 4 = active high level-sensitive.
+ 8 = active low level-sensitive.
+ Valid combinations are 1, 2, 3, 4, 8.
+ Default flag for internal sources should be set to 4 (active high).
+- reg: Should contain AIC registers location and length
+
+Examples:
+ /*
+ * AIC
+ */
+ aic: interrupt-controller@fffff000 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-aic";
+ interrupt-controller;
+ interrupt-parent;
+ #interrupt-cells = <2>;
+ reg = <0xfffff000 0x200>;
+ };
+
+ /*
+ * An interrupt generating device that is wired to an AIC.
+ */
+ dma: dma-controller@ffffec00 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91sam9g45-dma";
+ reg = <0xffffec00 0x200>;
+ interrupts = <21 4>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-at91.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-at91.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..ecc81e36871
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-at91.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,92 @@
+Atmel AT91 device tree bindings.
+================================
+
+PIT Timer required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "atmel,at91sam9260-pit"
+- reg: Should contain registers location and length
+- interrupts: Should contain interrupt for the PIT which is the IRQ line
+ shared across all System Controller members.
+
+TC/TCLIB Timer required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "atmel,<chip>-pit".
+ <chip> can be "at91rm9200" or "at91sam9x5"
+- reg: Should contain registers location and length
+- interrupts: Should contain all interrupts for the TC block
+ Note that you can specify several interrupt cells if the TC
+ block has one interrupt per channel.
+
+Examples:
+
+One interrupt per TC block:
+ tcb0: timer@fff7c000 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-tcb";
+ reg = <0xfff7c000 0x100>;
+ interrupts = <18 4>;
+ };
+
+One interrupt per TC channel in a TC block:
+ tcb1: timer@fffdc000 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-tcb";
+ reg = <0xfffdc000 0x100>;
+ interrupts = <26 4 27 4 28 4>;
+ };
+
+RSTC Reset Controller required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "atmel,<chip>-rstc".
+ <chip> can be "at91sam9260" or "at91sam9g45"
+- reg: Should contain registers location and length
+
+Example:
+
+ rstc@fffffd00 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91sam9260-rstc";
+ reg = <0xfffffd00 0x10>;
+ };
+
+RAMC SDRAM/DDR Controller required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "atmel,at91sam9260-sdramc",
+ "atmel,at91sam9g45-ddramc",
+- reg: Should contain registers location and length
+ For at91sam9263 and at91sam9g45 you must specify 2 entries.
+
+Examples:
+
+ ramc0: ramc@ffffe800 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91sam9g45-ddramc";
+ reg = <0xffffe800 0x200>;
+ };
+
+ ramc0: ramc@ffffe400 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91sam9g45-ddramc";
+ reg = <0xffffe400 0x200
+ 0xffffe600 0x200>;
+ };
+
+SHDWC Shutdown Controller
+
+required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "atmel,<chip>-shdwc".
+ <chip> can be "at91sam9260", "at91sam9rl" or "at91sam9x5".
+- reg: Should contain registers location and length
+
+optional properties:
+- atmel,wakeup-mode: String, operation mode of the wakeup mode.
+ Supported values are: "none", "high", "low", "any".
+- atmel,wakeup-counter: Counter on Wake-up 0 (between 0x0 and 0xf).
+
+optional at91sam9260 properties:
+- atmel,wakeup-rtt-timer: boolean to enable Real-time Timer Wake-up.
+
+optional at91sam9rl properties:
+- atmel,wakeup-rtc-timer: boolean to enable Real-time Clock Wake-up.
+- atmel,wakeup-rtt-timer: boolean to enable Real-time Timer Wake-up.
+
+optional at91sam9x5 properties:
+- atmel,wakeup-rtc-timer: boolean to enable Real-time Clock Wake-up.
+
+Example:
+
+ rstc@fffffd00 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91sam9260-rstc";
+ reg = <0xfffffd00 0x10>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-pmc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-pmc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..389bed5056e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/atmel-pmc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+* Power Management Controller (PMC)
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "atmel,at91rm9200-pmc"
+- reg: Should contain PMC registers location and length
+
+Examples:
+ pmc: pmc@fffffc00 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-pmc";
+ reg = <0xfffffc00 0x100>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/exynos/power_domain.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/exynos/power_domain.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..6528e215c5f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/exynos/power_domain.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,21 @@
+* Samsung Exynos Power Domains
+
+Exynos processors include support for multiple power domains which are used
+to gate power to one or more peripherals on the processor.
+
+Required Properties:
+- compatiable: should be one of the following.
+ * samsung,exynos4210-pd - for exynos4210 type power domain.
+- reg: physical base address of the controller and length of memory mapped
+ region.
+
+Optional Properties:
+- samsung,exynos4210-pd-off: Specifies that the power domain is in turned-off
+ state during boot and remains to be turned-off until explicitly turned-on.
+
+Example:
+
+ lcd0: power-domain-lcd0 {
+ compatible = "samsung,exynos4210-pd";
+ reg = <0x10023C00 0x10>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/fsl.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/fsl.txt
index 54bdddadf1c..bfbc771a65f 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/fsl.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/fsl.txt
@@ -28,3 +28,25 @@ Required root node properties:
i.MX6 Quad SABRE Lite Board
Required root node properties:
- compatible = "fsl,imx6q-sabrelite", "fsl,imx6q";
+
+Generic i.MX boards
+-------------------
+
+No iomux setup is done for these boards, so this must have been configured
+by the bootloader for boards to work with the generic bindings.
+
+i.MX27 generic board
+Required root node properties:
+ - compatible = "fsl,imx27";
+
+i.MX51 generic board
+Required root node properties:
+ - compatible = "fsl,imx51";
+
+i.MX53 generic board
+Required root node properties:
+ - compatible = "fsl,imx53";
+
+i.MX6q generic board
+Required root node properties:
+ - compatible = "fsl,imx6q";
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/mrvl.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/mrvl.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..d8de933e9d8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/mrvl.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+Marvell Platforms Device Tree Bindings
+----------------------------------------------------
+
+PXA168 Aspenite Board
+Required root node properties:
+ - compatible = "mrvl,pxa168-aspenite", "mrvl,pxa168";
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/intc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/intc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..f2583e6ec06
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/intc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
+* OMAP Interrupt Controller
+
+OMAP2/3 are using a TI interrupt controller that can support several
+configurable number of interrupts.
+
+Main node required properties:
+
+- compatible : should be:
+ "ti,omap2-intc"
+- interrupt-controller : Identifies the node as an interrupt controller
+- #interrupt-cells : Specifies the number of cells needed to encode an
+ interrupt source. The type shall be a <u32> and the value shall be 1.
+
+ The cell contains the interrupt number in the range [0-128].
+- ti,intc-size: Number of interrupts handled by the interrupt controller.
+- reg: physical base address and size of the intc registers map.
+
+Example:
+
+ intc: interrupt-controller@1 {
+ compatible = "ti,omap2-intc";
+ interrupt-controller;
+ #interrupt-cells = <1>;
+ ti,intc-size = <96>;
+ reg = <0x48200000 0x1000>;
+ };
+
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/omap.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/omap.txt
index dbdab40ed3a..e78e8bccac3 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/omap.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/omap.txt
@@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ IPs present in the SoC.
On top of that an omap_device is created to extend the platform_device
capabilities and to allow binding with one or several hwmods.
The hwmods will contain all the information to build the device:
-adresse range, irq lines, dma lines, interconnect, PRCM register,
+address range, irq lines, dma lines, interconnect, PRCM register,
clock domain, input clocks.
For the moment just point to the existing hwmod, the next step will be
to move data from hwmod to device-tree representation.
@@ -41,3 +41,9 @@ Boards:
- OMAP4 PandaBoard : Low cost community board
compatible = "ti,omap4-panda", "ti,omap4430"
+
+- OMAP3 EVM : Software Developement Board for OMAP35x, AM/DM37x
+ compatible = "ti,omap3-evm", "ti,omap3"
+
+- AM335X EVM : Software Developement Board for AM335x
+ compatible = "ti,am335x-evm", "ti,am33xx", "ti,omap3"
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/sirf.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/sirf.txt
index 6b07f65b32d..1881e1c6dda 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/sirf.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/sirf.txt
@@ -1,3 +1,3 @@
-prima2 "cb" evalutation board
+prima2 "cb" evaluation board
Required root node properties:
- compatible = "sirf,prima2-cb", "sirf,prima2";
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/spear.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/spear.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..f8e54f09232
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/spear.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,8 @@
+ST SPEAr Platforms Device Tree Bindings
+---------------------------------------
+
+Boards with the ST SPEAr600 SoC shall have the following properties:
+
+Required root node property:
+
+compatible = "st,spear600";
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/emc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/emc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..09335f8eee0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/emc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
+Embedded Memory Controller
+
+Properties:
+- name : Should be emc
+- #address-cells : Should be 1
+- #size-cells : Should be 0
+- compatible : Should contain "nvidia,tegra20-emc".
+- reg : Offset and length of the register set for the device
+- nvidia,use-ram-code : If present, the sub-nodes will be addressed
+ and chosen using the ramcode board selector. If omitted, only one
+ set of tables can be present and said tables will be used
+ irrespective of ram-code configuration.
+
+Child device nodes describe the memory settings for different configurations and clock rates.
+
+Example:
+
+ emc@7000f400 {
+ #address-cells = < 1 >;
+ #size-cells = < 0 >;
+ compatible = "nvidia,tegra20-emc";
+ reg = <0x7000f4000 0x200>;
+ }
+
+
+Embedded Memory Controller ram-code table
+
+If the emc node has the nvidia,use-ram-code property present, then the
+next level of nodes below the emc table are used to specify which settings
+apply for which ram-code settings.
+
+If the emc node lacks the nvidia,use-ram-code property, this level is omitted
+and the tables are stored directly under the emc node (see below).
+
+Properties:
+
+- name : Should be emc-tables
+- nvidia,ram-code : the binary representation of the ram-code board strappings
+ for which this node (and children) are valid.
+
+
+
+Embedded Memory Controller configuration table
+
+This is a table containing the EMC register settings for the various
+operating speeds of the memory controller. They are always located as
+subnodes of the emc controller node.
+
+There are two ways of specifying which tables to use:
+
+* The simplest is if there is just one set of tables in the device tree,
+ and they will always be used (based on which frequency is used).
+ This is the preferred method, especially when firmware can fill in
+ this information based on the specific system information and just
+ pass it on to the kernel.
+
+* The slightly more complex one is when more than one memory configuration
+ might exist on the system. The Tegra20 platform handles this during
+ early boot by selecting one out of possible 4 memory settings based
+ on a 2-pin "ram code" bootstrap setting on the board. The values of
+ these strappings can be read through a register in the SoC, and thus
+ used to select which tables to use.
+
+Properties:
+- name : Should be emc-table
+- compatible : Should contain "nvidia,tegra20-emc-table".
+- reg : either an opaque enumerator to tell different tables apart, or
+ the valid frequency for which the table should be used (in kHz).
+- clock-frequency : the clock frequency for the EMC at which this
+ table should be used (in kHz).
+- nvidia,emc-registers : a 46 word array of EMC registers to be programmed
+ for operation at the 'clock-frequency' setting.
+ The order and contents of the registers are:
+ RC, RFC, RAS, RP, R2W, W2R, R2P, W2P, RD_RCD, WR_RCD, RRD, REXT,
+ WDV, QUSE, QRST, QSAFE, RDV, REFRESH, BURST_REFRESH_NUM, PDEX2WR,
+ PDEX2RD, PCHG2PDEN, ACT2PDEN, AR2PDEN, RW2PDEN, TXSR, TCKE, TFAW,
+ TRPAB, TCLKSTABLE, TCLKSTOP, TREFBW, QUSE_EXTRA, FBIO_CFG6, ODT_WRITE,
+ ODT_READ, FBIO_CFG5, CFG_DIG_DLL, DLL_XFORM_DQS, DLL_XFORM_QUSE,
+ ZCAL_REF_CNT, ZCAL_WAIT_CNT, AUTO_CAL_INTERVAL, CFG_CLKTRIM_0,
+ CFG_CLKTRIM_1, CFG_CLKTRIM_2
+
+ emc-table@166000 {
+ reg = <166000>;
+ compatible = "nvidia,tegra20-emc-table";
+ clock-frequency = < 166000 >;
+ nvidia,emc-registers = < 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
+ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
+ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
+ 0 0 0 0 >;
+ };
+
+ emc-table@333000 {
+ reg = <333000>;
+ compatible = "nvidia,tegra20-emc-table";
+ clock-frequency = < 333000 >;
+ nvidia,emc-registers = < 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
+ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
+ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
+ 0 0 0 0 >;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/nvidia,tegra20-pmc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/nvidia,tegra20-pmc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..b5846e21cc2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/tegra/nvidia,tegra20-pmc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+NVIDIA Tegra Power Management Controller (PMC)
+
+Properties:
+- name : Should be pmc
+- compatible : Should contain "nvidia,tegra<chip>-pmc".
+- reg : Offset and length of the register set for the device
+- nvidia,invert-interrupt : If present, inverts the PMU interrupt signal.
+ The PMU is an external Power Management Unit, whose interrupt output
+ signal is fed into the PMC. This signal is optionally inverted, and then
+ fed into the ARM GIC. The PMC is not involved in the detection or
+ handling of this interrupt signal, merely its inversion.
+
+Example:
+
+pmc@7000f400 {
+ compatible = "nvidia,tegra20-pmc";
+ reg = <0x7000e400 0x400>;
+ nvidia,invert-interrupt;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/twd.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/twd.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..75b8610939f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/twd.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
+* ARM Timer Watchdog
+
+ARM 11MP, Cortex-A5 and Cortex-A9 are often associated with a per-core
+Timer-Watchdog (aka TWD), which provides both a per-cpu local timer
+and watchdog.
+
+The TWD is usually attached to a GIC to deliver its two per-processor
+interrupts.
+
+** Timer node required properties:
+
+- compatible : Should be one of:
+ "arm,cortex-a9-twd-timer"
+ "arm,cortex-a5-twd-timer"
+ "arm,arm11mp-twd-timer"
+
+- interrupts : One interrupt to each core
+
+- reg : Specify the base address and the size of the TWD timer
+ register window.
+
+Example:
+
+ twd-timer@2c000600 {
+ compatible = "arm,arm11mp-twd-timer"";
+ reg = <0x2c000600 0x20>;
+ interrupts = <1 13 0xf01>;
+ };
+
+** Watchdog node properties:
+
+- compatible : Should be one of:
+ "arm,cortex-a9-twd-wdt"
+ "arm,cortex-a5-twd-wdt"
+ "arm,arm11mp-twd-wdt"
+
+- interrupts : One interrupt to each core
+
+- reg : Specify the base address and the size of the TWD watchdog
+ register window.
+
+Example:
+
+ twd-watchdog@2c000620 {
+ compatible = "arm,arm11mp-twd-wdt";
+ reg = <0x2c000620 0x20>;
+ interrupts = <1 14 0xf01>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/vexpress.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/vexpress.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..ec8b50cbb2e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/vexpress.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,146 @@
+ARM Versatile Express boards family
+-----------------------------------
+
+ARM's Versatile Express platform consists of a motherboard and one
+or more daughterboards (tiles). The motherboard provides a set of
+peripherals. Processor and RAM "live" on the tiles.
+
+The motherboard and each core tile should be described by a separate
+Device Tree source file, with the tile's description including
+the motherboard file using a /include/ directive. As the motherboard
+can be initialized in one of two different configurations ("memory
+maps"), care must be taken to include the correct one.
+
+Required properties in the root node:
+- compatible value:
+ compatible = "arm,vexpress,<model>", "arm,vexpress";
+ where <model> is the full tile model name (as used in the tile's
+ Technical Reference Manual), eg.:
+ - for Coretile Express A5x2 (V2P-CA5s):
+ compatible = "arm,vexpress,v2p-ca5s", "arm,vexpress";
+ - for Coretile Express A9x4 (V2P-CA9):
+ compatible = "arm,vexpress,v2p-ca9", "arm,vexpress";
+ If a tile comes in several variants or can be used in more then one
+ configuration, the compatible value should be:
+ compatible = "arm,vexpress,<model>,<variant>", \
+ "arm,vexpress,<model>", "arm,vexpress";
+ eg:
+ - Coretile Express A15x2 (V2P-CA15) with Tech Chip 1:
+ compatible = "arm,vexpress,v2p-ca15,tc1", \
+ "arm,vexpress,v2p-ca15", "arm,vexpress";
+ - LogicTile Express 13MG (V2F-2XV6) running Cortex-A7 (3 cores) SMM:
+ compatible = "arm,vexpress,v2f-2xv6,ca7x3", \
+ "arm,vexpress,v2f-2xv6", "arm,vexpress";
+
+Optional properties in the root node:
+- tile model name (use name from the tile's Technical Reference
+ Manual, eg. "V2P-CA5s")
+ model = "<model>";
+- tile's HBI number (unique ARM's board model ID, visible on the
+ PCB's silkscreen) in hexadecimal transcription:
+ arm,hbi = <0xhbi>
+ eg:
+ - for Coretile Express A5x2 (V2P-CA5s) HBI-0191:
+ arm,hbi = <0x191>;
+ - Coretile Express A9x4 (V2P-CA9) HBI-0225:
+ arm,hbi = <0x225>;
+
+Top-level standard "cpus" node is required. It must contain a node
+with device_type = "cpu" property for every available core, eg.:
+
+ cpus {
+ #address-cells = <1>;
+ #size-cells = <0>;
+
+ cpu@0 {
+ device_type = "cpu";
+ compatible = "arm,cortex-a5";
+ reg = <0>;
+ };
+ };
+
+The motherboard description file provides a single "motherboard" node
+using 2 address cells corresponding to the Static Memory Bus used
+between the motherboard and the tile. The first cell defines the Chip
+Select (CS) line number, the second cell address offset within the CS.
+All interrupt lines between the motherboard and the tile are active
+high and are described using single cell.
+
+Optional properties of the "motherboard" node:
+- motherboard's memory map variant:
+ arm,v2m-memory-map = "<name>";
+ where name is one of:
+ - "rs1" - for RS1 map (i.a. peripherals on CS3); this map is also
+ referred to as "ARM Cortex-A Series memory map":
+ arm,v2m-memory-map = "rs1";
+ When this property is missing, the motherboard is using the original
+ memory map (also known as the "Legacy memory map", primarily used
+ with the original CoreTile Express A9x4) with peripherals on CS7.
+
+Motherboard .dtsi files provide a set of labelled peripherals that
+can be used to obtain required phandle in the tile's "aliases" node:
+- UARTs, note that the numbers correspond to the physical connectors
+ on the motherboard's back panel:
+ v2m_serial0, v2m_serial1, v2m_serial2 and v2m_serial3
+- I2C controllers:
+ v2m_i2c_dvi and v2m_i2c_pcie
+- SP804 timers:
+ v2m_timer01 and v2m_timer23
+
+Current Linux implementation requires a "arm,v2m_timer" alias
+pointing at one of the motherboard's SP804 timers, if it is to be
+used as the system timer. This alias should be defined in the
+motherboard files.
+
+The tile description must define "ranges", "interrupt-map-mask" and
+"interrupt-map" properties to translate the motherboard's address
+and interrupt space into one used by the tile's processor.
+
+Abbreviated example:
+
+/dts-v1/;
+
+/ {
+ model = "V2P-CA5s";
+ arm,hbi = <0x225>;
+ compatible = "arm,vexpress-v2p-ca5s", "arm,vexpress";
+ interrupt-parent = <&gic>;
+ #address-cells = <1>;
+ #size-cells = <1>;
+
+ chosen { };
+
+ aliases {
+ serial0 = &v2m_serial0;
+ };
+
+ cpus {
+ #address-cells = <1>;
+ #size-cells = <0>;
+
+ cpu@0 {
+ device_type = "cpu";
+ compatible = "arm,cortex-a5";
+ reg = <0>;
+ };
+ };
+
+ gic: interrupt-controller@2c001000 {
+ compatible = "arm,cortex-a9-gic";
+ #interrupt-cells = <3>;
+ #address-cells = <0>;
+ interrupt-controller;
+ reg = <0x2c001000 0x1000>,
+ <0x2c000100 0x100>;
+ };
+
+ motherboard {
+ /* CS0 is visible at 0x08000000 */
+ ranges = <0 0 0x08000000 0x04000000>;
+ interrupt-map-mask = <0 0 63>;
+ /* Active high IRQ 0 is connected to GIC's SPI0 */
+ interrupt-map = <0 0 0 &gic 0 0 4>;
+ };
+};
+
+/include/ "vexpress-v2m-rs1.dtsi"
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/tegra20-apbdma.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/tegra20-apbdma.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..90fa7da525b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/tegra20-apbdma.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,30 @@
+* NVIDIA Tegra APB DMA controller
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "nvidia,<chip>-apbdma"
+- reg: Should contain DMA registers location and length. This shuld include
+ all of the per-channel registers.
+- interrupts: Should contain all of the per-channel DMA interrupts.
+
+Examples:
+
+apbdma: dma@6000a000 {
+ compatible = "nvidia,tegra20-apbdma";
+ reg = <0x6000a000 0x1200>;
+ interrupts = < 0 136 0x04
+ 0 137 0x04
+ 0 138 0x04
+ 0 139 0x04
+ 0 140 0x04
+ 0 141 0x04
+ 0 142 0x04
+ 0 143 0x04
+ 0 144 0x04
+ 0 145 0x04
+ 0 146 0x04
+ 0 147 0x04
+ 0 148 0x04
+ 0 149 0x04
+ 0 150 0x04
+ 0 151 0x04 >;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_atmel.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_atmel.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..66efc804806
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_atmel.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+* Atmel GPIO controller (PIO)
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible: "atmel,<chip>-gpio", where <chip> is at91rm9200 or at91sam9x5.
+- reg: Should contain GPIO controller registers location and length
+- interrupts: Should be the port interrupt shared by all the pins.
+- #gpio-cells: Should be two. The first cell is the pin number and
+ the second cell is used to specify optional parameters (currently
+ unused).
+- gpio-controller: Marks the device node as a GPIO controller.
+
+Example:
+ pioA: gpio@fffff200 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-gpio";
+ reg = <0xfffff200 0x100>;
+ interrupts = <2 4>;
+ #gpio-cells = <2>;
+ gpio-controller;
+ };
+
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_i2c.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_i2c.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..4f8ec947c6b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_i2c.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
+Device-Tree bindings for i2c gpio driver
+
+Required properties:
+ - compatible = "i2c-gpio";
+ - gpios: sda and scl gpio
+
+
+Optional properties:
+ - i2c-gpio,sda-open-drain: sda as open drain
+ - i2c-gpio,scl-open-drain: scl as open drain
+ - i2c-gpio,scl-output-only: scl as output only
+ - i2c-gpio,delay-us: delay between GPIO operations (may depend on each platform)
+ - i2c-gpio,timeout-ms: timeout to get data
+
+Example nodes:
+
+i2c@0 {
+ compatible = "i2c-gpio";
+ gpios = <&pioA 23 0 /* sda */
+ &pioA 24 0 /* scl */
+ >;
+ i2c-gpio,sda-open-drain;
+ i2c-gpio,scl-open-drain;
+ i2c-gpio,delay-us = <2>; /* ~100 kHz */
+ #address-cells = <1>;
+ #size-cells = <0>;
+
+ rv3029c2@56 {
+ compatible = "rv3029c2";
+ reg = <0x56>;
+ };
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_nvidia.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_nvidia.txt
index eb4b530d64e..023c9526e5f 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_nvidia.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio_nvidia.txt
@@ -1,8 +1,40 @@
-NVIDIA Tegra 2 GPIO controller
+NVIDIA Tegra GPIO controller
Required properties:
-- compatible : "nvidia,tegra20-gpio"
+- compatible : "nvidia,tegra<chip>-gpio"
+- reg : Physical base address and length of the controller's registers.
+- interrupts : The interrupt outputs from the controller. For Tegra20,
+ there should be 7 interrupts specified, and for Tegra30, there should
+ be 8 interrupts specified.
- #gpio-cells : Should be two. The first cell is the pin number and the
second cell is used to specify optional parameters:
- bit 0 specifies polarity (0 for normal, 1 for inverted)
- gpio-controller : Marks the device node as a GPIO controller.
+- #interrupt-cells : Should be 2.
+ The first cell is the GPIO number.
+ The second cell is used to specify flags:
+ bits[3:0] trigger type and level flags:
+ 1 = low-to-high edge triggered.
+ 2 = high-to-low edge triggered.
+ 4 = active high level-sensitive.
+ 8 = active low level-sensitive.
+ Valid combinations are 1, 2, 3, 4, 8.
+- interrupt-controller : Marks the device node as an interrupt controller.
+
+Example:
+
+gpio: gpio@6000d000 {
+ compatible = "nvidia,tegra20-gpio";
+ reg = < 0x6000d000 0x1000 >;
+ interrupts = < 0 32 0x04
+ 0 33 0x04
+ 0 34 0x04
+ 0 35 0x04
+ 0 55 0x04
+ 0 87 0x04
+ 0 89 0x04 >;
+ #gpio-cells = <2>;
+ gpio-controller;
+ #interrupt-cells = <2>;
+ interrupt-controller;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/led.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/led.txt
index 141087cf310..fd2bd56e719 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/led.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/led.txt
@@ -7,9 +7,9 @@ Each LED is represented as a sub-node of the gpio-leds device. Each
node's name represents the name of the corresponding LED.
LED sub-node properties:
-- gpios : Should specify the LED's GPIO, see "Specifying GPIO information
- for devices" in Documentation/devicetree/booting-without-of.txt. Active
- low LEDs should be indicated using flags in the GPIO specifier.
+- gpios : Should specify the LED's GPIO, see "gpios property" in
+ Documentation/devicetree/gpio.txt. Active low LEDs should be
+ indicated using flags in the GPIO specifier.
- label : (optional) The label for this LED. If omitted, the label is
taken from the node name (excluding the unit address).
- linux,default-trigger : (optional) This parameter, if present, is a
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/mrvl-gpio.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/mrvl-gpio.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..1e34cfe5ebe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/mrvl-gpio.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+* Marvell PXA GPIO controller
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible : Should be "mrvl,pxa-gpio" or "mrvl,mmp-gpio"
+- reg : Address and length of the register set for the device
+- interrupts : Should be the port interrupt shared by all gpio pins, if
+- interrupt-name : Should be the name of irq resource.
+ one number.
+- gpio-controller : Marks the device node as a gpio controller.
+- #gpio-cells : Should be one. It is the pin number.
+
+Example:
+
+ gpio: gpio@d4019000 {
+ compatible = "mrvl,mmp-gpio", "mrvl,pxa-gpio";
+ reg = <0xd4019000 0x1000>;
+ interrupts = <49>, <17>, <18>;
+ interrupt-name = "gpio_mux", "gpio0", "gpio1";
+ gpio-controller;
+ #gpio-cells = <1>;
+ interrupt-controller;
+ #interrupt-cells = <1>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/mrvl-i2c.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/mrvl-i2c.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..071eb3caae9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/mrvl-i2c.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
+* I2C
+
+Required properties :
+
+ - reg : Offset and length of the register set for the device
+ - compatible : should be "mrvl,mmp-twsi" where CHIP is the name of a
+ compatible processor, e.g. pxa168, pxa910, mmp2, mmp3.
+ For the pxa2xx/pxa3xx, an additional node "mrvl,pxa-i2c" is required
+ as shown in the example below.
+
+Recommended properties :
+
+ - interrupts : <a b> where a is the interrupt number and b is a
+ field that represents an encoding of the sense and level
+ information for the interrupt. This should be encoded based on
+ the information in section 2) depending on the type of interrupt
+ controller you have.
+ - interrupt-parent : the phandle for the interrupt controller that
+ services interrupts for this device.
+ - mrvl,i2c-polling : Disable interrupt of i2c controller. Polling
+ status register of i2c controller instead.
+ - mrvl,i2c-fast-mode : Enable fast mode of i2c controller.
+
+Examples:
+ twsi1: i2c@d4011000 {
+ compatible = "mrvl,mmp-twsi", "mrvl,pxa-i2c";
+ reg = <0xd4011000 0x1000>;
+ interrupts = <7>;
+ mrvl,i2c-fast-mode;
+ };
+
+ twsi2: i2c@d4025000 {
+ compatible = "mrvl,mmp-twsi", "mrvl,pxa-i2c";
+ reg = <0xd4025000 0x1000>;
+ interrupts = <58>;
+ };
+
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/sirf-i2c.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/sirf-i2c.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..7baf9e133fa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i2c/sirf-i2c.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+I2C for SiRFprimaII platforms
+
+Required properties :
+- compatible : Must be "sirf,prima2-i2c"
+- reg: physical base address of the controller and length of memory mapped
+ region.
+- interrupts: interrupt number to the cpu.
+
+Optional properties:
+- clock-frequency : Constains desired I2C/HS-I2C bus clock frequency in Hz.
+ The absence of the propoerty indicates the default frequency 100 kHz.
+
+Examples :
+
+i2c0: i2c@b00e0000 {
+ compatible = "sirf,prima2-i2c";
+ reg = <0xb00e0000 0x10000>;
+ interrupts = <24>;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/matrix-keymap.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/matrix-keymap.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..3cd8b98ccd2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/matrix-keymap.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+A simple common binding for matrix-connected key boards. Currently targeted at
+defining the keys in the scope of linux key codes since that is a stable and
+standardized interface at this time.
+
+Required properties:
+- linux,keymap: an array of packed 1-cell entries containing the equivalent
+ of row, column and linux key-code. The 32-bit big endian cell is packed
+ as:
+ row << 24 | column << 16 | key-code
+
+Optional properties:
+Some users of this binding might choose to specify secondary keymaps for
+cases where there is a modifier key such as a Fn key. Proposed names
+for said properties are "linux,fn-keymap" or with another descriptive
+word for the modifier other from "Fn".
+
+Example:
+ linux,keymap = < 0x00030012
+ 0x0102003a >;
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/tegra-kbc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/tegra-kbc.txt
index 5ecfa99089b..72683be6de3 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/tegra-kbc.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/input/tegra-kbc.txt
@@ -3,16 +3,21 @@
Required properties:
- compatible: "nvidia,tegra20-kbc"
-Optional properties:
-- debounce-delay: delay in milliseconds per row scan for debouncing
-- repeat-delay: delay in milliseconds before repeat starts
-- ghost-filter: enable ghost filtering for this device
-- wakeup-source: configure keyboard as a wakeup source for suspend/resume
+Optional properties, in addition to those specified by the shared
+matrix-keyboard bindings:
+
+- linux,fn-keymap: a second keymap, same specification as the
+ matrix-keyboard-controller spec but to be used when the KEY_FN modifier
+ key is pressed.
+- nvidia,debounce-delay-ms: delay in milliseconds per row scan for debouncing
+- nvidia,repeat-delay-ms: delay in milliseconds before repeat starts
+- nvidia,ghost-filter: enable ghost filtering for this device
+- nvidia,wakeup-source: configure keyboard as a wakeup source for suspend/resume
Example:
keyboard: keyboard {
compatible = "nvidia,tegra20-kbc";
reg = <0x7000e200 0x100>;
- ghost-filter;
+ nvidia,ghost-filter;
};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/atmel-nand.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/atmel-nand.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..5903ecf6e89
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/atmel-nand.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+Atmel NAND flash
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible : "atmel,at91rm9200-nand".
+- reg : should specify localbus address and size used for the chip,
+ and if availlable the ECC.
+- atmel,nand-addr-offset : offset for the address latch.
+- atmel,nand-cmd-offset : offset for the command latch.
+- #address-cells, #size-cells : Must be present if the device has sub-nodes
+ representing partitions.
+
+- gpios : specifies the gpio pins to control the NAND device. detect is an
+ optional gpio and may be set to 0 if not present.
+
+Optional properties:
+- nand-ecc-mode : String, operation mode of the NAND ecc mode, soft by default.
+ Supported values are: "none", "soft", "hw", "hw_syndrome", "hw_oob_first",
+ "soft_bch".
+- nand-bus-width : 8 or 16 bus width if not present 8
+- nand-on-flash-bbt: boolean to enable on flash bbt option if not present false
+
+Examples:
+nand0: nand@40000000,0 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-nand";
+ #address-cells = <1>;
+ #size-cells = <1>;
+ reg = <0x40000000 0x10000000
+ 0xffffe800 0x200
+ >;
+ atmel,nand-addr-offset = <21>;
+ atmel,nand-cmd-offset = <22>;
+ nand-on-flash-bbt;
+ nand-ecc-mode = "soft";
+ gpios = <&pioC 13 0
+ &pioC 14 0
+ 0
+ >;
+ partition@0 {
+ ...
+ };
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/nand.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/nand.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..03855c8c492
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/nand.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,7 @@
+* MTD generic binding
+
+- nand-ecc-mode : String, operation mode of the NAND ecc mode.
+ Supported values are: "none", "soft", "hw", "hw_syndrome", "hw_oob_first",
+ "soft_bch".
+- nand-bus-width : 8 or 16 bus width if not present 8
+- nand-on-flash-bbt: boolean to enable on flash bbt option if not present false
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/net/stmmac.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/net/stmmac.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..1f62623f8c3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/net/stmmac.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,28 @@
+* STMicroelectronics 10/100/1000 Ethernet driver (GMAC)
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible: Should be "st,spear600-gmac"
+- reg: Address and length of the register set for the device
+- interrupt-parent: Should be the phandle for the interrupt controller
+ that services interrupts for this device
+- interrupts: Should contain the STMMAC interrupts
+- interrupt-names: Should contain the interrupt names "macirq"
+ "eth_wake_irq" if this interrupt is supported in the "interrupts"
+ property
+- phy-mode: String, operation mode of the PHY interface.
+ Supported values are: "mii", "rmii", "gmii", "rgmii".
+
+Optional properties:
+- mac-address: 6 bytes, mac address
+
+Examples:
+
+ gmac0: ethernet@e0800000 {
+ compatible = "st,spear600-gmac";
+ reg = <0xe0800000 0x8000>;
+ interrupt-parent = <&vic1>;
+ interrupts = <24 23>;
+ interrupt-names = "macirq", "eth_wake_irq";
+ mac-address = [000000000000]; /* Filled in by U-Boot */
+ phy-mode = "gmii";
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic-msgr.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic-msgr.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..bc8ded641ab
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic-msgr.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+* FSL MPIC Message Registers
+
+This binding specifies what properties must be available in the device tree
+representation of the message register blocks found in some FSL MPIC
+implementations.
+
+Required properties:
+
+ - compatible: Specifies the compatibility list for the message register
+ block. The type shall be <string-list> and the value shall be of the form
+ "fsl,mpic-v<version>-msgr", where <version> is the version number of
+ the MPIC containing the message registers.
+
+ - reg: Specifies the base physical address(s) and size(s) of the
+ message register block's addressable register space. The type shall be
+ <prop-encoded-array>.
+
+ - interrupts: Specifies a list of interrupt-specifiers which are available
+ for receiving interrupts. Interrupt-specifier consists of two cells: first
+ cell is interrupt-number and second cell is level-sense. The type shall be
+ <prop-encoded-array>.
+
+Optional properties:
+
+ - mpic-msgr-receive-mask: Specifies what registers in the containing block
+ are allowed to receive interrupts. The value is a bit mask where a set
+ bit at bit 'n' indicates that message register 'n' can receive interrupts.
+ Note that "bit 'n'" is numbered from LSB for PPC hardware. The type shall
+ be <u32>. If not present, then all of the message registers in the block
+ are available.
+
+Aliases:
+
+ An alias should be created for every message register block. They are not
+ required, though. However, a particular implementation of this binding
+ may require aliases to be present. Aliases are of the form
+ 'mpic-msgr-block<n>', where <n> is an integer specifying the block's number.
+ Numbers shall start at 0.
+
+Example:
+
+ aliases {
+ mpic-msgr-block0 = &mpic_msgr_block0;
+ mpic-msgr-block1 = &mpic_msgr_block1;
+ };
+
+ mpic_msgr_block0: mpic-msgr-block@41400 {
+ compatible = "fsl,mpic-v3.1-msgr";
+ reg = <0x41400 0x200>;
+ // Message registers 0 and 2 in this block can receive interrupts on
+ // sources 0xb0 and 0xb2, respectively.
+ interrupts = <0xb0 2 0xb2 2>;
+ mpic-msgr-receive-mask = <0x5>;
+ };
+
+ mpic_msgr_block1: mpic-msgr-block@42400 {
+ compatible = "fsl,mpic-v3.1-msgr";
+ reg = <0x42400 0x200>;
+ // Message registers 0 and 2 in this block can receive interrupts on
+ // sources 0xb4 and 0xb6, respectively.
+ interrupts = <0xb4 2 0xb6 2>;
+ mpic-msgr-receive-mask = <0x5>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic.txt
index 2cf38bd841f..dc5744636a5 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/mpic.txt
@@ -56,7 +56,27 @@ PROPERTIES
to the client. The presence of this property also mandates
that any initialization related to interrupt sources shall
be limited to sources explicitly referenced in the device tree.
-
+
+ - big-endian
+ Usage: optional
+ Value type: <empty>
+ If present the MPIC will be assumed to be big-endian. Some
+ device-trees omit this property on MPIC nodes even when the MPIC is
+ in fact big-endian, so certain boards override this property.
+
+ - single-cpu-affinity
+ Usage: optional
+ Value type: <empty>
+ If present the MPIC will be assumed to only be able to route
+ non-IPI interrupts to a single CPU at a time (EG: Freescale MPIC).
+
+ - last-interrupt-source
+ Usage: optional
+ Value type: <u32>
+ Some MPICs do not correctly report the number of hardware sources
+ in the global feature registers. If specified, this field will
+ override the value read from MPIC_GREG_FEATURE_LAST_SRC.
+
INTERRUPT SPECIFIER DEFINITION
Interrupt specifiers consists of 4 cells encoded as
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/msi-pic.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/msi-pic.txt
index 5d586e1ccaf..5693877ab37 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/msi-pic.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/powerpc/fsl/msi-pic.txt
@@ -6,8 +6,10 @@ Required properties:
etc.) and the second is "fsl,mpic-msi" or "fsl,ipic-msi" depending on
the parent type.
-- reg : should contain the address and the length of the shared message
- interrupt register set.
+- reg : It may contain one or two regions. The first region should contain
+ the address and the length of the shared message interrupt register set.
+ The second region should contain the address of aliased MSIIR register for
+ platforms that have such an alias.
- msi-available-ranges: use <start count> style section to define which
msi interrupt can be used in the 256 msi interrupts. This property is
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/twl-regulator.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/twl-regulator.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..0c3395d55ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/twl-regulator.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+TWL family of regulators
+
+Required properties:
+For twl6030 regulators/LDOs
+- compatible:
+ - "ti,twl6030-vaux1" for VAUX1 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vaux2" for VAUX2 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vaux3" for VAUX3 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vmmc" for VMMC LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vpp" for VPP LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vusim" for VUSIM LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vana" for VANA LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vcxio" for VCXIO LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vdac" for VDAC LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-vusb" for VUSB LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-v1v8" for V1V8 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-v2v1" for V2V1 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6030-clk32kg" for CLK32KG RESOURCE
+ - "ti,twl6030-vdd1" for VDD1 SMPS
+ - "ti,twl6030-vdd2" for VDD2 SMPS
+ - "ti,twl6030-vdd3" for VDD3 SMPS
+For twl6025 regulators/LDOs
+- compatible:
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldo1" for LDO1 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldo2" for LDO2 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldo3" for LDO3 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldo4" for LDO4 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldo5" for LDO5 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldo6" for LDO6 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldo7" for LDO7 LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldoln" for LDOLN LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-ldousb" for LDOUSB LDO
+ - "ti,twl6025-smps3" for SMPS3 SMPS
+ - "ti,twl6025-smps4" for SMPS4 SMPS
+ - "ti,twl6025-vio" for VIO SMPS
+For twl4030 regulators/LDOs
+- compatible:
+ - "ti,twl4030-vaux1" for VAUX1 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vaux2" for VAUX2 LDO
+ - "ti,twl5030-vaux2" for VAUX2 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vaux3" for VAUX3 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vaux4" for VAUX4 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vmmc1" for VMMC1 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vmmc2" for VMMC2 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vpll1" for VPLL1 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vpll2" for VPLL2 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vsim" for VSIM LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vdac" for VDAC LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vintana2" for VINTANA2 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vio" for VIO LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vdd1" for VDD1 SMPS
+ - "ti,twl4030-vdd2" for VDD2 SMPS
+ - "ti,twl4030-vintana1" for VINTANA1 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vintdig" for VINTDIG LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vusb1v5" for VUSB1V5 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vusb1v8" for VUSB1V8 LDO
+ - "ti,twl4030-vusb3v1" for VUSB3V1 LDO
+
+Optional properties:
+- Any optional property defined in bindings/regulator/regulator.txt
+
+Example:
+
+ xyz: regulator@0 {
+ compatible = "ti,twl6030-vaux1";
+ regulator-min-microvolt = <1000000>;
+ regulator-max-microvolt = <3000000>;
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rtc/sa1100-rtc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rtc/sa1100-rtc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..0cda19ad485
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rtc/sa1100-rtc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,17 @@
+* Marvell Real Time Clock controller
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible: should be "mrvl,sa1100-rtc"
+- reg: physical base address of the controller and length of memory mapped
+ region.
+- interrupts: Should be two. The first interrupt number is the rtc alarm
+ interrupt and the second interrupt number is the rtc hz interrupt.
+- interrupt-names: Assign name of irq resource.
+
+Example:
+ rtc: rtc@d4010000 {
+ compatible = "mrvl,mmp-rtc";
+ reg = <0xd4010000 0x1000>;
+ interrupts = <5>, <6>;
+ interrupt-name = "rtc 1Hz", "rtc alarm";
+ };
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/serial/mrvl-serial.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/serial/mrvl-serial.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..d744340de88
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/serial/mrvl-serial.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+PXA UART controller
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible : should be "mrvl,mmp-uart" or "mrvl,pxa-uart".
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/alc5632.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/alc5632.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..8608f747dcf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/alc5632.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,24 @@
+ALC5632 audio CODEC
+
+This device supports I2C only.
+
+Required properties:
+
+ - compatible : "realtek,alc5632"
+
+ - reg : the I2C address of the device.
+
+ - gpio-controller : Indicates this device is a GPIO controller.
+
+ - #gpio-cells : Should be two. The first cell is the pin number and the
+ second cell is used to specify optional parameters (currently unused).
+
+Example:
+
+alc5632: alc5632@1e {
+ compatible = "realtek,alc5632";
+ reg = <0x1a>;
+
+ gpio-controller;
+ #gpio-cells = <2>;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/imx-audmux.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/imx-audmux.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..215aa981721
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/imx-audmux.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
+Freescale Digital Audio Mux (AUDMUX) device
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible : "fsl,imx21-audmux" for AUDMUX version firstly used on i.MX21,
+ or "fsl,imx31-audmux" for the version firstly used on i.MX31.
+- reg : Should contain AUDMUX registers location and length
+
+Example:
+
+audmux@021d8000 {
+ compatible = "fsl,imx6q-audmux", "fsl,imx31-audmux";
+ reg = <0x021d8000 0x4000>;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/soc/codecs/fsl-sgtl5000.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sgtl5000.txt
index 2c3cd413f04..2c3cd413f04 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/soc/codecs/fsl-sgtl5000.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sgtl5000.txt
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/tegra-audio-alc5632.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/tegra-audio-alc5632.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..b77a97c9101
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/tegra-audio-alc5632.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
+NVIDIA Tegra audio complex
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible : "nvidia,tegra-audio-alc5632"
+- nvidia,model : The user-visible name of this sound complex.
+- nvidia,audio-routing : A list of the connections between audio components.
+ Each entry is a pair of strings, the first being the connection's sink,
+ the second being the connection's source. Valid names for sources and
+ sinks are the ALC5632's pins:
+
+ ALC5632 pins:
+
+ * SPK_OUTP
+ * SPK_OUTN
+ * HP_OUT_L
+ * HP_OUT_R
+ * AUX_OUT_P
+ * AUX_OUT_N
+ * LINE_IN_L
+ * LINE_IN_R
+ * PHONE_P
+ * PHONE_N
+ * MIC1_P
+ * MIC1_N
+ * MIC2_P
+ * MIC2_N
+ * MICBIAS1
+ * DMICDAT
+
+ Board connectors:
+
+ * Headset Stereophone
+ * Int Spk
+ * Headset Mic
+ * Digital Mic
+
+- nvidia,i2s-controller : The phandle of the Tegra I2S controller
+- nvidia,audio-codec : The phandle of the ALC5632 audio codec
+
+Example:
+
+sound {
+ compatible = "nvidia,tegra-audio-alc5632-paz00",
+ "nvidia,tegra-audio-alc5632";
+
+ nvidia,model = "Compal PAZ00";
+
+ nvidia,audio-routing =
+ "Int Spk", "SPK_OUTP",
+ "Int Spk", "SPK_OUTN",
+ "Headset Mic","MICBIAS1",
+ "MIC1_N", "Headset Mic",
+ "MIC1_P", "Headset Mic",
+ "Headset Stereophone", "HP_OUT_R",
+ "Headset Stereophone", "HP_OUT_L";
+
+ nvidia,i2s-controller = <&tegra_i2s1>;
+ nvidia,audio-codec = <&alc5632>;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/omap-spi.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/omap-spi.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..81df374adbb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/omap-spi.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+OMAP2+ McSPI device
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible :
+ - "ti,omap2-spi" for OMAP2 & OMAP3.
+ - "ti,omap4-spi" for OMAP4+.
+- ti,spi-num-cs : Number of chipselect supported by the instance.
+- ti,hwmods: Name of the hwmod associated to the McSPI
+
+
+Example:
+
+mcspi1: mcspi@1 {
+ #address-cells = <1>;
+ #size-cells = <0>;
+ compatible = "ti,omap4-mcspi";
+ ti,hwmods = "mcspi1";
+ ti,spi-num-cs = <4>;
+};
+
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/tty/serial/efm32-uart.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/tty/serial/efm32-uart.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..6588b6950a7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/tty/serial/efm32-uart.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,14 @@
+* Energymicro efm32 UART
+
+Required properties:
+- compatible : Should be "efm32,uart"
+- reg : Address and length of the register set
+- interrupts : Should contain uart interrupt
+
+Example:
+
+uart@0x4000c400 {
+ compatible = "efm32,uart";
+ reg = <0x4000c400 0x400>;
+ interrupts = <15>;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/atmel-usb.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/atmel-usb.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..60bd2150a3e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/atmel-usb.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
+Atmel SOC USB controllers
+
+OHCI
+
+Required properties:
+ - compatible: Should be "atmel,at91rm9200-ohci" for USB controllers
+ used in host mode.
+ - num-ports: Number of ports.
+ - atmel,vbus-gpio: If present, specifies a gpio that needs to be
+ activated for the bus to be powered.
+ - atmel,oc-gpio: If present, specifies a gpio that needs to be
+ activated for the overcurrent detection.
+
+usb0: ohci@00500000 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-ohci", "usb-ohci";
+ reg = <0x00500000 0x100000>;
+ interrupts = <20 4>;
+ num-ports = <2>;
+};
+
+EHCI
+
+Required properties:
+ - compatible: Should be "atmel,at91sam9g45-ehci" for USB controllers
+ used in host mode.
+
+usb1: ehci@00800000 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91sam9g45-ehci", "usb-ehci";
+ reg = <0x00800000 0x100000>;
+ interrupts = <22 4>;
+};
+
+AT91 USB device controller
+
+Required properties:
+ - compatible: Should be "atmel,at91rm9200-udc"
+ - reg: Address and length of the register set for the device
+ - interrupts: Should contain macb interrupt
+
+Optional properties:
+ - atmel,vbus-gpio: If present, specifies a gpio that needs to be
+ activated for the bus to be powered.
+
+usb1: gadget@fffa4000 {
+ compatible = "atmel,at91rm9200-udc";
+ reg = <0xfffa4000 0x4000>;
+ interrupts = <10 4>;
+ atmel,vbus-gpio = <&pioC 5 0>;
+};
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/tegra-usb.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/tegra-usb.txt
index 035d63d5646..007005ddbe1 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/tegra-usb.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/tegra-usb.txt
@@ -11,3 +11,16 @@ Required properties :
- phy_type : Should be one of "ulpi" or "utmi".
- nvidia,vbus-gpio : If present, specifies a gpio that needs to be
activated for the bus to be powered.
+
+Optional properties:
+ - dr_mode : dual role mode. Indicates the working mode for
+ nvidia,tegra20-ehci compatible controllers. Can be "host", "peripheral",
+ or "otg". Default to "host" if not defined for backward compatibility.
+ host means this is a host controller
+ peripheral means it is device controller
+ otg means it can operate as either ("on the go")
+ - nvidia,has-legacy-mode : boolean indicates whether this controller can
+ operate in legacy mode (as APX 2500 / 2600). In legacy mode some
+ registers are accessed through the APB_MISC base address instead of
+ the USB controller. Since this is a legacy issue it probably does not
+ warrant a compatible string of its own.
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.txt
index ecc6a6cd26c..82ac057a24a 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.txt
@@ -30,9 +30,11 @@ national National Semiconductor
nintendo Nintendo
nvidia NVIDIA
nxp NXP Semiconductors
+picochip Picochip Ltd
powervr Imagination Technologies
qcom Qualcomm, Inc.
ramtron Ramtron International
+realtek Realtek Semiconductor Corp.
samsung Samsung Semiconductor
sbs Smart Battery System
schindler Schindler
diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/booting-without-of.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/booting-without-of.txt
index 7c1329de059..da0bfeb4253 100644
--- a/Documentation/devicetree/booting-without-of.txt
+++ b/Documentation/devicetree/booting-without-of.txt
@@ -169,7 +169,7 @@ it with special cases.
b) Entry with a flattened device-tree block. Firmware loads the
physical address of the flattened device tree block (dtb) into r2,
- r1 is not used, but it is considered good practise to use a valid
+ r1 is not used, but it is considered good practice to use a valid
machine number as described in Documentation/arm/Booting.
r0 : 0
diff --git a/Documentation/dmaengine.txt b/Documentation/dmaengine.txt
index bbe6cb3d185..879b6e31e2d 100644
--- a/Documentation/dmaengine.txt
+++ b/Documentation/dmaengine.txt
@@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ The slave DMA usage consists of following steps:
struct dma_slave_config *config)
Please see the dma_slave_config structure definition in dmaengine.h
- for a detailed explaination of the struct members. Please note
+ for a detailed explanation of the struct members. Please note
that the 'direction' member will be going away as it duplicates the
direction given in the prepare call.
diff --git a/Documentation/driver-model/devres.txt b/Documentation/driver-model/devres.txt
index 41c0c5d1ba1..2a596a4fc23 100644
--- a/Documentation/driver-model/devres.txt
+++ b/Documentation/driver-model/devres.txt
@@ -271,3 +271,8 @@ IOMAP
pcim_iounmap()
pcim_iomap_table() : array of mapped addresses indexed by BAR
pcim_iomap_regions() : do request_region() and iomap() on multiple BARs
+
+REGULATOR
+ devm_regulator_get()
+ devm_regulator_put()
+ devm_regulator_bulk_get()
diff --git a/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt b/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt
index cc09187a5db..97709e9a307 100644
--- a/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt
+++ b/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt
@@ -119,4 +119,5 @@ o Cards based on the Phillips saa7134 PCI bridge:
- Compro Videomate DVB-T300
- Compro Videomate DVB-T200
- AVerMedia AVerTVHD MCE A180
+ - KWorld PC150-U ATSC Hybrid
diff --git a/Documentation/dvb/lmedm04.txt b/Documentation/dvb/lmedm04.txt
index 10b5f041138..f4b720a1467 100644
--- a/Documentation/dvb/lmedm04.txt
+++ b/Documentation/dvb/lmedm04.txt
@@ -66,5 +66,16 @@ dd if=US290D.sys ibs=1 skip=36856 count=3976 of=dvb-usb-lme2510-s0194.fw
For LME2510C
dd if=US290D.sys ibs=1 skip=33152 count=3697 of=dvb-usb-lme2510c-s0194.fw
+---------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The m88rs2000 tuner driver can be found in windows/system32/drivers
+
+US2B0D.sys (dated 29 Jun 2010)
+
+dd if=US2B0D.sys ibs=1 skip=34432 count=3871 of=dvb-usb-lme2510c-rs2000.fw
+
+We need to modify id of rs2000 firmware or it will warm boot id 3344:1120.
+
+echo -ne \\xF0\\x22 | dd conv=notrunc bs=1 count=2 seek=266 of=dvb-usb-lme2510c-rs2000.fw
Copy the firmware file(s) to /lib/firmware
diff --git a/Documentation/dynamic-debug-howto.txt b/Documentation/dynamic-debug-howto.txt
index f959909d715..74e6c778267 100644
--- a/Documentation/dynamic-debug-howto.txt
+++ b/Documentation/dynamic-debug-howto.txt
@@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ dynamically enabled per-callsite.
Dynamic debug has even more useful features:
* Simple query language allows turning on and off debugging statements by
- matching any combination of:
+ matching any combination of 0 or 1 of:
- source filename
- function name
@@ -79,31 +79,24 @@ Command Language Reference
==========================
At the lexical level, a command comprises a sequence of words separated
-by whitespace characters. Note that newlines are treated as word
-separators and do *not* end a command or allow multiple commands to
-be done together. So these are all equivalent:
+by spaces or tabs. So these are all equivalent:
nullarbor:~ # echo -c 'file svcsock.c line 1603 +p' >
<debugfs>/dynamic_debug/control
nullarbor:~ # echo -c ' file svcsock.c line 1603 +p ' >
<debugfs>/dynamic_debug/control
-nullarbor:~ # echo -c 'file svcsock.c\nline 1603 +p' >
- <debugfs>/dynamic_debug/control
nullarbor:~ # echo -n 'file svcsock.c line 1603 +p' >
<debugfs>/dynamic_debug/control
-Commands are bounded by a write() system call. If you want to do
-multiple commands you need to do a separate "echo" for each, like:
+Command submissions are bounded by a write() system call.
+Multiple commands can be written together, separated by ';' or '\n'.
-nullarbor:~ # echo 'file svcsock.c line 1603 +p' > /proc/dprintk ;\
-> echo 'file svcsock.c line 1563 +p' > /proc/dprintk
+ ~# echo "func pnpacpi_get_resources +p; func pnp_assign_mem +p" \
+ > <debugfs>/dynamic_debug/control
-or even like:
+If your query set is big, you can batch them too:
-nullarbor:~ # (
-> echo 'file svcsock.c line 1603 +p' ;\
-> echo 'file svcsock.c line 1563 +p' ;\
-> ) > /proc/dprintk
+ ~# cat query-batch-file > <debugfs>/dynamic_debug/control
At the syntactical level, a command comprises a sequence of match
specifications, followed by a flags change specification.
@@ -144,11 +137,12 @@ func
func svc_tcp_accept
file
- The given string is compared against either the full
- pathname or the basename of the source file of each
- callsite. Examples:
+ The given string is compared against either the full pathname, the
+ src-root relative pathname, or the basename of the source file of
+ each callsite. Examples:
file svcsock.c
+ file kernel/freezer.c
file /usr/src/packages/BUILD/sgi-enhancednfs-1.4/default/net/sunrpc/svcsock.c
module
diff --git a/Documentation/edac.txt b/Documentation/edac.txt
index 249822cde82..fdcc49fad8e 100644
--- a/Documentation/edac.txt
+++ b/Documentation/edac.txt
@@ -334,8 +334,8 @@ Sdram memory scrubbing rate:
Reading the file will return the actual scrubbing rate employed.
- If configuration fails or memory scrubbing is not implemented, the value
- of the attribute file will be -1.
+ If configuration fails or memory scrubbing is not implemented, accessing
+ that attribute will fail.
diff --git a/Documentation/fb/matroxfb.txt b/Documentation/fb/matroxfb.txt
index e5ce8a1a978..b95f5bb522f 100644
--- a/Documentation/fb/matroxfb.txt
+++ b/Documentation/fb/matroxfb.txt
@@ -177,8 +177,8 @@ sgram - tells to driver that you have Gxx0 with SGRAM memory. It has no
effect without `init'.
sdram - tells to driver that you have Gxx0 with SDRAM memory.
It is a default.
-inv24 - change timings parameters for 24bpp modes on Millenium and
- Millenium II. Specify this if you see strange color shadows around
+inv24 - change timings parameters for 24bpp modes on Millennium and
+ Millennium II. Specify this if you see strange color shadows around
characters.
noinv24 - use standard timings. It is the default.
inverse - invert colors on screen (for LCD displays)
@@ -204,9 +204,9 @@ grayscale - enable grayscale summing. It works in PSEUDOCOLOR modes (text,
can paint colors.
nograyscale - disable grayscale summing. It is default.
cross4MB - enables that pixel line can cross 4MB boundary. It is default for
- non-Millenium.
+ non-Millennium.
nocross4MB - pixel line must not cross 4MB boundary. It is default for
- Millenium I or II, because of these devices have hardware
+ Millennium I or II, because of these devices have hardware
limitations which do not allow this. But this option is
incompatible with some (if not all yet released) versions of
XF86_FBDev.
diff --git a/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt b/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt
index a0ffac029a0..0cad4803ffa 100644
--- a/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt
+++ b/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt
@@ -513,14 +513,19 @@ Who: Bjorn Helgaas <bhelgaas@google.com>
----------------------------
-What: The CAP9 SoC family will be removed
-When: 3.4
-Files: arch/arm/mach-at91/at91cap9.c
- arch/arm/mach-at91/at91cap9_devices.c
- arch/arm/mach-at91/include/mach/at91cap9.h
- arch/arm/mach-at91/include/mach/at91cap9_matrix.h
- arch/arm/mach-at91/include/mach/at91cap9_ddrsdr.h
- arch/arm/mach-at91/board-cap9adk.c
-Why: The code is not actively maintained and platforms are now hard to find.
-Who: Nicolas Ferre <nicolas.ferre@atmel.com>
- Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD <plagnioj@jcrosoft.com>
+What: Low Performance USB Block driver ("CONFIG_BLK_DEV_UB")
+When: 3.6
+Why: This driver provides support for USB storage devices like "USB
+ sticks". As of now, it is deactivated in Debian, Fedora and
+ Ubuntu. All current users can switch over to usb-storage
+ (CONFIG_USB_STORAGE) which only drawback is the additional SCSI
+ stack.
+Who: Sebastian Andrzej Siewior <sebastian@breakpoint.cc>
+
+----------------------------
+
+What: kmap_atomic(page, km_type)
+When: 3.5
+Why: The old kmap_atomic() with two arguments is deprecated, we only
+ keep it for backward compatibility for few cycles and then drop it.
+Who: Cong Wang <amwang@redhat.com>
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/debugfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/debugfs.txt
index 6872c91bce3..7a34f827989 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/debugfs.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/debugfs.txt
@@ -14,7 +14,10 @@ Debugfs is typically mounted with a command like:
mount -t debugfs none /sys/kernel/debug
-(Or an equivalent /etc/fstab line).
+(Or an equivalent /etc/fstab line).
+The debugfs root directory is accessible by anyone by default. To
+restrict access to the tree the "uid", "gid" and "mode" mount
+options can be used.
Note that the debugfs API is exported GPL-only to modules.
@@ -133,7 +136,7 @@ file.
void __iomem *base;
};
- struct dentry *debugfs_create_regset32(const char *name, mode_t mode,
+ struct dentry *debugfs_create_regset32(const char *name, umode_t mode,
struct dentry *parent,
struct debugfs_regset32 *regset);
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/ext4.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/ext4.txt
index 10ec4639f15..1b7f9acbcbb 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/ext4.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/ext4.txt
@@ -144,9 +144,6 @@ journal_async_commit Commit block can be written to disk without waiting
mount the device. This will enable 'journal_checksum'
internally.
-journal=update Update the ext4 file system's journal to the current
- format.
-
journal_dev=devnum When the external journal device's major/minor numbers
have changed, this option allows the user to specify
the new journal location. The journal device is
@@ -308,7 +305,7 @@ min_batch_time=usec This parameter sets the commit time (as
fast disks, at the cost of increasing latency.
journal_ioprio=prio The I/O priority (from 0 to 7, where 0 is the
- highest priorty) which should be used for I/O
+ highest priority) which should be used for I/O
operations submitted by kjournald2 during a
commit operation. This defaults to 3, which is
a slightly higher priority than the default I/O
@@ -343,7 +340,7 @@ noinit_itable Do not initialize any uninitialized inode table
init_itable=n The lazy itable init code will wait n times the
number of milliseconds it took to zero out the
previous block group's inode table. This
- minimizes the impact on the systme performance
+ minimizes the impact on the system performance
while file system's inode table is being initialized.
discard Controls whether ext4 should issue discard/TRIM
@@ -356,11 +353,6 @@ nouid32 Disables 32-bit UIDs and GIDs. This is for
interoperability with older kernels which only
store and expect 16-bit values.
-resize Allows to resize filesystem to the end of the last
- existing block group, further resize has to be done
- with resize2fs either online, or offline. It can be
- used only with conjunction with remount.
-
block_validity This options allows to enables/disables the in-kernel
noblock_validity facility for tracking filesystem metadata blocks
within internal data structures. This allows multi-
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/gfs2-uevents.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/gfs2-uevents.txt
index d8188966929..19a19ebebc3 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/gfs2-uevents.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/gfs2-uevents.txt
@@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ be fixed.
The REMOVE uevent is generated at the end of an unsuccessful mount
or at the end of a umount of the filesystem. All REMOVE uevents will
-have been preceded by at least an ADD uevent for the same fileystem,
+have been preceded by at least an ADD uevent for the same filesystem,
and unlike the other uevents is generated automatically by the kernel's
kobject subsystem.
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/idmapper.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/idmapper.txt
index 120fd3cf7fd..fe03d10bb79 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/idmapper.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/idmapper.txt
@@ -4,13 +4,21 @@ ID Mapper
=========
Id mapper is used by NFS to translate user and group ids into names, and to
translate user and group names into ids. Part of this translation involves
-performing an upcall to userspace to request the information. Id mapper will
-user request-key to perform this upcall and cache the result. The program
-/usr/sbin/nfs.idmap should be called by request-key, and will perform the
-translation and initialize a key with the resulting information.
+performing an upcall to userspace to request the information. There are two
+ways NFS could obtain this information: placing a call to /sbin/request-key
+or by placing a call to the rpc.idmap daemon.
+
+NFS will attempt to call /sbin/request-key first. If this succeeds, the
+result will be cached using the generic request-key cache. This call should
+only fail if /etc/request-key.conf is not configured for the id_resolver key
+type, see the "Configuring" section below if you wish to use the request-key
+method.
+
+If the call to /sbin/request-key fails (if /etc/request-key.conf is not
+configured with the id_resolver key type), then the idmapper will ask the
+legacy rpc.idmap daemon for the id mapping. This result will be stored
+in a custom NFS idmap cache.
- NFS_USE_NEW_IDMAPPER must be selected when configuring the kernel to use this
- feature.
===========
Configuring
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/pnfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/pnfs.txt
index 983e14abe7e..c7919c6e3be 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/pnfs.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/nfs/pnfs.txt
@@ -53,3 +53,57 @@ lseg maintains an extra reference corresponding to the NFS_LSEG_VALID
bit which holds it in the pnfs_layout_hdr's list. When the final lseg
is removed from the pnfs_layout_hdr's list, the NFS_LAYOUT_DESTROYED
bit is set, preventing any new lsegs from being added.
+
+layout drivers
+--------------
+
+PNFS utilizes what is called layout drivers. The STD defines 3 basic
+layout types: "files" "objects" and "blocks". For each of these types
+there is a layout-driver with a common function-vectors table which
+are called by the nfs-client pnfs-core to implement the different layout
+types.
+
+Files-layout-driver code is in: fs/nfs/nfs4filelayout.c && nfs4filelayoutdev.c
+Objects-layout-deriver code is in: fs/nfs/objlayout/.. directory
+Blocks-layout-deriver code is in: fs/nfs/blocklayout/.. directory
+
+objects-layout setup
+--------------------
+
+As part of the full STD implementation the objlayoutdriver.ko needs, at times,
+to automatically login to yet undiscovered iscsi/osd devices. For this the
+driver makes up-calles to a user-mode script called *osd_login*
+
+The path_name of the script to use is by default:
+ /sbin/osd_login.
+This name can be overridden by the Kernel module parameter:
+ objlayoutdriver.osd_login_prog
+
+If Kernel does not find the osd_login_prog path it will zero it out
+and will not attempt farther logins. An admin can then write new value
+to the objlayoutdriver.osd_login_prog Kernel parameter to re-enable it.
+
+The /sbin/osd_login is part of the nfs-utils package, and should usually
+be installed on distributions that support this Kernel version.
+
+The API to the login script is as follows:
+ Usage: $0 -u <URI> -o <OSDNAME> -s <SYSTEMID>
+ Options:
+ -u target uri e.g. iscsi://<ip>:<port>
+ (allways exists)
+ (More protocols can be defined in the future.
+ The client does not interpret this string it is
+ passed unchanged as recieved from the Server)
+ -o osdname of the requested target OSD
+ (Might be empty)
+ (A string which denotes the OSD name, there is a
+ limit of 64 chars on this string)
+ -s systemid of the requested target OSD
+ (Might be empty)
+ (This string, if not empty is always an hex
+ representation of the 20 bytes osd_system_id)
+
+blocks-layout setup
+-------------------
+
+TODO: Document the setup needs of the blocks layout driver
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/pohmelfs/network_protocol.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/pohmelfs/network_protocol.txt
index 65e03dd4482..c680b4b5353 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/pohmelfs/network_protocol.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/pohmelfs/network_protocol.txt
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ Commands can be embedded into transaction command (which in turn has own command
so one can extend protocol as needed without breaking backward compatibility as long
as old commands are supported. All string lengths include tail 0 byte.
-All commands are transferred over the network in big-endian. CPU endianess is used at the end peers.
+All commands are transferred over the network in big-endian. CPU endianness is used at the end peers.
@cmd - command number, which specifies command to be processed. Following
commands are used currently:
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/porting b/Documentation/filesystems/porting
index b4a3d765ff9..74acd961881 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/porting
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/porting
@@ -429,3 +429,9 @@ filemap_write_and_wait_range() so that all dirty pages are synced out properly.
You must also keep in mind that ->fsync() is not called with i_mutex held
anymore, so if you require i_mutex locking you must make sure to take it and
release it yourself.
+
+--
+[mandatory]
+ d_alloc_root() is gone, along with a lot of bugs caused by code
+misusing it. Replacement: d_make_root(inode). The difference is,
+d_make_root() drops the reference to inode if dentry allocation fails.
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt
index a76a26a1db8..b7413cb46dc 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt
@@ -290,7 +290,7 @@ Table 1-4: Contents of the stat files (as of 2.6.30-rc7)
rsslim current limit in bytes on the rss
start_code address above which program text can run
end_code address below which program text can run
- start_stack address of the start of the stack
+ start_stack address of the start of the main process stack
esp current value of ESP
eip current value of EIP
pending bitmap of pending signals
@@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ address perms offset dev inode pathname
a7cb1000-a7cb2000 ---p 00000000 00:00 0
a7cb2000-a7eb2000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0
a7eb2000-a7eb3000 ---p 00000000 00:00 0
-a7eb3000-a7ed5000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0
+a7eb3000-a7ed5000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0 [stack:1001]
a7ed5000-a8008000 r-xp 00000000 03:00 4222 /lib/libc.so.6
a8008000-a800a000 r--p 00133000 03:00 4222 /lib/libc.so.6
a800a000-a800b000 rw-p 00135000 03:00 4222 /lib/libc.so.6
@@ -357,11 +357,39 @@ is not associated with a file:
[heap] = the heap of the program
[stack] = the stack of the main process
+ [stack:1001] = the stack of the thread with tid 1001
[vdso] = the "virtual dynamic shared object",
the kernel system call handler
or if empty, the mapping is anonymous.
+The /proc/PID/task/TID/maps is a view of the virtual memory from the viewpoint
+of the individual tasks of a process. In this file you will see a mapping marked
+as [stack] if that task sees it as a stack. This is a key difference from the
+content of /proc/PID/maps, where you will see all mappings that are being used
+as stack by all of those tasks. Hence, for the example above, the task-level
+map, i.e. /proc/PID/task/TID/maps for thread 1001 will look like this:
+
+08048000-08049000 r-xp 00000000 03:00 8312 /opt/test
+08049000-0804a000 rw-p 00001000 03:00 8312 /opt/test
+0804a000-0806b000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0 [heap]
+a7cb1000-a7cb2000 ---p 00000000 00:00 0
+a7cb2000-a7eb2000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0
+a7eb2000-a7eb3000 ---p 00000000 00:00 0
+a7eb3000-a7ed5000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0 [stack]
+a7ed5000-a8008000 r-xp 00000000 03:00 4222 /lib/libc.so.6
+a8008000-a800a000 r--p 00133000 03:00 4222 /lib/libc.so.6
+a800a000-a800b000 rw-p 00135000 03:00 4222 /lib/libc.so.6
+a800b000-a800e000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0
+a800e000-a8022000 r-xp 00000000 03:00 14462 /lib/libpthread.so.0
+a8022000-a8023000 r--p 00013000 03:00 14462 /lib/libpthread.so.0
+a8023000-a8024000 rw-p 00014000 03:00 14462 /lib/libpthread.so.0
+a8024000-a8027000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0
+a8027000-a8043000 r-xp 00000000 03:00 8317 /lib/ld-linux.so.2
+a8043000-a8044000 r--p 0001b000 03:00 8317 /lib/ld-linux.so.2
+a8044000-a8045000 rw-p 0001c000 03:00 8317 /lib/ld-linux.so.2
+aff35000-aff4a000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0
+ffffe000-fffff000 r-xp 00000000 00:00 0 [vdso]
The /proc/PID/smaps is an extension based on maps, showing the memory
consumption for each of the process's mappings. For each of mappings there
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/qnx6.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/qnx6.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..050223ea03c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/qnx6.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,174 @@
+The QNX6 Filesystem
+===================
+
+The qnx6fs is used by newer QNX operating system versions. (e.g. Neutrino)
+It got introduced in QNX 6.4.0 and is used default since 6.4.1.
+
+Option
+======
+
+mmi_fs Mount filesystem as used for example by Audi MMI 3G system
+
+Specification
+=============
+
+qnx6fs shares many properties with traditional Unix filesystems. It has the
+concepts of blocks, inodes and directories.
+On QNX it is possible to create little endian and big endian qnx6 filesystems.
+This feature makes it possible to create and use a different endianness fs
+for the target (QNX is used on quite a range of embedded systems) plattform
+running on a different endianess.
+The Linux driver handles endianness transparently. (LE and BE)
+
+Blocks
+------
+
+The space in the device or file is split up into blocks. These are a fixed
+size of 512, 1024, 2048 or 4096, which is decided when the filesystem is
+created.
+Blockpointers are 32bit, so the maximum space that can be adressed is
+2^32 * 4096 bytes or 16TB
+
+The superblocks
+---------------
+
+The superblock contains all global information about the filesystem.
+Each qnx6fs got two superblocks, each one having a 64bit serial number.
+That serial number is used to identify the "active" superblock.
+In write mode with reach new snapshot (after each synchronous write), the
+serial of the new master superblock is increased (old superblock serial + 1)
+
+So basically the snapshot functionality is realized by an atomic final
+update of the serial number. Before updating that serial, all modifications
+are done by copying all modified blocks during that specific write request
+(or period) and building up a new (stable) filesystem structure under the
+inactive superblock.
+
+Each superblock holds a set of root inodes for the different filesystem
+parts. (Inode, Bitmap and Longfilenames)
+Each of these root nodes holds information like total size of the stored
+data and the adressing levels in that specific tree.
+If the level value is 0, up to 16 direct blocks can be adressed by each
+node.
+Level 1 adds an additional indirect adressing level where each indirect
+adressing block holds up to blocksize / 4 bytes pointers to data blocks.
+Level 2 adds an additional indirect adressig block level (so, already up
+to 16 * 256 * 256 = 1048576 blocks that can be adressed by such a tree)a
+
+Unused block pointers are always set to ~0 - regardless of root node,
+indirect adressing blocks or inodes.
+Data leaves are always on the lowest level. So no data is stored on upper
+tree levels.
+
+The first Superblock is located at 0x2000. (0x2000 is the bootblock size)
+The Audi MMI 3G first superblock directly starts at byte 0.
+Second superblock position can either be calculated from the superblock
+information (total number of filesystem blocks) or by taking the highest
+device address, zeroing the last 3 bytes and then substracting 0x1000 from
+that address.
+
+0x1000 is the size reserved for each superblock - regardless of the
+blocksize of the filesystem.
+
+Inodes
+------
+
+Each object in the filesystem is represented by an inode. (index node)
+The inode structure contains pointers to the filesystem blocks which contain
+the data held in the object and all of the metadata about an object except
+its longname. (filenames longer than 27 characters)
+The metadata about an object includes the permissions, owner, group, flags,
+size, number of blocks used, access time, change time and modification time.
+
+Object mode field is POSIX format. (which makes things easier)
+
+There are also pointers to the first 16 blocks, if the object data can be
+adressed with 16 direct blocks.
+For more than 16 blocks an indirect adressing in form of another tree is
+used. (scheme is the same as the one used for the superblock root nodes)
+
+The filesize is stored 64bit. Inode counting starts with 1. (whilst long
+filename inodes start with 0)
+
+Directories
+-----------
+
+A directory is a filesystem object and has an inode just like a file.
+It is a specially formatted file containing records which associate each
+name with an inode number.
+'.' inode number points to the directory inode
+'..' inode number points to the parent directory inode
+Eeach filename record additionally got a filename length field.
+
+One special case are long filenames or subdirectory names.
+These got set a filename length field of 0xff in the corresponding directory
+record plus the longfile inode number also stored in that record.
+With that longfilename inode number, the longfilename tree can be walked
+starting with the superblock longfilename root node pointers.
+
+Special files
+-------------
+
+Symbolic links are also filesystem objects with inodes. They got a specific
+bit in the inode mode field identifying them as symbolic link.
+The directory entry file inode pointer points to the target file inode.
+
+Hard links got an inode, a directory entry, but a specific mode bit set,
+no block pointers and the directory file record pointing to the target file
+inode.
+
+Character and block special devices do not exist in QNX as those files
+are handled by the QNX kernel/drivers and created in /dev independant of the
+underlaying filesystem.
+
+Long filenames
+--------------
+
+Long filenames are stored in a seperate adressing tree. The staring point
+is the longfilename root node in the active superblock.
+Each data block (tree leaves) holds one long filename. That filename is
+limited to 510 bytes. The first two starting bytes are used as length field
+for the actual filename.
+If that structure shall fit for all allowed blocksizes, it is clear why there
+is a limit of 510 bytes for the actual filename stored.
+
+Bitmap
+------
+
+The qnx6fs filesystem allocation bitmap is stored in a tree under bitmap
+root node in the superblock and each bit in the bitmap represents one
+filesystem block.
+The first block is block 0, which starts 0x1000 after superblock start.
+So for a normal qnx6fs 0x3000 (bootblock + superblock) is the physical
+address at which block 0 is located.
+
+Bits at the end of the last bitmap block are set to 1, if the device is
+smaller than addressing space in the bitmap.
+
+Bitmap system area
+------------------
+
+The bitmap itself is devided into three parts.
+First the system area, that is split into two halfs.
+Then userspace.
+
+The requirement for a static, fixed preallocated system area comes from how
+qnx6fs deals with writes.
+Each superblock got it's own half of the system area. So superblock #1
+always uses blocks from the lower half whilst superblock #2 just writes to
+blocks represented by the upper half bitmap system area bits.
+
+Bitmap blocks, Inode blocks and indirect addressing blocks for those two
+tree structures are treated as system blocks.
+
+The rational behind that is that a write request can work on a new snapshot
+(system area of the inactive - resp. lower serial numbered superblock) while
+at the same time there is still a complete stable filesystem structer in the
+other half of the system area.
+
+When finished with writing (a sync write is completed, the maximum sync leap
+time or a filesystem sync is requested), serial of the previously inactive
+superblock atomically is increased and the fs switches over to that - then
+stable declared - superblock.
+
+For all data outside the system area, blocks are just copied while writing.
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/ramfs-rootfs-initramfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/ramfs-rootfs-initramfs.txt
index a8273d5fad2..59b4a0962e0 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/ramfs-rootfs-initramfs.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/ramfs-rootfs-initramfs.txt
@@ -297,7 +297,7 @@ the above threads) is:
either way about the archive format, and there are alternative tools,
such as:
- http://freshmeat.net/projects/afio/
+ http://freecode.com/projects/afio
2) The cpio archive format chosen by the kernel is simpler and cleaner (and
thus easier to create and parse) than any of the (literally dozens of)
diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt
index 3d9393b845b..e916e3d3648 100644
--- a/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt
+++ b/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt
@@ -993,7 +993,7 @@ struct dentry_operations {
If the 'rcu_walk' parameter is true, then the caller is doing a
pathwalk in RCU-walk mode. Sleeping is not permitted in this mode,
- and the caller can be asked to leave it and call again by returing
+ and the caller can be asked to leave it and call again by returning
-ECHILD.
This function is only used if DCACHE_MANAGE_TRANSIT is set on the
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/adm1275 b/Documentation/hwmon/adm1275
index ab70d96d2df..2cfa2566712 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/adm1275
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/adm1275
@@ -2,6 +2,10 @@ Kernel driver adm1275
=====================
Supported chips:
+ * Analog Devices ADM1075
+ Prefix: 'adm1075'
+ Addresses scanned: -
+ Datasheet: www.analog.com/static/imported-files/data_sheets/ADM1075.pdf
* Analog Devices ADM1275
Prefix: 'adm1275'
Addresses scanned: -
@@ -17,13 +21,13 @@ Author: Guenter Roeck <guenter.roeck@ericsson.com>
Description
-----------
-This driver supports hardware montoring for Analog Devices ADM1275 and ADM1276
-Hot-Swap Controller and Digital Power Monitor.
+This driver supports hardware montoring for Analog Devices ADM1075, ADM1275,
+and ADM1276 Hot-Swap Controller and Digital Power Monitor.
-ADM1275 and ADM1276 are hot-swap controllers that allow a circuit board to be
-removed from or inserted into a live backplane. They also feature current and
-voltage readback via an integrated 12-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC),
-accessed using a PMBus interface.
+ADM1075, ADM1275, and ADM1276 are hot-swap controllers that allow a circuit
+board to be removed from or inserted into a live backplane. They also feature
+current and voltage readback via an integrated 12-bit analog-to-digital
+converter (ADC), accessed using a PMBus interface.
The driver is a client driver to the core PMBus driver. Please see
Documentation/hwmon/pmbus for details on PMBus client drivers.
@@ -36,6 +40,10 @@ This driver does not auto-detect devices. You will have to instantiate the
devices explicitly. Please see Documentation/i2c/instantiating-devices for
details.
+The ADM1075, unlike many other PMBus devices, does not support internal voltage
+or current scaling. Reported voltages, currents, and power are raw measurements,
+and will typically have to be scaled.
+
Platform data support
---------------------
@@ -51,9 +59,10 @@ The following attributes are supported. Limits are read-write, history reset
attributes are write-only, all other attributes are read-only.
in1_label "vin1" or "vout1" depending on chip variant and
- configuration.
+ configuration. On ADM1075, vout1 reports the voltage on
+ the VAUX pin.
in1_input Measured voltage.
-in1_min Minumum Voltage.
+in1_min Minimum Voltage.
in1_max Maximum voltage.
in1_min_alarm Voltage low alarm.
in1_max_alarm Voltage high alarm.
@@ -74,3 +83,10 @@ curr1_crit Critical maximum current. Depending on the chip
curr1_crit_alarm Critical current high alarm.
curr1_highest Historical maximum current.
curr1_reset_history Write any value to reset history.
+
+power1_label "pin1"
+power1_input Input power.
+power1_reset_history Write any value to reset history.
+
+ Power attributes are supported on ADM1075 and ADM1276
+ only.
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/jc42 b/Documentation/hwmon/jc42
index a22ecf48f25..66ecb9fc824 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/jc42
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/jc42
@@ -3,57 +3,50 @@ Kernel driver jc42
Supported chips:
* Analog Devices ADT7408
- Prefix: 'adt7408'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
Datasheets:
http://www.analog.com/static/imported-files/data_sheets/ADT7408.pdf
- * IDT TSE2002B3, TS3000B3
- Prefix: 'tse2002b3', 'ts3000b3'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
+ * Atmel AT30TS00
Datasheets:
- http://www.idt.com/products/getdoc.cfm?docid=18715691
- http://www.idt.com/products/getdoc.cfm?docid=18715692
+ http://www.atmel.com/Images/doc8585.pdf
+ * IDT TSE2002B3, TSE2002GB2, TS3000B3, TS3000GB2
+ Datasheets:
+ http://www.idt.com/sites/default/files/documents/IDT_TSE2002B3C_DST_20100512_120303152056.pdf
+ http://www.idt.com/sites/default/files/documents/IDT_TSE2002GB2A1_DST_20111107_120303145914.pdf
+ http://www.idt.com/sites/default/files/documents/IDT_TS3000B3A_DST_20101129_120303152013.pdf
+ http://www.idt.com/sites/default/files/documents/IDT_TS3000GB2A1_DST_20111104_120303151012.pdf
* Maxim MAX6604
- Prefix: 'max6604'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
Datasheets:
http://datasheets.maxim-ic.com/en/ds/MAX6604.pdf
- * Microchip MCP9805, MCP98242, MCP98243, MCP9843
- Prefixes: 'mcp9805', 'mcp98242', 'mcp98243', 'mcp9843'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
+ * Microchip MCP9804, MCP9805, MCP98242, MCP98243, MCP9843
Datasheets:
+ http://ww1.microchip.com/downloads/en/DeviceDoc/22203C.pdf
http://ww1.microchip.com/downloads/en/DeviceDoc/21977b.pdf
http://ww1.microchip.com/downloads/en/DeviceDoc/21996a.pdf
http://ww1.microchip.com/downloads/en/DeviceDoc/22153c.pdf
- * NXP Semiconductors SE97, SE97B
- Prefix: 'se97'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
+ * NXP Semiconductors SE97, SE97B, SE98, SE98A
Datasheets:
http://www.nxp.com/documents/data_sheet/SE97.pdf
http://www.nxp.com/documents/data_sheet/SE97B.pdf
- * NXP Semiconductors SE98
- Prefix: 'se98'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
- Datasheets:
http://www.nxp.com/documents/data_sheet/SE98.pdf
+ http://www.nxp.com/documents/data_sheet/SE98A.pdf
* ON Semiconductor CAT34TS02, CAT6095
- Prefix: 'cat34ts02', 'cat6095'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
Datasheet:
http://www.onsemi.com/pub_link/Collateral/CAT34TS02-D.PDF
http://www.onsemi.com/pub/Collateral/CAT6095-D.PDF
- * ST Microelectronics STTS424, STTS424E02
- Prefix: 'stts424'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
+ * ST Microelectronics STTS424, STTS424E02, STTS2002, STTS3000
Datasheets:
- http://www.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13447/stts424.pdf
- http://www.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13448/stts424e02.pdf
+ http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATASHEET/CD00157556.pdf
+ http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATASHEET/CD00157558.pdf
+ http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATASHEET/CD00225278.pdf
+ http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/CD00270920.pdf
* JEDEC JC 42.4 compliant temperature sensor chips
- Prefix: 'jc42'
- Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
Datasheet:
http://www.jedec.org/sites/default/files/docs/4_01_04R19.pdf
+ Common for all chips:
+ Prefix: 'jc42'
+ Addresses scanned: I2C 0x18 - 0x1f
+
Author:
Guenter Roeck <guenter.roeck@ericsson.com>
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/lm80 b/Documentation/hwmon/lm80
index cb5b407ba3e..a60b43efc32 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/lm80
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/lm80
@@ -7,6 +7,11 @@ Supported chips:
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x28 - 0x2f
Datasheet: Publicly available at the National Semiconductor website
http://www.national.com/
+ * National Semiconductor LM96080
+ Prefix: 'lm96080'
+ Addresses scanned: I2C 0x28 - 0x2f
+ Datasheet: Publicly available at the National Semiconductor website
+ http://www.national.com/
Authors:
Frodo Looijaard <frodol@dds.nl>,
@@ -17,7 +22,9 @@ Description
This driver implements support for the National Semiconductor LM80.
It is described as a 'Serial Interface ACPI-Compatible Microprocessor
-System Hardware Monitor'.
+System Hardware Monitor'. The LM96080 is a more recent incarnation,
+it is pin and register compatible, with a few additional features not
+yet supported by the driver.
The LM80 implements one temperature sensor, two fan rotation speed sensors,
seven voltage sensors, alarms, and some miscellaneous stuff.
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/lm90 b/Documentation/hwmon/lm90
index 9cd14cfe651..b466974e142 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/lm90
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/lm90
@@ -118,6 +118,10 @@ Supported chips:
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x48 through 0x4F
Datasheet: Publicly available at NXP website
http://ics.nxp.com/products/interface/datasheet/sa56004x.pdf
+ * GMT G781
+ Prefix: 'g781'
+ Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c, 0x4d
+ Datasheet: Not publicly available from GMT
Author: Jean Delvare <khali@linux-fr.org>
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/max16064 b/Documentation/hwmon/max16064
index f6e8bcbfacc..f8b478076f6 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/max16064
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/max16064
@@ -42,9 +42,9 @@ attributes are read-only.
in[1-4]_label "vout[1-4]"
in[1-4]_input Measured voltage. From READ_VOUT register.
-in[1-4]_min Minumum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
+in[1-4]_min Minimum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
in[1-4]_max Maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_WARN_LIMIT register.
-in[1-4]_lcrit Critical minumum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
+in[1-4]_lcrit Critical minimum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[1-4]_crit Critical maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[1-4]_min_alarm Voltage low alarm. From VOLTAGE_UV_WARNING status.
in[1-4]_max_alarm Voltage high alarm. From VOLTAGE_OV_WARNING status.
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/max34440 b/Documentation/hwmon/max34440
index 8ab51536a1e..04482226db2 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/max34440
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/max34440
@@ -11,6 +11,11 @@ Supported chips:
Prefixes: 'max34441'
Addresses scanned: -
Datasheet: http://datasheets.maxim-ic.com/en/ds/MAX34441.pdf
+ * Maxim MAX34446
+ PMBus Power-Supply Data Logger
+ Prefixes: 'max34446'
+ Addresses scanned: -
+ Datasheet: http://datasheets.maxim-ic.com/en/ds/MAX34446.pdf
Author: Guenter Roeck <guenter.roeck@ericsson.com>
@@ -19,8 +24,8 @@ Description
-----------
This driver supports hardware montoring for Maxim MAX34440 PMBus 6-Channel
-Power-Supply Manager and MAX34441 PMBus 5-Channel Power-Supply Manager
-and Intelligent Fan Controller.
+Power-Supply Manager, MAX34441 PMBus 5-Channel Power-Supply Manager
+and Intelligent Fan Controller, and MAX34446 PMBus Power-Supply Data Logger.
The driver is a client driver to the core PMBus driver. Please see
Documentation/hwmon/pmbus for details on PMBus client drivers.
@@ -33,6 +38,13 @@ This driver does not auto-detect devices. You will have to instantiate the
devices explicitly. Please see Documentation/i2c/instantiating-devices for
details.
+For MAX34446, the value of the currX_crit attribute determines if current or
+voltage measurement is enabled for a given channel. Voltage measurement is
+enabled if currX_crit is set to 0; current measurement is enabled if the
+attribute is set to a positive value. Power measurement is only enabled if
+channel 1 (3) is configured for voltage measurement, and channel 2 (4) is
+configured for current measurement.
+
Platform data support
---------------------
@@ -48,27 +60,39 @@ attributes are read-only.
in[1-6]_label "vout[1-6]".
in[1-6]_input Measured voltage. From READ_VOUT register.
-in[1-6]_min Minumum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
+in[1-6]_min Minimum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
in[1-6]_max Maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_WARN_LIMIT register.
-in[1-6]_lcrit Critical minumum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
+in[1-6]_lcrit Critical minimum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[1-6]_crit Critical maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[1-6]_min_alarm Voltage low alarm. From VOLTAGE_UV_WARNING status.
in[1-6]_max_alarm Voltage high alarm. From VOLTAGE_OV_WARNING status.
in[1-6]_lcrit_alarm Voltage critical low alarm. From VOLTAGE_UV_FAULT status.
in[1-6]_crit_alarm Voltage critical high alarm. From VOLTAGE_OV_FAULT status.
+in[1-6]_lowest Historical minimum voltage.
in[1-6]_highest Historical maximum voltage.
in[1-6]_reset_history Write any value to reset history.
+ MAX34446 only supports in[1-4].
+
curr[1-6]_label "iout[1-6]".
curr[1-6]_input Measured current. From READ_IOUT register.
curr[1-6]_max Maximum current. From IOUT_OC_WARN_LIMIT register.
curr[1-6]_crit Critical maximum current. From IOUT_OC_FAULT_LIMIT register.
curr[1-6]_max_alarm Current high alarm. From IOUT_OC_WARNING status.
curr[1-6]_crit_alarm Current critical high alarm. From IOUT_OC_FAULT status.
+curr[1-4]_average Historical average current (MAX34446 only).
curr[1-6]_highest Historical maximum current.
curr[1-6]_reset_history Write any value to reset history.
in6 and curr6 attributes only exist for MAX34440.
+ MAX34446 only supports curr[1-4].
+
+power[1,3]_label "pout[1,3]"
+power[1,3]_input Measured power.
+power[1,3]_average Historical average power.
+power[1,3]_highest Historical maximum power.
+
+ Power attributes only exist for MAX34446.
temp[1-8]_input Measured temperatures. From READ_TEMPERATURE_1 register.
temp1 is the chip's internal temperature. temp2..temp5
@@ -79,7 +103,9 @@ temp[1-8]_max Maximum temperature. From OT_WARN_LIMIT register.
temp[1-8]_crit Critical high temperature. From OT_FAULT_LIMIT register.
temp[1-8]_max_alarm Temperature high alarm.
temp[1-8]_crit_alarm Temperature critical high alarm.
+temp[1-8]_average Historical average temperature (MAX34446 only).
temp[1-8]_highest Historical maximum temperature.
temp[1-8]_reset_history Write any value to reset history.
temp7 and temp8 attributes only exist for MAX34440.
+ MAX34446 only supports temp[1-3].
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/max8688 b/Documentation/hwmon/max8688
index 71ed10a3c94..fe849871df3 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/max8688
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/max8688
@@ -42,9 +42,9 @@ attributes are read-only.
in1_label "vout1"
in1_input Measured voltage. From READ_VOUT register.
-in1_min Minumum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
+in1_min Minimum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
in1_max Maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_WARN_LIMIT register.
-in1_lcrit Critical minumum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
+in1_lcrit Critical minimum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in1_crit Critical maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in1_min_alarm Voltage low alarm. From VOLTAGE_UV_WARNING status.
in1_max_alarm Voltage high alarm. From VOLTAGE_OV_WARNING status.
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/mc13783-adc b/Documentation/hwmon/mc13783-adc
index 044531a8640..d0e7b3fa9e7 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/mc13783-adc
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/mc13783-adc
@@ -3,8 +3,11 @@ Kernel driver mc13783-adc
Supported chips:
* Freescale Atlas MC13783
- Prefix: 'mc13783_adc'
+ Prefix: 'mc13783'
Datasheet: http://www.freescale.com/files/rf_if/doc/data_sheet/MC13783.pdf?fsrch=1
+ * Freescale Atlas MC13892
+ Prefix: 'mc13892'
+ Datasheet: http://cache.freescale.com/files/analog/doc/data_sheet/MC13892.pdf?fsrch=1&sr=1
Authors:
Sascha Hauer <s.hauer@pengutronix.de>
@@ -13,20 +16,21 @@ Authors:
Description
-----------
-The Freescale MC13783 is a Power Management and Audio Circuit. Among
-other things it contains a 10-bit A/D converter. The converter has 16
-channels which can be used in different modes.
-The A/D converter has a resolution of 2.25mV. Channels 0-4 have
-a dedicated meaning with chip internal scaling applied. Channels 5-7
-can be used as general purpose inputs or alternatively in a dedicated
-mode. Channels 12-15 are occupied by the touchscreen if it's active.
+The Freescale MC13783 and MC13892 are Power Management and Audio Circuits.
+Among other things they contain a 10-bit A/D converter. The converter has 16
+(MC13783) resp. 12 (MC13892) channels which can be used in different modes. The
+A/D converter has a resolution of 2.25mV.
-Currently the driver only supports channels 2 and 5-15 with no alternative
-modes for channels 5-7.
+Some channels can be used as General Purpose inputs or in a dedicated mode with
+a chip internal scaling applied .
-See this table for the meaning of the different channels and their chip
-internal scaling:
+Currently the driver only supports the Application Supply channel (BP / BPSNS),
+the General Purpose inputs and touchscreen.
+See the following tables for the meaning of the different channels and their
+chip internal scaling:
+
+MC13783:
Channel Signal Input Range Scaling
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
0 Battery Voltage (BATT) 2.50 - 4.65V -2.40V
@@ -34,7 +38,7 @@ Channel Signal Input Range Scaling
2 Application Supply (BP) 2.50 - 4.65V -2.40V
3 Charger Voltage (CHRGRAW) 0 - 10V / /5
0 - 20V /10
-4 Charger Current (CHRGISNSP-CHRGISNSN) -0.25V - 0.25V x4
+4 Charger Current (CHRGISNSP-CHRGISNSN) -0.25 - 0.25V x4
5 General Purpose ADIN5 / Battery Pack Thermistor 0 - 2.30V No
6 General Purpose ADIN6 / Backup Voltage (LICELL) 0 - 2.30V / No /
1.50 - 3.50V -1.20V
@@ -48,3 +52,23 @@ Channel Signal Input Range Scaling
13 General Purpose TSX2 / Touchscreen X-plate 2 0 - 2.30V No
14 General Purpose TSY1 / Touchscreen Y-plate 1 0 - 2.30V No
15 General Purpose TSY2 / Touchscreen Y-plate 2 0 - 2.30V No
+
+MC13892:
+Channel Signal Input Range Scaling
+-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+0 Battery Voltage (BATT) 0 - 4.8V /2
+1 Battery Current (BATT - BATTISNSCC) -60 - 60 mV x20
+2 Application Supply (BPSNS) 0 - 4.8V /2
+3 Charger Voltage (CHRGRAW) 0 - 12V / /5
+ 0 - 20V /10
+4 Charger Current (CHRGISNS-BPSNS) / -0.3 - 0.3V / x4 /
+ Touchscreen X-plate 1 0 - 2.4V No
+5 General Purpose ADIN5 / Battery Pack Thermistor 0 - 2.4V No
+6 General Purpose ADIN6 / Backup Voltage (LICELL) 0 - 2.4V / No
+ Backup Voltage (LICELL) 0 - 3.6V x2/3
+7 General Purpose ADIN7 / UID / Die Temperature 0 - 2.4V / No /
+ 0 - 4.8V /2
+12 General Purpose TSX1 / Touchscreen X-plate 1 0 - 2.4V No
+13 General Purpose TSX2 / Touchscreen X-plate 2 0 - 2.4V No
+14 General Purpose TSY1 / Touchscreen Y-plate 1 0 - 2.4V No
+15 General Purpose TSY2 / Touchscreen Y-plate 2 0 - 2.4V No
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/mcp3021 b/Documentation/hwmon/mcp3021
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..325fd87e81b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/mcp3021
@@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
+Kernel driver MCP3021
+======================
+
+Supported chips:
+ * Microchip Technology MCP3021
+ Prefix: 'mcp3021'
+ Datasheet: http://ww1.microchip.com/downloads/en/DeviceDoc/21805a.pdf
+
+Author: Mingkai Hu
+
+Description
+-----------
+
+This driver implements support for the Microchip Technology MCP3021 chip.
+
+The Microchip Technology Inc. MCP3021 is a successive approximation A/D
+converter (ADC) with 10-bit resolution.
+This device provides one single-ended input with very low power consumption.
+Communication to the MCP3021 is performed using a 2-wire I2C compatible
+interface. Standard (100 kHz) and Fast (400 kHz) I2C modes are available.
+The default I2C device address is 0x4d (contact the Microchip factory for
+additional address options).
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/pmbus b/Documentation/hwmon/pmbus
index d28b591753d..f90f99920cc 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/pmbus
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/pmbus
@@ -15,13 +15,20 @@ Supported chips:
http://www.onsemi.com/pub_link/Collateral/NCP4200-D.PDF
http://www.onsemi.com/pub_link/Collateral/JUNE%202009-%20REV.%200.PDF
* Lineage Power
- Prefixes: 'pdt003', 'pdt006', 'pdt012', 'udt020'
+ Prefixes: 'mdt040', 'pdt003', 'pdt006', 'pdt012', 'udt020'
Addresses scanned: -
Datasheets:
http://www.lineagepower.com/oem/pdf/PDT003A0X.pdf
http://www.lineagepower.com/oem/pdf/PDT006A0X.pdf
http://www.lineagepower.com/oem/pdf/PDT012A0X.pdf
http://www.lineagepower.com/oem/pdf/UDT020A0X.pdf
+ http://www.lineagepower.com/oem/pdf/MDT040A0X.pdf
+ * Texas Instruments TPS40400, TPS40422
+ Prefixes: 'tps40400', 'tps40422'
+ Addresses scanned: -
+ Datasheets:
+ http://www.ti.com/lit/gpn/tps40400
+ http://www.ti.com/lit/gpn/tps40422
* Generic PMBus devices
Prefix: 'pmbus'
Addresses scanned: -
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/sch5627 b/Documentation/hwmon/sch5627
index 446a054e491..0551d266c51 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/sch5627
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/sch5627
@@ -16,6 +16,11 @@ Description
SMSC SCH5627 Super I/O chips include complete hardware monitoring
capabilities. They can monitor up to 5 voltages, 4 fans and 8 temperatures.
+The SMSC SCH5627 hardware monitoring part also contains an integrated
+watchdog. In order for this watchdog to function some motherboard specific
+initialization most be done by the BIOS, so if the watchdog is not enabled
+by the BIOS the sch5627 driver will not register a watchdog device.
+
The hardware monitoring part of the SMSC SCH5627 is accessed by talking
through an embedded microcontroller. An application note describing the
protocol for communicating with the microcontroller is available upon
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/sch5636 b/Documentation/hwmon/sch5636
index f83bd1c260f..7b0a01da071 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/sch5636
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/sch5636
@@ -26,6 +26,9 @@ temperatures. Note that the driver detects how many fan headers /
temperature sensors are actually implemented on the motherboard, so you will
likely see fewer temperature and fan inputs.
+The Fujitsu Theseus hwmon solution also contains an integrated watchdog.
+This watchdog is fully supported by the sch5636 driver.
+
An application note describing the Theseus' registers, as well as an
application note describing the protocol for communicating with the
microcontroller is available upon request. Please mail me if you want a copy.
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9000 b/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9000
index 40ca6db50c4..0df5f276505 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9000
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9000
@@ -70,9 +70,9 @@ attributes are read-only.
in[1-12]_label "vout[1-12]".
in[1-12]_input Measured voltage. From READ_VOUT register.
-in[1-12]_min Minumum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
+in[1-12]_min Minimum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
in[1-12]_max Maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_WARN_LIMIT register.
-in[1-12]_lcrit Critical minumum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
+in[1-12]_lcrit Critical minimum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[1-12]_crit Critical maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[1-12]_min_alarm Voltage low alarm. From VOLTAGE_UV_WARNING status.
in[1-12]_max_alarm Voltage high alarm. From VOLTAGE_OV_WARNING status.
@@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ in[1-12]_crit_alarm Voltage critical high alarm. From VOLTAGE_OV_FAULT status.
curr[1-12]_label "iout[1-12]".
curr[1-12]_input Measured current. From READ_IOUT register.
curr[1-12]_max Maximum current. From IOUT_OC_WARN_LIMIT register.
-curr[1-12]_lcrit Critical minumum output current. From IOUT_UC_FAULT_LIMIT
+curr[1-12]_lcrit Critical minimum output current. From IOUT_UC_FAULT_LIMIT
register.
curr[1-12]_crit Critical maximum current. From IOUT_OC_FAULT_LIMIT register.
curr[1-12]_max_alarm Current high alarm. From IOUT_OC_WARNING status.
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9200 b/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9200
index 3c58607f72f..fd7d07b1908 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9200
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/ucd9200
@@ -54,9 +54,9 @@ attributes are read-only.
in1_label "vin".
in1_input Measured voltage. From READ_VIN register.
-in1_min Minumum Voltage. From VIN_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
+in1_min Minimum Voltage. From VIN_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
in1_max Maximum voltage. From VIN_OV_WARN_LIMIT register.
-in1_lcrit Critical minumum Voltage. VIN_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
+in1_lcrit Critical minimum Voltage. VIN_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in1_crit Critical maximum voltage. From VIN_OV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in1_min_alarm Voltage low alarm. From VIN_UV_WARNING status.
in1_max_alarm Voltage high alarm. From VIN_OV_WARNING status.
@@ -65,9 +65,9 @@ in1_crit_alarm Voltage critical high alarm. From VIN_OV_FAULT status.
in[2-5]_label "vout[1-4]".
in[2-5]_input Measured voltage. From READ_VOUT register.
-in[2-5]_min Minumum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
+in[2-5]_min Minimum Voltage. From VOUT_UV_WARN_LIMIT register.
in[2-5]_max Maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_WARN_LIMIT register.
-in[2-5]_lcrit Critical minumum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
+in[2-5]_lcrit Critical minimum Voltage. VOUT_UV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[2-5]_crit Critical maximum voltage. From VOUT_OV_FAULT_LIMIT register.
in[2-5]_min_alarm Voltage low alarm. From VOLTAGE_UV_WARNING status.
in[2-5]_max_alarm Voltage high alarm. From VOLTAGE_OV_WARNING status.
@@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ curr1_input Measured current. From READ_IIN register.
curr[2-5]_label "iout[1-4]".
curr[2-5]_input Measured current. From READ_IOUT register.
curr[2-5]_max Maximum current. From IOUT_OC_WARN_LIMIT register.
-curr[2-5]_lcrit Critical minumum output current. From IOUT_UC_FAULT_LIMIT
+curr[2-5]_lcrit Critical minimum output current. From IOUT_UC_FAULT_LIMIT
register.
curr[2-5]_crit Critical maximum current. From IOUT_OC_FAULT_LIMIT register.
curr[2-5]_max_alarm Current high alarm. From IOUT_OC_WARNING status.
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/w83627ehf b/Documentation/hwmon/w83627ehf
index 3f44dbdfda7..ceaf6f652b0 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/w83627ehf
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/w83627ehf
@@ -50,7 +50,7 @@ W83627DHG, W83627DHG-P, W83627UHG, W83667HG, W83667HG-B, W83667HG-I
(NCT6775F), and NCT6776F super I/O chips. We will refer to them collectively
as Winbond chips.
-The chips implement 2 to 4 temperature sensors (9 for NCT6775F and NCT6776F),
+The chips implement 3 to 4 temperature sensors (9 for NCT6775F and NCT6776F),
2 to 5 fan rotation speed sensors, 8 to 10 analog voltage sensors, one VID
(except for 627UHG), alarms with beep warnings (control unimplemented),
and some automatic fan regulation strategies (plus manual fan control mode).
@@ -143,8 +143,13 @@ pwm[1-4]_min_output - minimum fan speed (range 1 - 255), when the temperature
pwm[1-4]_stop_time - how many milliseconds [ms] must elapse to switch
corresponding fan off. (when the temperature was below
defined range).
+pwm[1-4]_start_output-minimum fan speed (range 1 - 255) when spinning up
+pwm[1-4]_step_output- rate of fan speed change (1 - 255)
+pwm[1-4]_stop_output- minimum fan speed (range 1 - 255) when spinning down
+pwm[1-4]_max_output - maximum fan speed (range 1 - 255), when the temperature
+ is above defined range.
-Note: last two functions are influenced by other control bits, not yet exported
+Note: last six functions are influenced by other control bits, not yet exported
by the driver, so a change might not have any effect.
Implementation Details
diff --git a/Documentation/hwmon/zl6100 b/Documentation/hwmon/zl6100
index 51f76a189fe..a995b41724f 100644
--- a/Documentation/hwmon/zl6100
+++ b/Documentation/hwmon/zl6100
@@ -34,6 +34,14 @@ Supported chips:
Prefix: 'zl6105'
Addresses scanned: -
Datasheet: http://www.intersil.com/data/fn/fn6906.pdf
+ * Intersil / Zilker Labs ZL9101M
+ Prefix: 'zl9101'
+ Addresses scanned: -
+ Datasheet: http://www.intersil.com/data/fn/fn7669.pdf
+ * Intersil / Zilker Labs ZL9117M
+ Prefix: 'zl9117'
+ Addresses scanned: -
+ Datasheet: http://www.intersil.com/data/fn/fn7914.pdf
* Ericsson BMR450, BMR451
Prefix: 'bmr450', 'bmr451'
Addresses scanned: -
@@ -88,14 +96,12 @@ Module parameters
delay
-----
-Some Intersil/Zilker Labs DC-DC controllers require a minimum interval between
-I2C bus accesses. According to Intersil, the minimum interval is 2 ms, though
-1 ms appears to be sufficient and has not caused any problems in testing.
-The problem is known to affect ZL6100, ZL2105, and ZL2008. It is known not to
-affect ZL2004 and ZL6105. The driver automatically sets the interval to 1 ms
-except for ZL2004 and ZL6105. To enable manual override, the driver provides a
-writeable module parameter, 'delay', which can be used to set the interval to
-a value between 0 and 65,535 microseconds.
+Intersil/Zilker Labs DC-DC controllers require a minimum interval between I2C
+bus accesses. According to Intersil, the minimum interval is 2 ms, though 1 ms
+appears to be sufficient and has not caused any problems in testing. The problem
+is known to affect all currently supported chips. For manual override, the
+driver provides a writeable module parameter, 'delay', which can be used to set
+the interval to a value between 0 and 65,535 microseconds.
Sysfs entries
@@ -108,7 +114,7 @@ in1_label "vin"
in1_input Measured input voltage.
in1_min Minimum input voltage.
in1_max Maximum input voltage.
-in1_lcrit Critical minumum input voltage.
+in1_lcrit Critical minimum input voltage.
in1_crit Critical maximum input voltage.
in1_min_alarm Input voltage low alarm.
in1_max_alarm Input voltage high alarm.
@@ -117,7 +123,7 @@ in1_crit_alarm Input voltage critical high alarm.
in2_label "vout1"
in2_input Measured output voltage.
-in2_lcrit Critical minumum output Voltage.
+in2_lcrit Critical minimum output Voltage.
in2_crit Critical maximum output voltage.
in2_lcrit_alarm Critical output voltage critical low alarm.
in2_crit_alarm Critical output voltage critical high alarm.
diff --git a/Documentation/i2c/instantiating-devices b/Documentation/i2c/instantiating-devices
index 9edb75d8c9b..abf63615ee0 100644
--- a/Documentation/i2c/instantiating-devices
+++ b/Documentation/i2c/instantiating-devices
@@ -87,11 +87,11 @@ it may have different addresses from one board to the next (manufacturer
changing its design without notice). In this case, you can call
i2c_new_probed_device() instead of i2c_new_device().
-Example (from the pnx4008 OHCI driver):
+Example (from the nxp OHCI driver):
static const unsigned short normal_i2c[] = { 0x2c, 0x2d, I2C_CLIENT_END };
-static int __devinit usb_hcd_pnx4008_probe(struct platform_device *pdev)
+static int __devinit usb_hcd_nxp_probe(struct platform_device *pdev)
{
(...)
struct i2c_adapter *i2c_adap;
@@ -100,7 +100,7 @@ static int __devinit usb_hcd_pnx4008_probe(struct platform_device *pdev)
(...)
i2c_adap = i2c_get_adapter(2);
memset(&i2c_info, 0, sizeof(struct i2c_board_info));
- strlcpy(i2c_info.type, "isp1301_pnx", I2C_NAME_SIZE);
+ strlcpy(i2c_info.type, "isp1301_nxp", I2C_NAME_SIZE);
isp1301_i2c_client = i2c_new_probed_device(i2c_adap, &i2c_info,
normal_i2c, NULL);
i2c_put_adapter(i2c_adap);
diff --git a/Documentation/i2o/ioctl b/Documentation/i2o/ioctl
index 22ca53a67e2..27c3c549311 100644
--- a/Documentation/i2o/ioctl
+++ b/Documentation/i2o/ioctl
@@ -138,7 +138,7 @@ VI. Setting Parameters
The return value is the size in bytes of the data written into
ops->resbuf if no errors occur. If an error occurs, -1 is returned
- and errno is set appropriatly:
+ and errno is set appropriately:
EFAULT Invalid user space pointer was passed
ENXIO Invalid IOP number
@@ -222,7 +222,7 @@ VIII. Downloading Software
RETURNS
This function returns 0 no errors occur. If an error occurs, -1
- is returned and errno is set appropriatly:
+ is returned and errno is set appropriately:
EFAULT Invalid user space pointer was passed
ENXIO Invalid IOP number
@@ -264,7 +264,7 @@ IX. Uploading Software
RETURNS
This function returns 0 if no errors occur. If an error occurs, -1
- is returned and errno is set appropriatly:
+ is returned and errno is set appropriately:
EFAULT Invalid user space pointer was passed
ENXIO Invalid IOP number
@@ -301,7 +301,7 @@ X. Removing Software
RETURNS
This function returns 0 if no errors occur. If an error occurs, -1
- is returned and errno is set appropriatly:
+ is returned and errno is set appropriately:
EFAULT Invalid user space pointer was passed
ENXIO Invalid IOP number
@@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ X. Validating Configuration
RETURNS
This function returns 0 if no erro occur. If an error occurs, -1 is
- returned and errno is set appropriatly:
+ returned and errno is set appropriately:
ETIMEDOUT Timeout waiting for reply message
ENXIO Invalid IOP number
@@ -360,7 +360,7 @@ XI. Configuration Dialog
RETURNS
This function returns 0 if no error occur. If an error occurs, -1
- is returned and errno is set appropriatly:
+ is returned and errno is set appropriately:
EFAULT Invalid user space pointer was passed
ENXIO Invalid IOP number
diff --git a/Documentation/ide/ChangeLog.ide-cd.1994-2004 b/Documentation/ide/ChangeLog.ide-cd.1994-2004
index 190d17bfff6..4cc3ad99f39 100644
--- a/Documentation/ide/ChangeLog.ide-cd.1994-2004
+++ b/Documentation/ide/ChangeLog.ide-cd.1994-2004
@@ -175,7 +175,7 @@
* since the .pdf version doesn't seem to work...
* -- Updated the TODO list to something more current.
*
- * 4.15 Aug 25, 1998 -- Updated ide-cd.h to respect mechine endianess,
+ * 4.15 Aug 25, 1998 -- Updated ide-cd.h to respect machine endianness,
* patch thanks to "Eddie C. Dost" <ecd@skynet.be>
*
* 4.50 Oct 19, 1998 -- New maintainers!
diff --git a/Documentation/input/alps.txt b/Documentation/input/alps.txt
index f274c28b510..ae8ba9a74ce 100644
--- a/Documentation/input/alps.txt
+++ b/Documentation/input/alps.txt
@@ -13,7 +13,8 @@ Detection
All ALPS touchpads should respond to the "E6 report" command sequence:
E8-E6-E6-E6-E9. An ALPS touchpad should respond with either 00-00-0A or
-00-00-64.
+00-00-64 if no buttons are pressed. The bits 0-2 of the first byte will be 1s
+if some buttons are pressed.
If the E6 report is successful, the touchpad model is identified using the "E7
report" sequence: E8-E7-E7-E7-E9. The response is the model signature and is
@@ -131,8 +132,8 @@ number of contacts (f1 and f0 in the table below).
byte 5: 0 1 ? ? ? ? f1 f0
This packet only appears after a position packet with the mt bit set, and
-ususally only appears when there are two or more contacts (although
-ocassionally it's seen with only a single contact).
+usually only appears when there are two or more contacts (although
+occassionally it's seen with only a single contact).
The final v3 packet type is the trackstick packet.
diff --git a/Documentation/input/joystick.txt b/Documentation/input/joystick.txt
index 8007b7ca87b..304262bb661 100644
--- a/Documentation/input/joystick.txt
+++ b/Documentation/input/joystick.txt
@@ -330,7 +330,7 @@ the USB documentation for how to setup an USB mouse.
The TM DirectConnect (BSP) protocol is supported by the tmdc.c
module. This includes, but is not limited to:
-* ThrustMaster Millenium 3D Inceptor
+* ThrustMaster Millennium 3D Interceptor
* ThrustMaster 3D Rage Pad
* ThrustMaster Fusion Digital Game Pad
diff --git a/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt b/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt
index 91a6ecbae0b..18eb98c44ff 100644
--- a/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt
+++ b/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt
@@ -596,7 +596,7 @@ HDIO_DRIVE_TASKFILE execute raw taskfile
if CHS/LBA28
The association between in_flags.all and each enable
- bitfield flips depending on endianess; fortunately, TASKFILE
+ bitfield flips depending on endianness; fortunately, TASKFILE
only uses inflags.b.data bit and ignores all other bits.
The end result is that, on any endian machines, it has no
effect other than modifying in_flags on completion.
@@ -720,7 +720,7 @@ HDIO_DRIVE_TASKFILE execute raw taskfile
[6] Do not access {in|out}_flags->all except for resetting
all the bits. Always access individual bit fields. ->all
- value will flip depending on endianess. For the same
+ value will flip depending on endianness. For the same
reason, do not use IDE_{TASKFILE|HOB}_STD_{OUT|IN}_FLAGS
constants defined in hdreg.h.
diff --git a/Documentation/ioctl/ioctl-number.txt b/Documentation/ioctl/ioctl-number.txt
index 4840334ea97..3b7488fc337 100644
--- a/Documentation/ioctl/ioctl-number.txt
+++ b/Documentation/ioctl/ioctl-number.txt
@@ -189,7 +189,7 @@ Code Seq#(hex) Include File Comments
'Y' all linux/cyclades.h
'Z' 14-15 drivers/message/fusion/mptctl.h
'[' 00-07 linux/usb/tmc.h USB Test and Measurement Devices
- <mailto:gregkh@suse.de>
+ <mailto:gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
'a' all linux/atm*.h, linux/sonet.h ATM on linux
<http://lrcwww.epfl.ch/>
'b' 00-FF conflict! bit3 vme host bridge
@@ -218,6 +218,7 @@ Code Seq#(hex) Include File Comments
'h' 00-7F conflict! Charon filesystem
<mailto:zapman@interlan.net>
'h' 00-1F linux/hpet.h conflict!
+'h' 80-8F fs/hfsplus/ioctl.c
'i' 00-3F linux/i2o-dev.h conflict!
'i' 0B-1F linux/ipmi.h conflict!
'i' 80-8F linux/i8k.h
@@ -255,7 +256,7 @@ Code Seq#(hex) Include File Comments
linux/ixjuser.h <http://web.archive.org/web/*/http://www.quicknet.net>
'r' 00-1F linux/msdos_fs.h and fs/fat/dir.c
's' all linux/cdk.h
-'t' 00-7F linux/if_ppp.h
+'t' 00-7F linux/ppp-ioctl.h
't' 80-8F linux/isdn_ppp.h
't' 90 linux/toshiba.h
'u' 00-1F linux/smb_fs.h gone
diff --git a/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt b/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt
index 44e2649fbb2..a686f9cd69c 100644
--- a/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt
+++ b/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt
@@ -117,7 +117,7 @@ applicable everywhere (see syntax).
This attribute is only applicable to menu blocks, if the condition is
false, the menu block is not displayed to the user (the symbols
contained there can still be selected by other symbols, though). It is
- similar to a conditional "prompt" attribude for individual menu
+ similar to a conditional "prompt" attribute for individual menu
entries. Default value of "visible" is true.
- numerical ranges: "range" <symbol> <symbol> ["if" <expr>]
diff --git a/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt b/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt
index 033d4e69b43..58eac231fe6 100644
--- a/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt
+++ b/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt
@@ -713,6 +713,21 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
The filter can be disabled or changed to another
driver later using sysfs.
+ drm_kms_helper.edid_firmware=[<connector>:]<file>
+ Broken monitors, graphic adapters and KVMs may
+ send no or incorrect EDID data sets. This parameter
+ allows to specify an EDID data set in the
+ /lib/firmware directory that is used instead.
+ Generic built-in EDID data sets are used, if one of
+ edid/1024x768.bin, edid/1280x1024.bin,
+ edid/1680x1050.bin, or edid/1920x1080.bin is given
+ and no file with the same name exists. Details and
+ instructions how to build your own EDID data are
+ available in Documentation/EDID/HOWTO.txt. An EDID
+ data set will only be used for a particular connector,
+ if its name and a colon are prepended to the EDID
+ name.
+
dscc4.setup= [NET]
earlycon= [KNL] Output early console device and options.
@@ -950,7 +965,7 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
controller
i8042.nopnp [HW] Don't use ACPIPnP / PnPBIOS to discover KBD/AUX
controllers
- i8042.notimeout [HW] Ignore timeout condition signalled by conroller
+ i8042.notimeout [HW] Ignore timeout condition signalled by controller
i8042.reset [HW] Reset the controller during init and cleanup
i8042.unlock [HW] Unlock (ignore) the keylock
@@ -1071,8 +1086,6 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
no_x2apic_optout
BIOS x2APIC opt-out request will be ignored
- inttest= [IA-64]
-
iomem= Disable strict checking of access to MMIO memory
strict regions from userspace.
relaxed
@@ -1657,6 +1670,14 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
of returning the full 64-bit number.
The default is to return 64-bit inode numbers.
+ nfs.max_session_slots=
+ [NFSv4.1] Sets the maximum number of session slots
+ the client will attempt to negotiate with the server.
+ This limits the number of simultaneous RPC requests
+ that the client can send to the NFSv4.1 server.
+ Note that there is little point in setting this
+ value higher than the max_tcp_slot_table_limit.
+
nfs.nfs4_disable_idmapping=
[NFSv4] When set to the default of '1', this option
ensures that both the RPC level authentication
@@ -1670,6 +1691,21 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
back to using the idmapper.
To turn off this behaviour, set the value to '0'.
+ nfs.send_implementation_id =
+ [NFSv4.1] Send client implementation identification
+ information in exchange_id requests.
+ If zero, no implementation identification information
+ will be sent.
+ The default is to send the implementation identification
+ information.
+
+
+ objlayoutdriver.osd_login_prog=
+ [NFS] [OBJLAYOUT] sets the pathname to the program which
+ is used to automatically discover and login into new
+ osd-targets. Please see:
+ Documentation/filesystems/pnfs.txt for more explanations
+
nmi_debug= [KNL,AVR32,SH] Specify one or more actions to take
when a NMI is triggered.
Format: [state][,regs][,debounce][,die]
@@ -2109,8 +2145,14 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
the default.
off: Turn ECRC off
on: Turn ECRC on.
- realloc reallocate PCI resources if allocations done by BIOS
- are erroneous.
+ realloc= Enable/disable reallocating PCI bridge resources
+ if allocations done by BIOS are too small to
+ accommodate resources required by all child
+ devices.
+ off: Turn realloc off
+ on: Turn realloc on
+ realloc same as realloc=on
+ noari do not use PCIe ARI.
pcie_aspm= [PCIE] Forcibly enable or disable PCIe Active State Power
Management.
@@ -2118,6 +2160,10 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
force Enable ASPM even on devices that claim not to support it.
WARNING: Forcing ASPM on may cause system lockups.
+ pcie_hp= [PCIE] PCI Express Hotplug driver options:
+ nomsi Do not use MSI for PCI Express Native Hotplug (this
+ makes all PCIe ports use INTx for hotplug services).
+
pcie_ports= [PCIE] PCIe ports handling:
auto Ask the BIOS whether or not to use native PCIe services
associated with PCIe ports (PME, hot-plug, AER). Use
@@ -2211,6 +2257,12 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
default: off.
+ printk.always_kmsg_dump=
+ Trigger kmsg_dump for cases other than kernel oops or
+ panics
+ Format: <bool> (1/Y/y=enable, 0/N/n=disable)
+ default: disabled
+
printk.time= Show timing data prefixed to each printk message line
Format: <bool> (1/Y/y=enable, 0/N/n=disable)
@@ -2434,7 +2486,7 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
For more information see Documentation/vm/slub.txt.
slub_min_order= [MM, SLUB]
- Determines the mininum page order for slabs. Must be
+ Determines the minimum page order for slabs. Must be
lower than slub_max_order.
For more information see Documentation/vm/slub.txt.
@@ -2600,7 +2652,7 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
threadirqs [KNL]
Force threading of all interrupt handlers except those
- marked explicitely IRQF_NO_THREAD.
+ marked explicitly IRQF_NO_THREAD.
topology= [S390]
Format: {off | on}
@@ -2629,6 +2681,13 @@ bytes respectively. Such letter suffixes can also be entirely omitted.
to facilitate early boot debugging.
See also Documentation/trace/events.txt
+ transparent_hugepage=
+ [KNL]
+ Format: [always|madvise|never]
+ Can be used to control the default behavior of the system
+ with respect to transparent hugepages.
+ See Documentation/vm/transhuge.txt for more details.
+
tsc= Disable clocksource stability checks for TSC.
Format: <string>
[x86] reliable: mark tsc clocksource as reliable, this
diff --git a/Documentation/ko_KR/HOWTO b/Documentation/ko_KR/HOWTO
index ab5189ae342..2f48f205fed 100644
--- a/Documentation/ko_KR/HOWTO
+++ b/Documentation/ko_KR/HOWTO
@@ -354,7 +354,7 @@ Andrew Morton에 의해 배포된 실험적인 커널 패치들이다. Andrew는
git.kernel.org:/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/jejb/scsi-misc-2.6.git
quilt trees:
- - USB, PCI, Driver Core, and I2C, Greg Kroah-Hartman < gregkh@suse.de>
+ - USB, PCI, Driver Core, and I2C, Greg Kroah-Hartman < gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
kernel.org/pub/linux/kernel/people/gregkh/gregkh-2.6/
- x86-64, partly i386, Andi Kleen < ak@suse.de>
ftp.firstfloor.org:/pub/ak/x86_64/quilt/
diff --git a/Documentation/kobject.txt b/Documentation/kobject.txt
index 3ab2472509c..49578cf1aea 100644
--- a/Documentation/kobject.txt
+++ b/Documentation/kobject.txt
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
Everything you never wanted to know about kobjects, ksets, and ktypes
-Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
Based on an original article by Jon Corbet for lwn.net written October 1,
2003 and located at http://lwn.net/Articles/51437/
diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt
index c4d8d151e0f..0e542ab3d4a 100644
--- a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt
+++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt
@@ -43,17 +43,23 @@ Format: 10x mA i.e 10 means 1.0 mA
example platform data:
Note: chan_nr can have values between 0 and 2.
+The name of each channel can be configurable.
+If the name field is not defined, the default name will be set to 'xxxx:channelN'
+(XXXX : pdata->label or i2c client name, N : channel number)
static struct lp5521_led_config lp5521_led_config[] = {
{
+ .name = "red",
.chan_nr = 0,
.led_current = 50,
.max_current = 130,
}, {
+ .name = "green",
.chan_nr = 1,
.led_current = 0,
.max_current = 130,
}, {
+ .name = "blue",
.chan_nr = 2,
.led_current = 0,
.max_current = 130,
@@ -86,3 +92,60 @@ static struct lp5521_platform_data lp5521_platform_data = {
If the current is set to 0 in the platform data, that channel is
disabled and it is not visible in the sysfs.
+
+The 'update_config' : CONFIG register (ADDR 08h)
+This value is platform-specific data.
+If update_config is not defined, the CONFIG register is set with
+'LP5521_PWRSAVE_EN | LP5521_CP_MODE_AUTO | LP5521_R_TO_BATT'.
+(Enable auto-powersave, set charge pump to auto, red to battery)
+
+example of update_config :
+
+#define LP5521_CONFIGS (LP5521_PWM_HF | LP5521_PWRSAVE_EN | \
+ LP5521_CP_MODE_AUTO | LP5521_R_TO_BATT | \
+ LP5521_CLK_INT)
+
+static struct lp5521_platform_data lp5521_pdata = {
+ .led_config = lp5521_led_config,
+ .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5521_led_config),
+ .clock_mode = LP5521_CLOCK_INT,
+ .update_config = LP5521_CONFIGS,
+};
+
+LED patterns : LP5521 has autonomous operation without external control.
+Pattern data can be defined in the platform data.
+
+example of led pattern data :
+
+/* RGB(50,5,0) 500ms on, 500ms off, infinite loop */
+static u8 pattern_red[] = {
+ 0x40, 0x32, 0x60, 0x00, 0x40, 0x00, 0x60, 0x00,
+ };
+
+static u8 pattern_green[] = {
+ 0x40, 0x05, 0x60, 0x00, 0x40, 0x00, 0x60, 0x00,
+ };
+
+static struct lp5521_led_pattern board_led_patterns[] = {
+ {
+ .r = pattern_red,
+ .g = pattern_green,
+ .size_r = ARRAY_SIZE(pattern_red),
+ .size_g = ARRAY_SIZE(pattern_green),
+ },
+};
+
+static struct lp5521_platform_data lp5521_platform_data = {
+ .led_config = lp5521_led_config,
+ .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5521_led_config),
+ .clock_mode = LP5521_CLOCK_EXT,
+ .patterns = board_led_patterns,
+ .num_patterns = ARRAY_SIZE(board_led_patterns),
+};
+
+Then predefined led pattern(s) can be executed via the sysfs.
+To start the pattern #1,
+# echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern
+(xxxx : i2c bus & slave address)
+To end the pattern,
+# echo 0 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern
diff --git a/Documentation/lockup-watchdogs.txt b/Documentation/lockup-watchdogs.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..d2a36602ca8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/lockup-watchdogs.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+===============================================================
+Softlockup detector and hardlockup detector (aka nmi_watchdog)
+===============================================================
+
+The Linux kernel can act as a watchdog to detect both soft and hard
+lockups.
+
+A 'softlockup' is defined as a bug that causes the kernel to loop in
+kernel mode for more than 20 seconds (see "Implementation" below for
+details), without giving other tasks a chance to run. The current
+stack trace is displayed upon detection and, by default, the system
+will stay locked up. Alternatively, the kernel can be configured to
+panic; a sysctl, "kernel.softlockup_panic", a kernel parameter,
+"softlockup_panic" (see "Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt" for
+details), and a compile option, "BOOTPARAM_HARDLOCKUP_PANIC", are
+provided for this.
+
+A 'hardlockup' is defined as a bug that causes the CPU to loop in
+kernel mode for more than 10 seconds (see "Implementation" below for
+details), without letting other interrupts have a chance to run.
+Similarly to the softlockup case, the current stack trace is displayed
+upon detection and the system will stay locked up unless the default
+behavior is changed, which can be done through a compile time knob,
+"BOOTPARAM_HARDLOCKUP_PANIC", and a kernel parameter, "nmi_watchdog"
+(see "Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt" for details).
+
+The panic option can be used in combination with panic_timeout (this
+timeout is set through the confusingly named "kernel.panic" sysctl),
+to cause the system to reboot automatically after a specified amount
+of time.
+
+=== Implementation ===
+
+The soft and hard lockup detectors are built on top of the hrtimer and
+perf subsystems, respectively. A direct consequence of this is that,
+in principle, they should work in any architecture where these
+subsystems are present.
+
+A periodic hrtimer runs to generate interrupts and kick the watchdog
+task. An NMI perf event is generated every "watchdog_thresh"
+(compile-time initialized to 10 and configurable through sysctl of the
+same name) seconds to check for hardlockups. If any CPU in the system
+does not receive any hrtimer interrupt during that time the
+'hardlockup detector' (the handler for the NMI perf event) will
+generate a kernel warning or call panic, depending on the
+configuration.
+
+The watchdog task is a high priority kernel thread that updates a
+timestamp every time it is scheduled. If that timestamp is not updated
+for 2*watchdog_thresh seconds (the softlockup threshold) the
+'softlockup detector' (coded inside the hrtimer callback function)
+will dump useful debug information to the system log, after which it
+will call panic if it was instructed to do so or resume execution of
+other kernel code.
+
+The period of the hrtimer is 2*watchdog_thresh/5, which means it has
+two or three chances to generate an interrupt before the hardlockup
+detector kicks in.
+
+As explained above, a kernel knob is provided that allows
+administrators to configure the period of the hrtimer and the perf
+event. The right value for a particular environment is a trade-off
+between fast response to lockups and detection overhead.
diff --git a/Documentation/magic-number.txt b/Documentation/magic-number.txt
index abf481f780e..82761a31d64 100644
--- a/Documentation/magic-number.txt
+++ b/Documentation/magic-number.txt
@@ -89,7 +89,7 @@ TTY_DRIVER_MAGIC 0x5402 tty_driver include/linux/tty_driver.h
MGSLPC_MAGIC 0x5402 mgslpc_info drivers/char/pcmcia/synclink_cs.c
TTY_LDISC_MAGIC 0x5403 tty_ldisc include/linux/tty_ldisc.h
USB_SERIAL_MAGIC 0x6702 usb_serial drivers/usb/serial/usb-serial.h
-FULL_DUPLEX_MAGIC 0x6969 drivers/net/tulip/de2104x.c
+FULL_DUPLEX_MAGIC 0x6969 drivers/net/ethernet/dec/tulip/de2104x.c
USB_BLUETOOTH_MAGIC 0x6d02 usb_bluetooth drivers/usb/class/bluetty.c
RFCOMM_TTY_MAGIC 0x6d02 net/bluetooth/rfcomm/tty.c
USB_SERIAL_PORT_MAGIC 0x7301 usb_serial_port drivers/usb/serial/usb-serial.h
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/LICENSE.qlge b/Documentation/networking/LICENSE.qlge
index 123b6edd7f1..ce64e4d15b2 100644
--- a/Documentation/networking/LICENSE.qlge
+++ b/Documentation/networking/LICENSE.qlge
@@ -1,46 +1,288 @@
-Copyright (c) 2003-2008 QLogic Corporation
-QLogic Linux Networking HBA Driver
+Copyright (c) 2003-2011 QLogic Corporation
+QLogic Linux qlge NIC Driver
-This program includes a device driver for Linux 2.6 that may be
-distributed with QLogic hardware specific firmware binary file.
You may modify and redistribute the device driver code under the
-GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
-Foundation (version 2 or a later version).
-
-You may redistribute the hardware specific firmware binary file
-under the following terms:
-
- 1. Redistribution of source code (only if applicable),
- must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
- conditions and the following disclaimer.
-
- 2. Redistribution in binary form must reproduce the above
- copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
- following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
- materials provided with the distribution.
-
- 3. The name of QLogic Corporation may not be used to
- endorse or promote products derived from this software
- without specific prior written permission
-
-REGARDLESS OF WHAT LICENSING MECHANISM IS USED OR APPLICABLE,
-THIS PROGRAM IS PROVIDED BY QLOGIC CORPORATION "AS IS'' AND ANY
-EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
-IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
-PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR
-BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
-EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
-TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
-DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
-ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
-OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
-OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
-POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
-
-USER ACKNOWLEDGES AND AGREES THAT USE OF THIS PROGRAM WILL NOT
-CREATE OR GIVE GROUNDS FOR A LICENSE BY IMPLICATION, ESTOPPEL, OR
-OTHERWISE IN ANY INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS (PATENT, COPYRIGHT,
-TRADE SECRET, MASK WORK, OR OTHER PROPRIETARY RIGHT) EMBODIED IN
-ANY OTHER QLOGIC HARDWARE OR SOFTWARE EITHER SOLELY OR IN
-COMBINATION WITH THIS PROGRAM.
+GNU General Public License (a copy of which is attached hereto as
+Exhibit A) published by the Free Software Foundation (version 2).
+
+EXHIBIT A
+
+ GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+ Version 2, June 1991
+
+ Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+ of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+
+ Preamble
+
+ The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
+freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
+License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
+software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
+General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
+Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
+using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
+the GNU Lesser General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
+your programs, too.
+
+ When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
+price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
+have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
+this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
+if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
+in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
+
+ To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
+anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
+These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
+distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
+
+ For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
+gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
+you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
+source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
+rights.
+
+ We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
+(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
+distribute and/or modify the software.
+
+ Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
+that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
+software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
+want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
+that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
+authors' reputations.
+
+ Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
+patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
+program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
+program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
+patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
+
+ The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
+modification follow.
+
+ GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+ TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
+
+ 0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains
+a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
+under the terms of this General Public License. The "Program", below,
+refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program"
+means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
+that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
+either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
+language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
+the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you".
+
+Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
+covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
+running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
+is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
+Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
+Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
+
+ 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
+source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
+conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
+copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
+notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
+and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
+along with the Program.
+
+You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
+you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
+
+ 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
+of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
+distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
+above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
+
+ a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
+ stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
+
+ b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
+ whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
+ part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
+ parties under the terms of this License.
+
+ c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
+ when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
+ interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
+ announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
+ notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
+ a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
+ these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
+ License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
+ does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
+ the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
+
+These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
+identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
+and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
+themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
+sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
+distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
+on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
+this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
+entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
+
+Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
+your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
+exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
+collective works based on the Program.
+
+In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
+with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
+a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
+the scope of this License.
+
+ 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
+under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
+Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
+
+ a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
+ source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
+ 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+ b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
+ years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
+ cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
+ machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
+ distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
+ customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+ c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
+ to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
+ allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
+ received the program in object code or executable form with such
+ an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
+
+The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
+making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
+code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
+associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
+control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
+special exception, the source code distributed need not include
+anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
+form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
+operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
+itself accompanies the executable.
+
+If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
+access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
+access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
+distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
+compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
+
+ 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
+except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
+otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
+void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
+However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
+this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
+parties remain in full compliance.
+
+ 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
+signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
+distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
+prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
+modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
+all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
+the Program or works based on it.
+
+ 6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
+original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
+these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
+restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
+You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
+this License.
+
+ 7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
+infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
+conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
+otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
+excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
+distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
+License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
+may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
+license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
+all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
+the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
+refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
+
+If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
+any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
+apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
+circumstances.
+
+It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
+patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
+such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
+integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
+implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
+generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
+through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
+system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
+to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
+impose that choice.
+
+This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
+be a consequence of the rest of this License.
+
+ 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
+certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
+original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
+may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
+those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
+countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
+the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
+
+ 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
+of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
+be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
+address new problems or concerns.
+
+Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
+specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any
+later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions
+either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
+Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
+this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
+Foundation.
+
+ 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
+programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
+to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
+Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
+make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
+of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
+of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
+
+ NO WARRANTY
+
+ 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
+FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
+OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
+PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
+OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
+MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
+TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
+PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
+REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
+
+ 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
+WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
+REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
+INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
+OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
+TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
+YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
+PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/dns_resolver.txt b/Documentation/networking/dns_resolver.txt
index 7f531ad8328..d86adcdae42 100644
--- a/Documentation/networking/dns_resolver.txt
+++ b/Documentation/networking/dns_resolver.txt
@@ -102,6 +102,10 @@ implemented in the module can be called after doing:
If _expiry is non-NULL, the expiry time (TTL) of the result will be
returned also.
+The kernel maintains an internal keyring in which it caches looked up keys.
+This can be cleared by any process that has the CAP_SYS_ADMIN capability by
+the use of KEYCTL_KEYRING_CLEAR on the keyring ID.
+
===============================
READING DNS KEYS FROM USERSPACE
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/fore200e.txt b/Documentation/networking/fore200e.txt
index 6e0d2a9613e..f648eb26518 100644
--- a/Documentation/networking/fore200e.txt
+++ b/Documentation/networking/fore200e.txt
@@ -44,7 +44,7 @@ the 'software updates' pages. The firmware binaries are part of
the various ForeThought software distributions.
Notice that different versions of the PCA-200E firmware exist, depending
-on the endianess of the host architecture. The driver is shipped with
+on the endianness of the host architecture. The driver is shipped with
both little and big endian PCA firmware images.
Name and location of the new firmware images can be set at kernel
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/l2tp.txt b/Documentation/networking/l2tp.txt
index e7bf3979fac..e63fc1f7bf8 100644
--- a/Documentation/networking/l2tp.txt
+++ b/Documentation/networking/l2tp.txt
@@ -111,7 +111,7 @@ When creating PPPoL2TP sockets, the application provides information
to the driver about the socket in a socket connect() call. Source and
destination tunnel and session ids are provided, as well as the file
descriptor of a UDP socket. See struct pppol2tp_addr in
-include/linux/if_ppp.h. Note that zero tunnel / session ids are
+include/linux/if_pppol2tp.h. Note that zero tunnel / session ids are
treated specially. When creating the per-tunnel PPPoL2TP management
socket in Step 2 above, zero source and destination session ids are
specified, which tells the driver to prepare the supplied UDP file
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/mac80211-auth-assoc-deauth.txt b/Documentation/networking/mac80211-auth-assoc-deauth.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..e0a2aa585ca
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/networking/mac80211-auth-assoc-deauth.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
+#
+# This outlines the Linux authentication/association and
+# deauthentication/disassociation flows.
+#
+# This can be converted into a diagram using the service
+# at http://www.websequencediagrams.com/
+#
+
+participant userspace
+participant mac80211
+participant driver
+
+alt authentication needed (not FT)
+userspace->mac80211: authenticate
+
+alt authenticated/authenticating already
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, not-exists)
+mac80211->driver: bss_info_changed(clear BSSID)
+else associated
+note over mac80211,driver
+like deauth/disassoc, without sending the
+BA session stop & deauth/disassoc frames
+end note
+end
+
+mac80211->driver: config(channel, non-HT)
+mac80211->driver: bss_info_changed(set BSSID, basic rate bitmap)
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, exists)
+
+alt no probe request data known
+mac80211->driver: TX directed probe request
+driver->mac80211: RX probe response
+end
+
+mac80211->driver: TX auth frame
+driver->mac80211: RX auth frame
+
+alt WEP shared key auth
+mac80211->driver: TX auth frame
+driver->mac80211: RX auth frame
+end
+
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, authenticated)
+mac80211->userspace: RX auth frame
+
+end
+
+userspace->mac80211: associate
+alt authenticated or associated
+note over mac80211,driver: cleanup like for authenticate
+end
+
+alt not previously authenticated (FT)
+mac80211->driver: config(channel, non-HT)
+mac80211->driver: bss_info_changed(set BSSID, basic rate bitmap)
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, exists)
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, authenticated)
+end
+mac80211->driver: TX assoc
+driver->mac80211: RX assoc response
+note over mac80211: init rate control
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, associated)
+
+alt not using WPA
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, authorized)
+end
+
+mac80211->driver: set up QoS parameters
+
+alt is HT channel
+mac80211->driver: config(channel, HT params)
+end
+
+mac80211->driver: bss_info_changed(QoS, HT, associated with AID)
+mac80211->userspace: associated
+
+note left of userspace: associated now
+
+alt using WPA
+note over userspace
+do 4-way-handshake
+(data frames)
+end note
+userspace->mac80211: authorized
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP, authorized)
+end
+
+userspace->mac80211: deauthenticate/disassociate
+mac80211->driver: stop BA sessions
+mac80211->driver: TX deauth/disassoc
+mac80211->driver: flush frames
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP,associated)
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP,authenticated)
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP,exists)
+mac80211->driver: sta_state(AP,not-exists)
+mac80211->driver: turn off powersave
+mac80211->driver: bss_info_changed(clear BSSID, not associated, no QoS, ...)
+mac80211->driver: config(non-HT channel type)
+mac80211->userspace: disconnected
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/netdev-features.txt b/Documentation/networking/netdev-features.txt
index 4b1c0dcef84..4164f5c02e4 100644
--- a/Documentation/networking/netdev-features.txt
+++ b/Documentation/networking/netdev-features.txt
@@ -152,3 +152,16 @@ NETIF_F_VLAN_CHALLENGED should be set for devices which can't cope with VLAN
headers. Some drivers set this because the cards can't handle the bigger MTU.
[FIXME: Those cases could be fixed in VLAN code by allowing only reduced-MTU
VLANs. This may be not useful, though.]
+
+* rx-fcs
+
+This requests that the NIC append the Ethernet Frame Checksum (FCS)
+to the end of the skb data. This allows sniffers and other tools to
+read the CRC recorded by the NIC on receipt of the packet.
+
+* rx-all
+
+This requests that the NIC receive all possible frames, including errored
+frames (such as bad FCS, etc). This can be helpful when sniffing a link with
+bad packets on it. Some NICs may receive more packets if also put into normal
+PROMISC mdoe.
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/phy.txt b/Documentation/networking/phy.txt
index 9eb1ba52013..95e5f5985a2 100644
--- a/Documentation/networking/phy.txt
+++ b/Documentation/networking/phy.txt
@@ -62,7 +62,8 @@ The MDIO bus
5) The bus must also be declared somewhere as a device, and registered.
As an example for how one driver implemented an mdio bus driver, see
- drivers/net/gianfar_mii.c and arch/ppc/syslib/mpc85xx_devices.c
+ drivers/net/ethernet/freescale/fsl_pq_mdio.c and an associated DTS file
+ for one of the users. (e.g. "git grep fsl,.*-mdio arch/powerpc/boot/dts/")
Connecting to a PHY
diff --git a/Documentation/networking/ppp_generic.txt b/Documentation/networking/ppp_generic.txt
index 15b5172fbb9..091d20273dc 100644
--- a/Documentation/networking/ppp_generic.txt
+++ b/Documentation/networking/ppp_generic.txt
@@ -342,7 +342,7 @@ an interface unit are:
numbers on received multilink fragments
SC_MP_XSHORTSEQ transmit short multilink sequence nos.
- The values of these flags are defined in <linux/if_ppp.h>. Note
+ The values of these flags are defined in <linux/ppp-ioctl.h>. Note
that the values of the SC_MULTILINK, SC_MP_SHORTSEQ and
SC_MP_XSHORTSEQ bits are ignored if the CONFIG_PPP_MULTILINK option
is not selected.
@@ -358,7 +358,7 @@ an interface unit are:
* PPPIOCSCOMPRESS sets the parameters for packet compression or
decompression. The argument should point to a ppp_option_data
- structure (defined in <linux/if_ppp.h>), which contains a
+ structure (defined in <linux/ppp-ioctl.h>), which contains a
pointer/length pair which should describe a block of memory
containing a CCP option specifying a compression method and its
parameters. The ppp_option_data struct also contains a `transmit'
@@ -395,7 +395,7 @@ an interface unit are:
* PPPIOCSNPMODE sets the network-protocol mode for a given network
protocol. The argument should point to an npioctl struct (defined
- in <linux/if_ppp.h>). The `protocol' field gives the PPP protocol
+ in <linux/ppp-ioctl.h>). The `protocol' field gives the PPP protocol
number for the protocol to be affected, and the `mode' field
specifies what to do with packets for that protocol:
diff --git a/Documentation/nmi_watchdog.txt b/Documentation/nmi_watchdog.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index bf9f80a9828..00000000000
--- a/Documentation/nmi_watchdog.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,83 +0,0 @@
-
-[NMI watchdog is available for x86 and x86-64 architectures]
-
-Is your system locking up unpredictably? No keyboard activity, just
-a frustrating complete hard lockup? Do you want to help us debugging
-such lockups? If all yes then this document is definitely for you.
-
-On many x86/x86-64 type hardware there is a feature that enables
-us to generate 'watchdog NMI interrupts'. (NMI: Non Maskable Interrupt
-which get executed even if the system is otherwise locked up hard).
-This can be used to debug hard kernel lockups. By executing periodic
-NMI interrupts, the kernel can monitor whether any CPU has locked up,
-and print out debugging messages if so.
-
-In order to use the NMI watchdog, you need to have APIC support in your
-kernel. For SMP kernels, APIC support gets compiled in automatically. For
-UP, enable either CONFIG_X86_UP_APIC (Processor type and features -> Local
-APIC support on uniprocessors) or CONFIG_X86_UP_IOAPIC (Processor type and
-features -> IO-APIC support on uniprocessors) in your kernel config.
-CONFIG_X86_UP_APIC is for uniprocessor machines without an IO-APIC.
-CONFIG_X86_UP_IOAPIC is for uniprocessor with an IO-APIC. [Note: certain
-kernel debugging options, such as Kernel Stack Meter or Kernel Tracer,
-may implicitly disable the NMI watchdog.]
-
-For x86-64, the needed APIC is always compiled in.
-
-Using local APIC (nmi_watchdog=2) needs the first performance register, so
-you can't use it for other purposes (such as high precision performance
-profiling.) However, at least oprofile and the perfctr driver disable the
-local APIC NMI watchdog automatically.
-
-To actually enable the NMI watchdog, use the 'nmi_watchdog=N' boot
-parameter. Eg. the relevant lilo.conf entry:
-
- append="nmi_watchdog=1"
-
-For SMP machines and UP machines with an IO-APIC use nmi_watchdog=1.
-For UP machines without an IO-APIC use nmi_watchdog=2, this only works
-for some processor types. If in doubt, boot with nmi_watchdog=1 and
-check the NMI count in /proc/interrupts; if the count is zero then
-reboot with nmi_watchdog=2 and check the NMI count. If it is still
-zero then log a problem, you probably have a processor that needs to be
-added to the nmi code.
-
-A 'lockup' is the following scenario: if any CPU in the system does not
-execute the period local timer interrupt for more than 5 seconds, then
-the NMI handler generates an oops and kills the process. This
-'controlled crash' (and the resulting kernel messages) can be used to
-debug the lockup. Thus whenever the lockup happens, wait 5 seconds and
-the oops will show up automatically. If the kernel produces no messages
-then the system has crashed so hard (eg. hardware-wise) that either it
-cannot even accept NMI interrupts, or the crash has made the kernel
-unable to print messages.
-
-Be aware that when using local APIC, the frequency of NMI interrupts
-it generates, depends on the system load. The local APIC NMI watchdog,
-lacking a better source, uses the "cycles unhalted" event. As you may
-guess it doesn't tick when the CPU is in the halted state (which happens
-when the system is idle), but if your system locks up on anything but the
-"hlt" processor instruction, the watchdog will trigger very soon as the
-"cycles unhalted" event will happen every clock tick. If it locks up on
-"hlt", then you are out of luck -- the event will not happen at all and the
-watchdog won't trigger. This is a shortcoming of the local APIC watchdog
--- unfortunately there is no "clock ticks" event that would work all the
-time. The I/O APIC watchdog is driven externally and has no such shortcoming.
-But its NMI frequency is much higher, resulting in a more significant hit
-to the overall system performance.
-
-On x86 nmi_watchdog is disabled by default so you have to enable it with
-a boot time parameter.
-
-It's possible to disable the NMI watchdog in run-time by writing "0" to
-/proc/sys/kernel/nmi_watchdog. Writing "1" to the same file will re-enable
-the NMI watchdog. Notice that you still need to use "nmi_watchdog=" parameter
-at boot time.
-
-NOTE: In kernels prior to 2.4.2-ac18 the NMI-oopser is enabled unconditionally
-on x86 SMP boxes.
-
-[ feel free to send bug reports, suggestions and patches to
- Ingo Molnar <mingo@redhat.com> or the Linux SMP mailing
- list at <linux-smp@vger.kernel.org> ]
-
diff --git a/Documentation/numastat.txt b/Documentation/numastat.txt
index 9fcc9a608dc..520327790d5 100644
--- a/Documentation/numastat.txt
+++ b/Documentation/numastat.txt
@@ -5,18 +5,23 @@ Numa policy hit/miss statistics
All units are pages. Hugepages have separate counters.
-numa_hit A process wanted to allocate memory from this node,
- and succeeded.
-numa_miss A process wanted to allocate memory from another node,
- but ended up with memory from this node.
-numa_foreign A process wanted to allocate on this node,
- but ended up with memory from another one.
-local_node A process ran on this node and got memory from it.
-other_node A process ran on this node and got memory from another node.
-interleave_hit Interleaving wanted to allocate from this node
- and succeeded.
+numa_hit A process wanted to allocate memory from this node,
+ and succeeded.
+
+numa_miss A process wanted to allocate memory from another node,
+ but ended up with memory from this node.
+
+numa_foreign A process wanted to allocate on this node,
+ but ended up with memory from another one.
+
+local_node A process ran on this node and got memory from it.
+
+other_node A process ran on this node and got memory from another node.
+
+interleave_hit Interleaving wanted to allocate from this node
+ and succeeded.
For easier reading you can use the numastat utility from the numactl package
-(ftp://ftp.suse.com/pub/people/ak/numa/numactl*). Note that it only works
+(http://oss.sgi.com/projects/libnuma/). Note that it only works
well right now on machines with a small number of CPUs.
diff --git a/Documentation/pinctrl.txt b/Documentation/pinctrl.txt
index 150fd3833d0..d97bccf4614 100644
--- a/Documentation/pinctrl.txt
+++ b/Documentation/pinctrl.txt
@@ -206,12 +206,21 @@ using a certain resistor value - pull up and pull down - so that the pin has a
stable value when nothing is driving the rail it is connected to, or when it's
unconnected.
-For example, a platform may do this:
+Pin configuration can be programmed either using the explicit APIs described
+immediately below, or by adding configuration entries into the mapping table;
+see section "Board/machine configuration" below.
+
+For example, a platform may do the following to pull up a pin to VDD:
+
+#include <linux/pinctrl/consumer.h>
ret = pin_config_set("foo-dev", "FOO_GPIO_PIN", PLATFORM_X_PULL_UP);
-To pull up a pin to VDD. The pin configuration driver implements callbacks for
-changing pin configuration in the pin controller ops like this:
+The format and meaning of the configuration parameter, PLATFORM_X_PULL_UP
+above, is entirely defined by the pin controller driver.
+
+The pin configuration driver implements callbacks for changing pin
+configuration in the pin controller ops like this:
#include <linux/pinctrl/pinctrl.h>
#include <linux/pinctrl/pinconf.h>
@@ -492,14 +501,10 @@ Definitions:
{"map-i2c0", i2c0, pinctrl0, fi2c0, gi2c0}
}
- Every map must be assigned a symbolic name, pin controller and function.
- The group is not compulsory - if it is omitted the first group presented by
- the driver as applicable for the function will be selected, which is
- useful for simple cases.
-
- The device name is present in map entries tied to specific devices. Maps
- without device names are referred to as SYSTEM pinmuxes, such as can be taken
- by the machine implementation on boot and not tied to any specific device.
+ Every map must be assigned a state name, pin controller, device and
+ function. The group is not compulsory - if it is omitted the first group
+ presented by the driver as applicable for the function will be selected,
+ which is useful for simple cases.
It is possible to map several groups to the same combination of device,
pin controller and function. This is for cases where a certain function on
@@ -726,19 +731,19 @@ same time.
All the above functions are mandatory to implement for a pinmux driver.
-Pinmux interaction with the GPIO subsystem
-==========================================
+Pin control interaction with the GPIO subsystem
+===============================================
-The public pinmux API contains two functions named pinmux_request_gpio()
-and pinmux_free_gpio(). These two functions shall *ONLY* be called from
+The public pinmux API contains two functions named pinctrl_request_gpio()
+and pinctrl_free_gpio(). These two functions shall *ONLY* be called from
gpiolib-based drivers as part of their gpio_request() and
-gpio_free() semantics. Likewise the pinmux_gpio_direction_[input|output]
+gpio_free() semantics. Likewise the pinctrl_gpio_direction_[input|output]
shall only be called from within respective gpio_direction_[input|output]
gpiolib implementation.
NOTE that platforms and individual drivers shall *NOT* request GPIO pins to be
-muxed in. Instead, implement a proper gpiolib driver and have that driver
-request proper muxing for its pins.
+controlled e.g. muxed in. Instead, implement a proper gpiolib driver and have
+that driver request proper muxing and other control for its pins.
The function list could become long, especially if you can convert every
individual pin into a GPIO pin independent of any other pins, and then try
@@ -747,7 +752,7 @@ the approach to define every pin as a function.
In this case, the function array would become 64 entries for each GPIO
setting and then the device functions.
-For this reason there are two functions a pinmux driver can implement
+For this reason there are two functions a pin control driver can implement
to enable only GPIO on an individual pin: .gpio_request_enable() and
.gpio_disable_free().
@@ -762,12 +767,12 @@ gpiolib driver and the affected GPIO range, pin offset and desired direction
will be passed along to this function.
Alternatively to using these special functions, it is fully allowed to use
-named functions for each GPIO pin, the pinmux_request_gpio() will attempt to
+named functions for each GPIO pin, the pinctrl_request_gpio() will attempt to
obtain the function "gpioN" where "N" is the global GPIO pin number if no
special GPIO-handler is registered.
-Pinmux board/machine configuration
+Board/machine configuration
==================================
Boards and machines define how a certain complete running system is put
@@ -775,27 +780,33 @@ together, including how GPIOs and devices are muxed, how regulators are
constrained and how the clock tree looks. Of course pinmux settings are also
part of this.
-A pinmux config for a machine looks pretty much like a simple regulator
-configuration, so for the example array above we want to enable i2c and
-spi on the second function mapping:
+A pin controller configuration for a machine looks pretty much like a simple
+regulator configuration, so for the example array above we want to enable i2c
+and spi on the second function mapping:
#include <linux/pinctrl/machine.h>
-static const struct pinmux_map __initdata pmx_mapping[] = {
+static const struct pinctrl_map __initdata mapping[] = {
{
- .ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
- .function = "spi0",
.dev_name = "foo-spi.0",
+ .name = PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT,
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
+ .ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
+ .data.mux.function = "spi0",
},
{
- .ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
- .function = "i2c0",
.dev_name = "foo-i2c.0",
+ .name = PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT,
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
+ .ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
+ .data.mux.function = "i2c0",
},
{
- .ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
- .function = "mmc0",
.dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
+ .name = PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT,
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
+ .ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
+ .data.mux.function = "mmc0",
},
};
@@ -805,21 +816,51 @@ must match a function provided by the pinmux driver handling this pin range.
As you can see we may have several pin controllers on the system and thus
we need to specify which one of them that contain the functions we wish
-to map. The map can also use struct device * directly, so there is no
-inherent need to use strings to specify .dev_name or .ctrl_dev_name, these
-are for the situation where you do not have a handle to the struct device *,
-for example if they are not yet instantiated or cumbersome to obtain.
+to map.
You register this pinmux mapping to the pinmux subsystem by simply:
- ret = pinmux_register_mappings(pmx_mapping, ARRAY_SIZE(pmx_mapping));
+ ret = pinctrl_register_mappings(mapping, ARRAY_SIZE(mapping));
Since the above construct is pretty common there is a helper macro to make
it even more compact which assumes you want to use pinctrl-foo and position
0 for mapping, for example:
-static struct pinmux_map __initdata pmx_mapping[] = {
- PINMUX_MAP("I2CMAP", "pinctrl-foo", "i2c0", "foo-i2c.0"),
+static struct pinctrl_map __initdata mapping[] = {
+ PIN_MAP_MUX_GROUP("foo-i2c.o", PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT, "pinctrl-foo", NULL, "i2c0"),
+};
+
+The mapping table may also contain pin configuration entries. It's common for
+each pin/group to have a number of configuration entries that affect it, so
+the table entries for configuration reference an array of config parameters
+and values. An example using the convenience macros is shown below:
+
+static unsigned long i2c_grp_configs[] = {
+ FOO_PIN_DRIVEN,
+ FOO_PIN_PULLUP,
+};
+
+static unsigned long i2c_pin_configs[] = {
+ FOO_OPEN_COLLECTOR,
+ FOO_SLEW_RATE_SLOW,
+};
+
+static struct pinctrl_map __initdata mapping[] = {
+ PIN_MAP_MUX_GROUP("foo-i2c.0", PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT, "pinctrl-foo", "i2c0", "i2c0"),
+ PIN_MAP_MUX_CONFIGS_GROUP("foo-i2c.0", PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT, "pinctrl-foo", "i2c0", i2c_grp_configs),
+ PIN_MAP_MUX_CONFIGS_PIN("foo-i2c.0", PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT, "pinctrl-foo", "i2c0scl", i2c_pin_configs),
+ PIN_MAP_MUX_CONFIGS_PIN("foo-i2c.0", PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT, "pinctrl-foo", "i2c0sda", i2c_pin_configs),
+};
+
+Finally, some devices expect the mapping table to contain certain specific
+named states. When running on hardware that doesn't need any pin controller
+configuration, the mapping table must still contain those named states, in
+order to explicitly indicate that the states were provided and intended to
+be empty. Table entry macro PIN_MAP_DUMMY_STATE serves the purpose of defining
+a named state without causing any pin controller to be programmed:
+
+static struct pinctrl_map __initdata mapping[] = {
+ PIN_MAP_DUMMY_STATE("foo-i2c.0", PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT),
};
@@ -831,81 +872,96 @@ As it is possible to map a function to different groups of pins an optional
...
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-spi.0",
.name = "spi0-pos-A",
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "spi0",
.group = "spi0_0_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-spi.0",
},
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-spi.0",
.name = "spi0-pos-B",
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "spi0",
.group = "spi0_1_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-spi.0",
},
...
This example mapping is used to switch between two positions for spi0 at
runtime, as described further below under the heading "Runtime pinmuxing".
-Further it is possible to match several groups of pins to the same function
-for a single device, say for example in the mmc0 example above, where you can
+Further it is possible for one named state to affect the muxing of several
+groups of pins, say for example in the mmc0 example above, where you can
additively expand the mmc0 bus from 2 to 4 to 8 pins. If we want to use all
three groups for a total of 2+2+4 = 8 pins (for an 8-bit MMC bus as is the
case), we define a mapping like this:
...
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
.name = "2bit"
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "mmc0",
.group = "mmc0_1_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
},
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
.name = "4bit"
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "mmc0",
.group = "mmc0_1_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
},
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
.name = "4bit"
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "mmc0",
.group = "mmc0_2_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
},
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
.name = "8bit"
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
+ .function = "mmc0",
.group = "mmc0_1_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
},
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
.name = "8bit"
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "mmc0",
.group = "mmc0_2_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
},
{
+ .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
.name = "8bit"
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "mmc0",
.group = "mmc0_3_grp",
- .dev_name = "foo-mmc.0",
},
...
The result of grabbing this mapping from the device with something like
this (see next paragraph):
- pmx = pinmux_get(&device, "8bit");
+ p = pinctrl_get(dev);
+ s = pinctrl_lookup_state(p, "8bit");
+ ret = pinctrl_select_state(p, s);
+
+or more simply:
+
+ p = pinctrl_get_select(dev, "8bit");
Will be that you activate all the three bottom records in the mapping at
-once. Since they share the same name, pin controller device, funcion and
+once. Since they share the same name, pin controller device, function and
device, and since we allow multiple groups to match to a single device, they
all get selected, and they all get enabled and disable simultaneously by the
pinmux core.
@@ -914,97 +970,111 @@ pinmux core.
Pinmux requests from drivers
============================
-Generally it is discouraged to let individual drivers get and enable pinmuxes.
-So if possible, handle the pinmuxes in platform code or some other place where
-you have access to all the affected struct device * pointers. In some cases
-where a driver needs to switch between different mux mappings at runtime
-this is not possible.
+Generally it is discouraged to let individual drivers get and enable pin
+control. So if possible, handle the pin control in platform code or some other
+place where you have access to all the affected struct device * pointers. In
+some cases where a driver needs to e.g. switch between different mux mappings
+at runtime this is not possible.
-A driver may request a certain mux to be activated, usually just the default
-mux like this:
+A driver may request a certain control state to be activated, usually just the
+default state like this:
-#include <linux/pinctrl/pinmux.h>
+#include <linux/pinctrl/consumer.h>
struct foo_state {
- struct pinmux *pmx;
+ struct pinctrl *p;
+ struct pinctrl_state *s;
...
};
foo_probe()
{
- /* Allocate a state holder named "state" etc */
- struct pinmux pmx;
+ /* Allocate a state holder named "foo" etc */
+ struct foo_state *foo = ...;
+
+ foo->p = pinctrl_get(&device);
+ if (IS_ERR(foo->p)) {
+ /* FIXME: clean up "foo" here */
+ return PTR_ERR(foo->p);
+ }
- pmx = pinmux_get(&device, NULL);
- if IS_ERR(pmx)
- return PTR_ERR(pmx);
- pinmux_enable(pmx);
+ foo->s = pinctrl_lookup_state(foo->p, PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT);
+ if (IS_ERR(foo->s)) {
+ pinctrl_put(foo->p);
+ /* FIXME: clean up "foo" here */
+ return PTR_ERR(s);
+ }
- state->pmx = pmx;
+ ret = pinctrl_select_state(foo->s);
+ if (ret < 0) {
+ pinctrl_put(foo->p);
+ /* FIXME: clean up "foo" here */
+ return ret;
+ }
}
foo_remove()
{
- pinmux_disable(state->pmx);
- pinmux_put(state->pmx);
+ pinctrl_put(state->p);
}
-If you want to grab a specific mux mapping and not just the first one found for
-this device you can specify a specific mapping name, for example in the above
-example the second i2c0 setting: pinmux_get(&device, "spi0-pos-B");
-
-This get/enable/disable/put sequence can just as well be handled by bus drivers
+This get/lookup/select/put sequence can just as well be handled by bus drivers
if you don't want each and every driver to handle it and you know the
arrangement on your bus.
-The semantics of the get/enable respective disable/put is as follows:
+The semantics of the pinctrl APIs are:
+
+- pinctrl_get() is called in process context to obtain a handle to all pinctrl
+ information for a given client device. It will allocate a struct from the
+ kernel memory to hold the pinmux state. All mapping table parsing or similar
+ slow operations take place within this API.
-- pinmux_get() is called in process context to reserve the pins affected with
- a certain mapping and set up the pinmux core and the driver. It will allocate
- a struct from the kernel memory to hold the pinmux state.
+- pinctrl_lookup_state() is called in process context to obtain a handle to a
+ specific state for a the client device. This operation may be slow too.
-- pinmux_enable()/pinmux_disable() is quick and can be called from fastpath
- (irq context) when you quickly want to set up/tear down the hardware muxing
- when running a device driver. Usually it will just poke some values into a
- register.
+- pinctrl_select_state() programs pin controller hardware according to the
+ definition of the state as given by the mapping table. In theory this is a
+ fast-path operation, since it only involved blasting some register settings
+ into hardware. However, note that some pin controllers may have their
+ registers on a slow/IRQ-based bus, so client devices should not assume they
+ can call pinctrl_select_state() from non-blocking contexts.
-- pinmux_disable() is called in process context to tear down the pin requests
- and release the state holder struct for the mux setting.
+- pinctrl_put() frees all information associated with a pinctrl handle.
-Usually the pinmux core handled the get/put pair and call out to the device
-drivers bookkeeping operations, like checking available functions and the
-associated pins, whereas the enable/disable pass on to the pin controller
+Usually the pin control core handled the get/put pair and call out to the
+device drivers bookkeeping operations, like checking available functions and
+the associated pins, whereas the enable/disable pass on to the pin controller
driver which takes care of activating and/or deactivating the mux setting by
quickly poking some registers.
-The pins are allocated for your device when you issue the pinmux_get() call,
+The pins are allocated for your device when you issue the pinctrl_get() call,
after this you should be able to see this in the debugfs listing of all pins.
-System pinmux hogging
-=====================
+System pin control hogging
+==========================
-A system pinmux map entry, i.e. a pinmux setting that does not have a device
-associated with it, can be hogged by the core when the pin controller is
-registered. This means that the core will attempt to call pinmux_get() and
-pinmux_enable() on it immediately after the pin control device has been
-registered.
+Pin control map entries can be hogged by the core when the pin controller
+is registered. This means that the core will attempt to call pinctrl_get(),
+lookup_state() and select_state() on it immediately after the pin control
+device has been registered.
-This is enabled by simply setting the .hog_on_boot field in the map to true,
-like this:
+This occurs for mapping table entries where the client device name is equal
+to the pin controller device name, and the state name is PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT.
{
- .name = "POWERMAP"
+ .dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
+ .name = PINCTRL_STATE_DEFAULT,
+ .type = PIN_MAP_TYPE_MUX_GROUP,
.ctrl_dev_name = "pinctrl-foo",
.function = "power_func",
- .hog_on_boot = true,
},
Since it may be common to request the core to hog a few always-applicable
mux settings on the primary pin controller, there is a convenience macro for
this:
-PINMUX_MAP_PRIMARY_SYS_HOG("POWERMAP", "power_func")
+PIN_MAP_MUX_GROUP_HOG_DEFAULT("pinctrl-foo", NULL /* group */, "power_func")
This gives the exact same result as the above construction.
@@ -1016,32 +1086,47 @@ It is possible to mux a certain function in and out at runtime, say to move
an SPI port from one set of pins to another set of pins. Say for example for
spi0 in the example above, we expose two different groups of pins for the same
function, but with different named in the mapping as described under
-"Advanced mapping" above. So we have two mappings named "spi0-pos-A" and
-"spi0-pos-B".
+"Advanced mapping" above. So that for an SPI device, we have two states named
+"pos-A" and "pos-B".
This snippet first muxes the function in the pins defined by group A, enables
it, disables and releases it, and muxes it in on the pins defined by group B:
+#include <linux/pinctrl/consumer.h>
+
foo_switch()
{
- struct pinmux *pmx;
+ struct pinctrl *p;
+ struct pinctrl_state *s1, *s2;
+
+ /* Setup */
+ p = pinctrl_get(&device);
+ if (IS_ERR(p))
+ ...
+
+ s1 = pinctrl_lookup_state(foo->p, "pos-A");
+ if (IS_ERR(s1))
+ ...
+
+ s2 = pinctrl_lookup_state(foo->p, "pos-B");
+ if (IS_ERR(s2))
+ ...
/* Enable on position A */
- pmx = pinmux_get(&device, "spi0-pos-A");
- if IS_ERR(pmx)
- return PTR_ERR(pmx);
- pinmux_enable(pmx);
+ ret = pinctrl_select_state(s1);
+ if (ret < 0)
+ ...
- /* This releases the pins again */
- pinmux_disable(pmx);
- pinmux_put(pmx);
+ ...
/* Enable on position B */
- pmx = pinmux_get(&device, "spi0-pos-B");
- if IS_ERR(pmx)
- return PTR_ERR(pmx);
- pinmux_enable(pmx);
+ ret = pinctrl_select_state(s2);
+ if (ret < 0)
+ ...
+
...
+
+ pinctrl_put(p);
}
The above has to be done from process context.
diff --git a/Documentation/power/devices.txt b/Documentation/power/devices.txt
index 20af7def23c..872815cd41d 100644
--- a/Documentation/power/devices.txt
+++ b/Documentation/power/devices.txt
@@ -96,6 +96,12 @@ struct dev_pm_ops {
int (*thaw)(struct device *dev);
int (*poweroff)(struct device *dev);
int (*restore)(struct device *dev);
+ int (*suspend_late)(struct device *dev);
+ int (*resume_early)(struct device *dev);
+ int (*freeze_late)(struct device *dev);
+ int (*thaw_early)(struct device *dev);
+ int (*poweroff_late)(struct device *dev);
+ int (*restore_early)(struct device *dev);
int (*suspend_noirq)(struct device *dev);
int (*resume_noirq)(struct device *dev);
int (*freeze_noirq)(struct device *dev);
@@ -305,7 +311,7 @@ Entering System Suspend
-----------------------
When the system goes into the standby or memory sleep state, the phases are:
- prepare, suspend, suspend_noirq.
+ prepare, suspend, suspend_late, suspend_noirq.
1. The prepare phase is meant to prevent races by preventing new devices
from being registered; the PM core would never know that all the
@@ -324,7 +330,12 @@ When the system goes into the standby or memory sleep state, the phases are:
appropriate low-power state, depending on the bus type the device is on,
and they may enable wakeup events.
- 3. The suspend_noirq phase occurs after IRQ handlers have been disabled,
+ 3 For a number of devices it is convenient to split suspend into the
+ "quiesce device" and "save device state" phases, in which cases
+ suspend_late is meant to do the latter. It is always executed after
+ runtime power management has been disabled for all devices.
+
+ 4. The suspend_noirq phase occurs after IRQ handlers have been disabled,
which means that the driver's interrupt handler will not be called while
the callback method is running. The methods should save the values of
the device's registers that weren't saved previously and finally put the
@@ -359,7 +370,7 @@ Leaving System Suspend
----------------------
When resuming from standby or memory sleep, the phases are:
- resume_noirq, resume, complete.
+ resume_noirq, resume_early, resume, complete.
1. The resume_noirq callback methods should perform any actions needed
before the driver's interrupt handlers are invoked. This generally
@@ -375,14 +386,18 @@ When resuming from standby or memory sleep, the phases are:
device driver's ->pm.resume_noirq() method to perform device-specific
actions.
- 2. The resume methods should bring the the device back to its operating
+ 2. The resume_early methods should prepare devices for the execution of
+ the resume methods. This generally involves undoing the actions of the
+ preceding suspend_late phase.
+
+ 3 The resume methods should bring the the device back to its operating
state, so that it can perform normal I/O. This generally involves
undoing the actions of the suspend phase.
- 3. The complete phase uses only a bus callback. The method should undo the
- actions of the prepare phase. Note, however, that new children may be
- registered below the device as soon as the resume callbacks occur; it's
- not necessary to wait until the complete phase.
+ 4. The complete phase should undo the actions of the prepare phase. Note,
+ however, that new children may be registered below the device as soon as
+ the resume callbacks occur; it's not necessary to wait until the
+ complete phase.
At the end of these phases, drivers should be as functional as they were before
suspending: I/O can be performed using DMA and IRQs, and the relevant clocks are
@@ -429,8 +444,8 @@ an image of the system memory while everything is stable, reactivate all
devices (thaw), write the image to permanent storage, and finally shut down the
system (poweroff). The phases used to accomplish this are:
- prepare, freeze, freeze_noirq, thaw_noirq, thaw, complete,
- prepare, poweroff, poweroff_noirq
+ prepare, freeze, freeze_late, freeze_noirq, thaw_noirq, thaw_early,
+ thaw, complete, prepare, poweroff, poweroff_late, poweroff_noirq
1. The prepare phase is discussed in the "Entering System Suspend" section
above.
@@ -441,7 +456,11 @@ system (poweroff). The phases used to accomplish this are:
save time it's best not to do so. Also, the device should not be
prepared to generate wakeup events.
- 3. The freeze_noirq phase is analogous to the suspend_noirq phase discussed
+ 3. The freeze_late phase is analogous to the suspend_late phase described
+ above, except that the device should not be put in a low-power state and
+ should not be allowed to generate wakeup events by it.
+
+ 4. The freeze_noirq phase is analogous to the suspend_noirq phase discussed
above, except again that the device should not be put in a low-power
state and should not be allowed to generate wakeup events.
@@ -449,15 +468,19 @@ At this point the system image is created. All devices should be inactive and
the contents of memory should remain undisturbed while this happens, so that the
image forms an atomic snapshot of the system state.
- 4. The thaw_noirq phase is analogous to the resume_noirq phase discussed
+ 5. The thaw_noirq phase is analogous to the resume_noirq phase discussed
above. The main difference is that its methods can assume the device is
in the same state as at the end of the freeze_noirq phase.
- 5. The thaw phase is analogous to the resume phase discussed above. Its
+ 6. The thaw_early phase is analogous to the resume_early phase described
+ above. Its methods should undo the actions of the preceding
+ freeze_late, if necessary.
+
+ 7. The thaw phase is analogous to the resume phase discussed above. Its
methods should bring the device back to an operating state, so that it
can be used for saving the image if necessary.
- 6. The complete phase is discussed in the "Leaving System Suspend" section
+ 8. The complete phase is discussed in the "Leaving System Suspend" section
above.
At this point the system image is saved, and the devices then need to be
@@ -465,16 +488,19 @@ prepared for the upcoming system shutdown. This is much like suspending them
before putting the system into the standby or memory sleep state, and the phases
are similar.
- 7. The prepare phase is discussed above.
+ 9. The prepare phase is discussed above.
+
+ 10. The poweroff phase is analogous to the suspend phase.
- 8. The poweroff phase is analogous to the suspend phase.
+ 11. The poweroff_late phase is analogous to the suspend_late phase.
- 9. The poweroff_noirq phase is analogous to the suspend_noirq phase.
+ 12. The poweroff_noirq phase is analogous to the suspend_noirq phase.
-The poweroff and poweroff_noirq callbacks should do essentially the same things
-as the suspend and suspend_noirq callbacks. The only notable difference is that
-they need not store the device register values, because the registers should
-already have been stored during the freeze or freeze_noirq phases.
+The poweroff, poweroff_late and poweroff_noirq callbacks should do essentially
+the same things as the suspend, suspend_late and suspend_noirq callbacks,
+respectively. The only notable difference is that they need not store the
+device register values, because the registers should already have been stored
+during the freeze, freeze_late or freeze_noirq phases.
Leaving Hibernation
@@ -518,22 +544,25 @@ To achieve this, the image kernel must restore the devices' pre-hibernation
functionality. The operation is much like waking up from the memory sleep
state, although it involves different phases:
- restore_noirq, restore, complete
+ restore_noirq, restore_early, restore, complete
1. The restore_noirq phase is analogous to the resume_noirq phase.
- 2. The restore phase is analogous to the resume phase.
+ 2. The restore_early phase is analogous to the resume_early phase.
+
+ 3. The restore phase is analogous to the resume phase.
- 3. The complete phase is discussed above.
+ 4. The complete phase is discussed above.
-The main difference from resume[_noirq] is that restore[_noirq] must assume the
-device has been accessed and reconfigured by the boot loader or the boot kernel.
-Consequently the state of the device may be different from the state remembered
-from the freeze and freeze_noirq phases. The device may even need to be reset
-and completely re-initialized. In many cases this difference doesn't matter, so
-the resume[_noirq] and restore[_norq] method pointers can be set to the same
-routines. Nevertheless, different callback pointers are used in case there is a
-situation where it actually matters.
+The main difference from resume[_early|_noirq] is that restore[_early|_noirq]
+must assume the device has been accessed and reconfigured by the boot loader or
+the boot kernel. Consequently the state of the device may be different from the
+state remembered from the freeze, freeze_late and freeze_noirq phases. The
+device may even need to be reset and completely re-initialized. In many cases
+this difference doesn't matter, so the resume[_early|_noirq] and
+restore[_early|_norq] method pointers can be set to the same routines.
+Nevertheless, different callback pointers are used in case there is a situation
+where it actually does matter.
Device Power Management Domains
diff --git a/Documentation/power/freezing-of-tasks.txt b/Documentation/power/freezing-of-tasks.txt
index ebd7490ef1d..ec715cd78fb 100644
--- a/Documentation/power/freezing-of-tasks.txt
+++ b/Documentation/power/freezing-of-tasks.txt
@@ -63,6 +63,27 @@ devices have been reinitialized, the function thaw_processes() is called in
order to clear the PF_FROZEN flag for each frozen task. Then, the tasks that
have been frozen leave __refrigerator() and continue running.
+
+Rationale behind the functions dealing with freezing and thawing of tasks:
+-------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+freeze_processes():
+ - freezes only userspace tasks
+
+freeze_kernel_threads():
+ - freezes all tasks (including kernel threads) because we can't freeze
+ kernel threads without freezing userspace tasks
+
+thaw_kernel_threads():
+ - thaws only kernel threads; this is particularly useful if we need to do
+ anything special in between thawing of kernel threads and thawing of
+ userspace tasks, or if we want to postpone the thawing of userspace tasks
+
+thaw_processes():
+ - thaws all tasks (including kernel threads) because we can't thaw userspace
+ tasks without thawing kernel threads
+
+
III. Which kernel threads are freezable?
Kernel threads are not freezable by default. However, a kernel thread may clear
diff --git a/Documentation/powerpc/firmware-assisted-dump.txt b/Documentation/powerpc/firmware-assisted-dump.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..3007bc98af2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/powerpc/firmware-assisted-dump.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,270 @@
+
+ Firmware-Assisted Dump
+ ------------------------
+ July 2011
+
+The goal of firmware-assisted dump is to enable the dump of
+a crashed system, and to do so from a fully-reset system, and
+to minimize the total elapsed time until the system is back
+in production use.
+
+- Firmware assisted dump (fadump) infrastructure is intended to replace
+ the existing phyp assisted dump.
+- Fadump uses the same firmware interfaces and memory reservation model
+ as phyp assisted dump.
+- Unlike phyp dump, fadump exports the memory dump through /proc/vmcore
+ in the ELF format in the same way as kdump. This helps us reuse the
+ kdump infrastructure for dump capture and filtering.
+- Unlike phyp dump, userspace tool does not need to refer any sysfs
+ interface while reading /proc/vmcore.
+- Unlike phyp dump, fadump allows user to release all the memory reserved
+ for dump, with a single operation of echo 1 > /sys/kernel/fadump_release_mem.
+- Once enabled through kernel boot parameter, fadump can be
+ started/stopped through /sys/kernel/fadump_registered interface (see
+ sysfs files section below) and can be easily integrated with kdump
+ service start/stop init scripts.
+
+Comparing with kdump or other strategies, firmware-assisted
+dump offers several strong, practical advantages:
+
+-- Unlike kdump, the system has been reset, and loaded
+ with a fresh copy of the kernel. In particular,
+ PCI and I/O devices have been reinitialized and are
+ in a clean, consistent state.
+-- Once the dump is copied out, the memory that held the dump
+ is immediately available to the running kernel. And therefore,
+ unlike kdump, fadump doesn't need a 2nd reboot to get back
+ the system to the production configuration.
+
+The above can only be accomplished by coordination with,
+and assistance from the Power firmware. The procedure is
+as follows:
+
+-- The first kernel registers the sections of memory with the
+ Power firmware for dump preservation during OS initialization.
+ These registered sections of memory are reserved by the first
+ kernel during early boot.
+
+-- When a system crashes, the Power firmware will save
+ the low memory (boot memory of size larger of 5% of system RAM
+ or 256MB) of RAM to the previous registered region. It will
+ also save system registers, and hardware PTE's.
+
+ NOTE: The term 'boot memory' means size of the low memory chunk
+ that is required for a kernel to boot successfully when
+ booted with restricted memory. By default, the boot memory
+ size will be the larger of 5% of system RAM or 256MB.
+ Alternatively, user can also specify boot memory size
+ through boot parameter 'fadump_reserve_mem=' which will
+ override the default calculated size. Use this option
+ if default boot memory size is not sufficient for second
+ kernel to boot successfully.
+
+-- After the low memory (boot memory) area has been saved, the
+ firmware will reset PCI and other hardware state. It will
+ *not* clear the RAM. It will then launch the bootloader, as
+ normal.
+
+-- The freshly booted kernel will notice that there is a new
+ node (ibm,dump-kernel) in the device tree, indicating that
+ there is crash data available from a previous boot. During
+ the early boot OS will reserve rest of the memory above
+ boot memory size effectively booting with restricted memory
+ size. This will make sure that the second kernel will not
+ touch any of the dump memory area.
+
+-- User-space tools will read /proc/vmcore to obtain the contents
+ of memory, which holds the previous crashed kernel dump in ELF
+ format. The userspace tools may copy this info to disk, or
+ network, nas, san, iscsi, etc. as desired.
+
+-- Once the userspace tool is done saving dump, it will echo
+ '1' to /sys/kernel/fadump_release_mem to release the reserved
+ memory back to general use, except the memory required for
+ next firmware-assisted dump registration.
+
+ e.g.
+ # echo 1 > /sys/kernel/fadump_release_mem
+
+Please note that the firmware-assisted dump feature
+is only available on Power6 and above systems with recent
+firmware versions.
+
+Implementation details:
+----------------------
+
+During boot, a check is made to see if firmware supports
+this feature on that particular machine. If it does, then
+we check to see if an active dump is waiting for us. If yes
+then everything but boot memory size of RAM is reserved during
+early boot (See Fig. 2). This area is released once we finish
+collecting the dump from user land scripts (e.g. kdump scripts)
+that are run. If there is dump data, then the
+/sys/kernel/fadump_release_mem file is created, and the reserved
+memory is held.
+
+If there is no waiting dump data, then only the memory required
+to hold CPU state, HPTE region, boot memory dump and elfcore
+header, is reserved at the top of memory (see Fig. 1). This area
+is *not* released: this region will be kept permanently reserved,
+so that it can act as a receptacle for a copy of the boot memory
+content in addition to CPU state and HPTE region, in the case a
+crash does occur.
+
+ o Memory Reservation during first kernel
+
+ Low memory Top of memory
+ 0 boot memory size |
+ | | |<--Reserved dump area -->|
+ V V | Permanent Reservation V
+ +-----------+----------/ /----------+---+----+-----------+----+
+ | | |CPU|HPTE| DUMP |ELF |
+ +-----------+----------/ /----------+---+----+-----------+----+
+ | ^
+ | |
+ \ /
+ -------------------------------------------
+ Boot memory content gets transferred to
+ reserved area by firmware at the time of
+ crash
+ Fig. 1
+
+ o Memory Reservation during second kernel after crash
+
+ Low memory Top of memory
+ 0 boot memory size |
+ | |<------------- Reserved dump area ----------- -->|
+ V V V
+ +-----------+----------/ /----------+---+----+-----------+----+
+ | | |CPU|HPTE| DUMP |ELF |
+ +-----------+----------/ /----------+---+----+-----------+----+
+ | |
+ V V
+ Used by second /proc/vmcore
+ kernel to boot
+ Fig. 2
+
+Currently the dump will be copied from /proc/vmcore to a
+a new file upon user intervention. The dump data available through
+/proc/vmcore will be in ELF format. Hence the existing kdump
+infrastructure (kdump scripts) to save the dump works fine with
+minor modifications.
+
+The tools to examine the dump will be same as the ones
+used for kdump.
+
+How to enable firmware-assisted dump (fadump):
+-------------------------------------
+
+1. Set config option CONFIG_FA_DUMP=y and build kernel.
+2. Boot into linux kernel with 'fadump=on' kernel cmdline option.
+3. Optionally, user can also set 'fadump_reserve_mem=' kernel cmdline
+ to specify size of the memory to reserve for boot memory dump
+ preservation.
+
+NOTE: If firmware-assisted dump fails to reserve memory then it will
+ fallback to existing kdump mechanism if 'crashkernel=' option
+ is set at kernel cmdline.
+
+Sysfs/debugfs files:
+------------
+
+Firmware-assisted dump feature uses sysfs file system to hold
+the control files and debugfs file to display memory reserved region.
+
+Here is the list of files under kernel sysfs:
+
+ /sys/kernel/fadump_enabled
+
+ This is used to display the fadump status.
+ 0 = fadump is disabled
+ 1 = fadump is enabled
+
+ This interface can be used by kdump init scripts to identify if
+ fadump is enabled in the kernel and act accordingly.
+
+ /sys/kernel/fadump_registered
+
+ This is used to display the fadump registration status as well
+ as to control (start/stop) the fadump registration.
+ 0 = fadump is not registered.
+ 1 = fadump is registered and ready to handle system crash.
+
+ To register fadump echo 1 > /sys/kernel/fadump_registered and
+ echo 0 > /sys/kernel/fadump_registered for un-register and stop the
+ fadump. Once the fadump is un-registered, the system crash will not
+ be handled and vmcore will not be captured. This interface can be
+ easily integrated with kdump service start/stop.
+
+ /sys/kernel/fadump_release_mem
+
+ This file is available only when fadump is active during
+ second kernel. This is used to release the reserved memory
+ region that are held for saving crash dump. To release the
+ reserved memory echo 1 to it:
+
+ echo 1 > /sys/kernel/fadump_release_mem
+
+ After echo 1, the content of the /sys/kernel/debug/powerpc/fadump_region
+ file will change to reflect the new memory reservations.
+
+ The existing userspace tools (kdump infrastructure) can be easily
+ enhanced to use this interface to release the memory reserved for
+ dump and continue without 2nd reboot.
+
+Here is the list of files under powerpc debugfs:
+(Assuming debugfs is mounted on /sys/kernel/debug directory.)
+
+ /sys/kernel/debug/powerpc/fadump_region
+
+ This file shows the reserved memory regions if fadump is
+ enabled otherwise this file is empty. The output format
+ is:
+ <region>: [<start>-<end>] <reserved-size> bytes, Dumped: <dump-size>
+
+ e.g.
+ Contents when fadump is registered during first kernel
+
+ # cat /sys/kernel/debug/powerpc/fadump_region
+ CPU : [0x0000006ffb0000-0x0000006fff001f] 0x40020 bytes, Dumped: 0x0
+ HPTE: [0x0000006fff0020-0x0000006fff101f] 0x1000 bytes, Dumped: 0x0
+ DUMP: [0x0000006fff1020-0x0000007fff101f] 0x10000000 bytes, Dumped: 0x0
+
+ Contents when fadump is active during second kernel
+
+ # cat /sys/kernel/debug/powerpc/fadump_region
+ CPU : [0x0000006ffb0000-0x0000006fff001f] 0x40020 bytes, Dumped: 0x40020
+ HPTE: [0x0000006fff0020-0x0000006fff101f] 0x1000 bytes, Dumped: 0x1000
+ DUMP: [0x0000006fff1020-0x0000007fff101f] 0x10000000 bytes, Dumped: 0x10000000
+ : [0x00000010000000-0x0000006ffaffff] 0x5ffb0000 bytes, Dumped: 0x5ffb0000
+
+NOTE: Please refer to Documentation/filesystems/debugfs.txt on
+ how to mount the debugfs filesystem.
+
+
+TODO:
+-----
+ o Need to come up with the better approach to find out more
+ accurate boot memory size that is required for a kernel to
+ boot successfully when booted with restricted memory.
+ o The fadump implementation introduces a fadump crash info structure
+ in the scratch area before the ELF core header. The idea of introducing
+ this structure is to pass some important crash info data to the second
+ kernel which will help second kernel to populate ELF core header with
+ correct data before it gets exported through /proc/vmcore. The current
+ design implementation does not address a possibility of introducing
+ additional fields (in future) to this structure without affecting
+ compatibility. Need to come up with the better approach to address this.
+ The possible approaches are:
+ 1. Introduce version field for version tracking, bump up the version
+ whenever a new field is added to the structure in future. The version
+ field can be used to find out what fields are valid for the current
+ version of the structure.
+ 2. Reserve the area of predefined size (say PAGE_SIZE) for this
+ structure and have unused area as reserved (initialized to zero)
+ for future field additions.
+ The advantage of approach 1 over 2 is we don't need to reserve extra space.
+---
+Author: Mahesh Salgaonkar <mahesh@linux.vnet.ibm.com>
+This document is based on the original documentation written for phyp
+assisted dump by Linas Vepstas and Manish Ahuja.
diff --git a/Documentation/powerpc/mpc52xx.txt b/Documentation/powerpc/mpc52xx.txt
index 10dd4ab93b8..0d540a31ea1 100644
--- a/Documentation/powerpc/mpc52xx.txt
+++ b/Documentation/powerpc/mpc52xx.txt
@@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ Linux 2.6.x on MPC52xx family
-----------------------------
For the latest info, go to http://www.246tNt.com/mpc52xx/
-
+
To compile/use :
- U-Boot:
@@ -10,23 +10,23 @@ To compile/use :
if you wish to ).
# make lite5200_defconfig
# make uImage
-
+
then, on U-boot:
=> tftpboot 200000 uImage
=> tftpboot 400000 pRamdisk
=> bootm 200000 400000
-
+
- DBug:
# <edit Makefile to set ARCH=ppc & CROSS_COMPILE=... ( also EXTRAVERSION
if you wish to ).
# make lite5200_defconfig
# cp your_initrd.gz arch/ppc/boot/images/ramdisk.image.gz
- # make zImage.initrd
- # make
+ # make zImage.initrd
+ # make
then in DBug:
DBug> dn -i zImage.initrd.lite5200
-
+
Some remarks :
- The port is named mpc52xxx, and config options are PPC_MPC52xx. The MGT5100
diff --git a/Documentation/powerpc/phyp-assisted-dump.txt b/Documentation/powerpc/phyp-assisted-dump.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index ad340205d96..00000000000
--- a/Documentation/powerpc/phyp-assisted-dump.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,127 +0,0 @@
-
- Hypervisor-Assisted Dump
- ------------------------
- November 2007
-
-The goal of hypervisor-assisted dump is to enable the dump of
-a crashed system, and to do so from a fully-reset system, and
-to minimize the total elapsed time until the system is back
-in production use.
-
-As compared to kdump or other strategies, hypervisor-assisted
-dump offers several strong, practical advantages:
-
--- Unlike kdump, the system has been reset, and loaded
- with a fresh copy of the kernel. In particular,
- PCI and I/O devices have been reinitialized and are
- in a clean, consistent state.
--- As the dump is performed, the dumped memory becomes
- immediately available to the system for normal use.
--- After the dump is completed, no further reboots are
- required; the system will be fully usable, and running
- in its normal, production mode on its normal kernel.
-
-The above can only be accomplished by coordination with,
-and assistance from the hypervisor. The procedure is
-as follows:
-
--- When a system crashes, the hypervisor will save
- the low 256MB of RAM to a previously registered
- save region. It will also save system state, system
- registers, and hardware PTE's.
-
--- After the low 256MB area has been saved, the
- hypervisor will reset PCI and other hardware state.
- It will *not* clear RAM. It will then launch the
- bootloader, as normal.
-
--- The freshly booted kernel will notice that there
- is a new node (ibm,dump-kernel) in the device tree,
- indicating that there is crash data available from
- a previous boot. It will boot into only 256MB of RAM,
- reserving the rest of system memory.
-
--- Userspace tools will parse /sys/kernel/release_region
- and read /proc/vmcore to obtain the contents of memory,
- which holds the previous crashed kernel. The userspace
- tools may copy this info to disk, or network, nas, san,
- iscsi, etc. as desired.
-
- For Example: the values in /sys/kernel/release-region
- would look something like this (address-range pairs).
- CPU:0x177fee000-0x10000: HPTE:0x177ffe020-0x1000: /
- DUMP:0x177fff020-0x10000000, 0x10000000-0x16F1D370A
-
--- As the userspace tools complete saving a portion of
- dump, they echo an offset and size to
- /sys/kernel/release_region to release the reserved
- memory back to general use.
-
- An example of this is:
- "echo 0x40000000 0x10000000 > /sys/kernel/release_region"
- which will release 256MB at the 1GB boundary.
-
-Please note that the hypervisor-assisted dump feature
-is only available on Power6-based systems with recent
-firmware versions.
-
-Implementation details:
-----------------------
-
-During boot, a check is made to see if firmware supports
-this feature on this particular machine. If it does, then
-we check to see if a active dump is waiting for us. If yes
-then everything but 256 MB of RAM is reserved during early
-boot. This area is released once we collect a dump from user
-land scripts that are run. If there is dump data, then
-the /sys/kernel/release_region file is created, and
-the reserved memory is held.
-
-If there is no waiting dump data, then only the highest
-256MB of the ram is reserved as a scratch area. This area
-is *not* released: this region will be kept permanently
-reserved, so that it can act as a receptacle for a copy
-of the low 256MB in the case a crash does occur. See,
-however, "open issues" below, as to whether
-such a reserved region is really needed.
-
-Currently the dump will be copied from /proc/vmcore to a
-a new file upon user intervention. The starting address
-to be read and the range for each data point in provided
-in /sys/kernel/release_region.
-
-The tools to examine the dump will be same as the ones
-used for kdump.
-
-General notes:
---------------
-Security: please note that there are potential security issues
-with any sort of dump mechanism. In particular, plaintext
-(unencrypted) data, and possibly passwords, may be present in
-the dump data. Userspace tools must take adequate precautions to
-preserve security.
-
-Open issues/ToDo:
-------------
- o The various code paths that tell the hypervisor that a crash
- occurred, vs. it simply being a normal reboot, should be
- reviewed, and possibly clarified/fixed.
-
- o Instead of using /sys/kernel, should there be a /sys/dump
- instead? There is a dump_subsys being created by the s390 code,
- perhaps the pseries code should use a similar layout as well.
-
- o Is reserving a 256MB region really required? The goal of
- reserving a 256MB scratch area is to make sure that no
- important crash data is clobbered when the hypervisor
- save low mem to the scratch area. But, if one could assure
- that nothing important is located in some 256MB area, then
- it would not need to be reserved. Something that can be
- improved in subsequent versions.
-
- o Still working the kdump team to integrate this with kdump,
- some work remains but this would not affect the current
- patches.
-
- o Still need to write a shell script, to copy the dump away.
- Currently I am parsing it manually.
diff --git a/Documentation/remoteproc.txt b/Documentation/remoteproc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..70a048cd3fa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/remoteproc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,322 @@
+Remote Processor Framework
+
+1. Introduction
+
+Modern SoCs typically have heterogeneous remote processor devices in asymmetric
+multiprocessing (AMP) configurations, which may be running different instances
+of operating system, whether it's Linux or any other flavor of real-time OS.
+
+OMAP4, for example, has dual Cortex-A9, dual Cortex-M3 and a C64x+ DSP.
+In a typical configuration, the dual cortex-A9 is running Linux in a SMP
+configuration, and each of the other three cores (two M3 cores and a DSP)
+is running its own instance of RTOS in an AMP configuration.
+
+The remoteproc framework allows different platforms/architectures to
+control (power on, load firmware, power off) those remote processors while
+abstracting the hardware differences, so the entire driver doesn't need to be
+duplicated. In addition, this framework also adds rpmsg virtio devices
+for remote processors that supports this kind of communication. This way,
+platform-specific remoteproc drivers only need to provide a few low-level
+handlers, and then all rpmsg drivers will then just work
+(for more information about the virtio-based rpmsg bus and its drivers,
+please read Documentation/rpmsg.txt).
+Registration of other types of virtio devices is now also possible. Firmwares
+just need to publish what kind of virtio devices do they support, and then
+remoteproc will add those devices. This makes it possible to reuse the
+existing virtio drivers with remote processor backends at a minimal development
+cost.
+
+2. User API
+
+ int rproc_boot(struct rproc *rproc)
+ - Boot a remote processor (i.e. load its firmware, power it on, ...).
+ If the remote processor is already powered on, this function immediately
+ returns (successfully).
+ Returns 0 on success, and an appropriate error value otherwise.
+ Note: to use this function you should already have a valid rproc
+ handle. There are several ways to achieve that cleanly (devres, pdata,
+ the way remoteproc_rpmsg.c does this, or, if this becomes prevalent, we
+ might also consider using dev_archdata for this). See also
+ rproc_get_by_name() below.
+
+ void rproc_shutdown(struct rproc *rproc)
+ - Power off a remote processor (previously booted with rproc_boot()).
+ In case @rproc is still being used by an additional user(s), then
+ this function will just decrement the power refcount and exit,
+ without really powering off the device.
+ Every call to rproc_boot() must (eventually) be accompanied by a call
+ to rproc_shutdown(). Calling rproc_shutdown() redundantly is a bug.
+ Notes:
+ - we're not decrementing the rproc's refcount, only the power refcount.
+ which means that the @rproc handle stays valid even after
+ rproc_shutdown() returns, and users can still use it with a subsequent
+ rproc_boot(), if needed.
+ - don't call rproc_shutdown() to unroll rproc_get_by_name(), exactly
+ because rproc_shutdown() _does not_ decrement the refcount of @rproc.
+ To decrement the refcount of @rproc, use rproc_put() (but _only_ if
+ you acquired @rproc using rproc_get_by_name()).
+
+ struct rproc *rproc_get_by_name(const char *name)
+ - Find an rproc handle using the remote processor's name, and then
+ boot it. If it's already powered on, then just immediately return
+ (successfully). Returns the rproc handle on success, and NULL on failure.
+ This function increments the remote processor's refcount, so always
+ use rproc_put() to decrement it back once rproc isn't needed anymore.
+ Note: currently rproc_get_by_name() and rproc_put() are not used anymore
+ by the rpmsg bus and its drivers. We need to scrutinize the use cases
+ that still need them, and see if we can migrate them to use the non
+ name-based boot/shutdown interface.
+
+ void rproc_put(struct rproc *rproc)
+ - Decrement @rproc's power refcount and shut it down if it reaches zero
+ (essentially by just calling rproc_shutdown), and then decrement @rproc's
+ validity refcount too.
+ After this function returns, @rproc may _not_ be used anymore, and its
+ handle should be considered invalid.
+ This function should be called _iff_ the @rproc handle was grabbed by
+ calling rproc_get_by_name().
+
+3. Typical usage
+
+#include <linux/remoteproc.h>
+
+/* in case we were given a valid 'rproc' handle */
+int dummy_rproc_example(struct rproc *my_rproc)
+{
+ int ret;
+
+ /* let's power on and boot our remote processor */
+ ret = rproc_boot(my_rproc);
+ if (ret) {
+ /*
+ * something went wrong. handle it and leave.
+ */
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * our remote processor is now powered on... give it some work
+ */
+
+ /* let's shut it down now */
+ rproc_shutdown(my_rproc);
+}
+
+4. API for implementors
+
+ struct rproc *rproc_alloc(struct device *dev, const char *name,
+ const struct rproc_ops *ops,
+ const char *firmware, int len)
+ - Allocate a new remote processor handle, but don't register
+ it yet. Required parameters are the underlying device, the
+ name of this remote processor, platform-specific ops handlers,
+ the name of the firmware to boot this rproc with, and the
+ length of private data needed by the allocating rproc driver (in bytes).
+
+ This function should be used by rproc implementations during
+ initialization of the remote processor.
+ After creating an rproc handle using this function, and when ready,
+ implementations should then call rproc_register() to complete
+ the registration of the remote processor.
+ On success, the new rproc is returned, and on failure, NULL.
+
+ Note: _never_ directly deallocate @rproc, even if it was not registered
+ yet. Instead, if you just need to unroll rproc_alloc(), use rproc_free().
+
+ void rproc_free(struct rproc *rproc)
+ - Free an rproc handle that was allocated by rproc_alloc.
+ This function should _only_ be used if @rproc was only allocated,
+ but not registered yet.
+ If @rproc was already successfully registered (by calling
+ rproc_register()), then use rproc_unregister() instead.
+
+ int rproc_register(struct rproc *rproc)
+ - Register @rproc with the remoteproc framework, after it has been
+ allocated with rproc_alloc().
+ This is called by the platform-specific rproc implementation, whenever
+ a new remote processor device is probed.
+ Returns 0 on success and an appropriate error code otherwise.
+ Note: this function initiates an asynchronous firmware loading
+ context, which will look for virtio devices supported by the rproc's
+ firmware.
+ If found, those virtio devices will be created and added, so as a result
+ of registering this remote processor, additional virtio drivers might get
+ probed.
+
+ int rproc_unregister(struct rproc *rproc)
+ - Unregister a remote processor, and decrement its refcount.
+ If its refcount drops to zero, then @rproc will be freed. If not,
+ it will be freed later once the last reference is dropped.
+
+ This function should be called when the platform specific rproc
+ implementation decides to remove the rproc device. it should
+ _only_ be called if a previous invocation of rproc_register()
+ has completed successfully.
+
+ After rproc_unregister() returns, @rproc is _not_ valid anymore and
+ it shouldn't be used. More specifically, don't call rproc_free()
+ or try to directly free @rproc after rproc_unregister() returns;
+ none of these are needed, and calling them is a bug.
+
+ Returns 0 on success and -EINVAL if @rproc isn't valid.
+
+5. Implementation callbacks
+
+These callbacks should be provided by platform-specific remoteproc
+drivers:
+
+/**
+ * struct rproc_ops - platform-specific device handlers
+ * @start: power on the device and boot it
+ * @stop: power off the device
+ * @kick: kick a virtqueue (virtqueue id given as a parameter)
+ */
+struct rproc_ops {
+ int (*start)(struct rproc *rproc);
+ int (*stop)(struct rproc *rproc);
+ void (*kick)(struct rproc *rproc, int vqid);
+};
+
+Every remoteproc implementation should at least provide the ->start and ->stop
+handlers. If rpmsg/virtio functionality is also desired, then the ->kick handler
+should be provided as well.
+
+The ->start() handler takes an rproc handle and should then power on the
+device and boot it (use rproc->priv to access platform-specific private data).
+The boot address, in case needed, can be found in rproc->bootaddr (remoteproc
+core puts there the ELF entry point).
+On success, 0 should be returned, and on failure, an appropriate error code.
+
+The ->stop() handler takes an rproc handle and powers the device down.
+On success, 0 is returned, and on failure, an appropriate error code.
+
+The ->kick() handler takes an rproc handle, and an index of a virtqueue
+where new message was placed in. Implementations should interrupt the remote
+processor and let it know it has pending messages. Notifying remote processors
+the exact virtqueue index to look in is optional: it is easy (and not
+too expensive) to go through the existing virtqueues and look for new buffers
+in the used rings.
+
+6. Binary Firmware Structure
+
+At this point remoteproc only supports ELF32 firmware binaries. However,
+it is quite expected that other platforms/devices which we'd want to
+support with this framework will be based on different binary formats.
+
+When those use cases show up, we will have to decouple the binary format
+from the framework core, so we can support several binary formats without
+duplicating common code.
+
+When the firmware is parsed, its various segments are loaded to memory
+according to the specified device address (might be a physical address
+if the remote processor is accessing memory directly).
+
+In addition to the standard ELF segments, most remote processors would
+also include a special section which we call "the resource table".
+
+The resource table contains system resources that the remote processor
+requires before it should be powered on, such as allocation of physically
+contiguous memory, or iommu mapping of certain on-chip peripherals.
+Remotecore will only power up the device after all the resource table's
+requirement are met.
+
+In addition to system resources, the resource table may also contain
+resource entries that publish the existence of supported features
+or configurations by the remote processor, such as trace buffers and
+supported virtio devices (and their configurations).
+
+The resource table begins with this header:
+
+/**
+ * struct resource_table - firmware resource table header
+ * @ver: version number
+ * @num: number of resource entries
+ * @reserved: reserved (must be zero)
+ * @offset: array of offsets pointing at the various resource entries
+ *
+ * The header of the resource table, as expressed by this structure,
+ * contains a version number (should we need to change this format in the
+ * future), the number of available resource entries, and their offsets
+ * in the table.
+ */
+struct resource_table {
+ u32 ver;
+ u32 num;
+ u32 reserved[2];
+ u32 offset[0];
+} __packed;
+
+Immediately following this header are the resource entries themselves,
+each of which begins with the following resource entry header:
+
+/**
+ * struct fw_rsc_hdr - firmware resource entry header
+ * @type: resource type
+ * @data: resource data
+ *
+ * Every resource entry begins with a 'struct fw_rsc_hdr' header providing
+ * its @type. The content of the entry itself will immediately follow
+ * this header, and it should be parsed according to the resource type.
+ */
+struct fw_rsc_hdr {
+ u32 type;
+ u8 data[0];
+} __packed;
+
+Some resources entries are mere announcements, where the host is informed
+of specific remoteproc configuration. Other entries require the host to
+do something (e.g. allocate a system resource). Sometimes a negotiation
+is expected, where the firmware requests a resource, and once allocated,
+the host should provide back its details (e.g. address of an allocated
+memory region).
+
+Here are the various resource types that are currently supported:
+
+/**
+ * enum fw_resource_type - types of resource entries
+ *
+ * @RSC_CARVEOUT: request for allocation of a physically contiguous
+ * memory region.
+ * @RSC_DEVMEM: request to iommu_map a memory-based peripheral.
+ * @RSC_TRACE: announces the availability of a trace buffer into which
+ * the remote processor will be writing logs.
+ * @RSC_VDEV: declare support for a virtio device, and serve as its
+ * virtio header.
+ * @RSC_LAST: just keep this one at the end
+ *
+ * Please note that these values are used as indices to the rproc_handle_rsc
+ * lookup table, so please keep them sane. Moreover, @RSC_LAST is used to
+ * check the validity of an index before the lookup table is accessed, so
+ * please update it as needed.
+ */
+enum fw_resource_type {
+ RSC_CARVEOUT = 0,
+ RSC_DEVMEM = 1,
+ RSC_TRACE = 2,
+ RSC_VDEV = 3,
+ RSC_LAST = 4,
+};
+
+For more details regarding a specific resource type, please see its
+dedicated structure in include/linux/remoteproc.h.
+
+We also expect that platform-specific resource entries will show up
+at some point. When that happens, we could easily add a new RSC_PLATFORM
+type, and hand those resources to the platform-specific rproc driver to handle.
+
+7. Virtio and remoteproc
+
+The firmware should provide remoteproc information about virtio devices
+that it supports, and their configurations: a RSC_VDEV resource entry
+should specify the virtio device id (as in virtio_ids.h), virtio features,
+virtio config space, vrings information, etc.
+
+When a new remote processor is registered, the remoteproc framework
+will look for its resource table and will register the virtio devices
+it supports. A firmware may support any number of virtio devices, and
+of any type (a single remote processor can also easily support several
+rpmsg virtio devices this way, if desired).
+
+Of course, RSC_VDEV resource entries are only good enough for static
+allocation of virtio devices. Dynamic allocations will also be made possible
+using the rpmsg bus (similar to how we already do dynamic allocations of
+rpmsg channels; read more about it in rpmsg.txt).
diff --git a/Documentation/rpmsg.txt b/Documentation/rpmsg.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..409d9f964c5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/rpmsg.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,293 @@
+Remote Processor Messaging (rpmsg) Framework
+
+Note: this document describes the rpmsg bus and how to write rpmsg drivers.
+To learn how to add rpmsg support for new platforms, check out remoteproc.txt
+(also a resident of Documentation/).
+
+1. Introduction
+
+Modern SoCs typically employ heterogeneous remote processor devices in
+asymmetric multiprocessing (AMP) configurations, which may be running
+different instances of operating system, whether it's Linux or any other
+flavor of real-time OS.
+
+OMAP4, for example, has dual Cortex-A9, dual Cortex-M3 and a C64x+ DSP.
+Typically, the dual cortex-A9 is running Linux in a SMP configuration,
+and each of the other three cores (two M3 cores and a DSP) is running
+its own instance of RTOS in an AMP configuration.
+
+Typically AMP remote processors employ dedicated DSP codecs and multimedia
+hardware accelerators, and therefore are often used to offload CPU-intensive
+multimedia tasks from the main application processor.
+
+These remote processors could also be used to control latency-sensitive
+sensors, drive random hardware blocks, or just perform background tasks
+while the main CPU is idling.
+
+Users of those remote processors can either be userland apps (e.g. multimedia
+frameworks talking with remote OMX components) or kernel drivers (controlling
+hardware accessible only by the remote processor, reserving kernel-controlled
+resources on behalf of the remote processor, etc..).
+
+Rpmsg is a virtio-based messaging bus that allows kernel drivers to communicate
+with remote processors available on the system. In turn, drivers could then
+expose appropriate user space interfaces, if needed.
+
+When writing a driver that exposes rpmsg communication to userland, please
+keep in mind that remote processors might have direct access to the
+system's physical memory and other sensitive hardware resources (e.g. on
+OMAP4, remote cores and hardware accelerators may have direct access to the
+physical memory, gpio banks, dma controllers, i2c bus, gptimers, mailbox
+devices, hwspinlocks, etc..). Moreover, those remote processors might be
+running RTOS where every task can access the entire memory/devices exposed
+to the processor. To minimize the risks of rogue (or buggy) userland code
+exploiting remote bugs, and by that taking over the system, it is often
+desired to limit userland to specific rpmsg channels (see definition below)
+it can send messages on, and if possible, minimize how much control
+it has over the content of the messages.
+
+Every rpmsg device is a communication channel with a remote processor (thus
+rpmsg devices are called channels). Channels are identified by a textual name
+and have a local ("source") rpmsg address, and remote ("destination") rpmsg
+address.
+
+When a driver starts listening on a channel, its rx callback is bound with
+a unique rpmsg local address (a 32-bit integer). This way when inbound messages
+arrive, the rpmsg core dispatches them to the appropriate driver according
+to their destination address (this is done by invoking the driver's rx handler
+with the payload of the inbound message).
+
+
+2. User API
+
+ int rpmsg_send(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev, void *data, int len);
+ - sends a message across to the remote processor on a given channel.
+ The caller should specify the channel, the data it wants to send,
+ and its length (in bytes). The message will be sent on the specified
+ channel, i.e. its source and destination address fields will be
+ set to the channel's src and dst addresses.
+
+ In case there are no TX buffers available, the function will block until
+ one becomes available (i.e. until the remote processor consumes
+ a tx buffer and puts it back on virtio's used descriptor ring),
+ or a timeout of 15 seconds elapses. When the latter happens,
+ -ERESTARTSYS is returned.
+ The function can only be called from a process context (for now).
+ Returns 0 on success and an appropriate error value on failure.
+
+ int rpmsg_sendto(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev, void *data, int len, u32 dst);
+ - sends a message across to the remote processor on a given channel,
+ to a destination address provided by the caller.
+ The caller should specify the channel, the data it wants to send,
+ its length (in bytes), and an explicit destination address.
+ The message will then be sent to the remote processor to which the
+ channel belongs, using the channel's src address, and the user-provided
+ dst address (thus the channel's dst address will be ignored).
+
+ In case there are no TX buffers available, the function will block until
+ one becomes available (i.e. until the remote processor consumes
+ a tx buffer and puts it back on virtio's used descriptor ring),
+ or a timeout of 15 seconds elapses. When the latter happens,
+ -ERESTARTSYS is returned.
+ The function can only be called from a process context (for now).
+ Returns 0 on success and an appropriate error value on failure.
+
+ int rpmsg_send_offchannel(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev, u32 src, u32 dst,
+ void *data, int len);
+ - sends a message across to the remote processor, using the src and dst
+ addresses provided by the user.
+ The caller should specify the channel, the data it wants to send,
+ its length (in bytes), and explicit source and destination addresses.
+ The message will then be sent to the remote processor to which the
+ channel belongs, but the channel's src and dst addresses will be
+ ignored (and the user-provided addresses will be used instead).
+
+ In case there are no TX buffers available, the function will block until
+ one becomes available (i.e. until the remote processor consumes
+ a tx buffer and puts it back on virtio's used descriptor ring),
+ or a timeout of 15 seconds elapses. When the latter happens,
+ -ERESTARTSYS is returned.
+ The function can only be called from a process context (for now).
+ Returns 0 on success and an appropriate error value on failure.
+
+ int rpmsg_trysend(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev, void *data, int len);
+ - sends a message across to the remote processor on a given channel.
+ The caller should specify the channel, the data it wants to send,
+ and its length (in bytes). The message will be sent on the specified
+ channel, i.e. its source and destination address fields will be
+ set to the channel's src and dst addresses.
+
+ In case there are no TX buffers available, the function will immediately
+ return -ENOMEM without waiting until one becomes available.
+ The function can only be called from a process context (for now).
+ Returns 0 on success and an appropriate error value on failure.
+
+ int rpmsg_trysendto(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev, void *data, int len, u32 dst)
+ - sends a message across to the remote processor on a given channel,
+ to a destination address provided by the user.
+ The user should specify the channel, the data it wants to send,
+ its length (in bytes), and an explicit destination address.
+ The message will then be sent to the remote processor to which the
+ channel belongs, using the channel's src address, and the user-provided
+ dst address (thus the channel's dst address will be ignored).
+
+ In case there are no TX buffers available, the function will immediately
+ return -ENOMEM without waiting until one becomes available.
+ The function can only be called from a process context (for now).
+ Returns 0 on success and an appropriate error value on failure.
+
+ int rpmsg_trysend_offchannel(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev, u32 src, u32 dst,
+ void *data, int len);
+ - sends a message across to the remote processor, using source and
+ destination addresses provided by the user.
+ The user should specify the channel, the data it wants to send,
+ its length (in bytes), and explicit source and destination addresses.
+ The message will then be sent to the remote processor to which the
+ channel belongs, but the channel's src and dst addresses will be
+ ignored (and the user-provided addresses will be used instead).
+
+ In case there are no TX buffers available, the function will immediately
+ return -ENOMEM without waiting until one becomes available.
+ The function can only be called from a process context (for now).
+ Returns 0 on success and an appropriate error value on failure.
+
+ struct rpmsg_endpoint *rpmsg_create_ept(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev,
+ void (*cb)(struct rpmsg_channel *, void *, int, void *, u32),
+ void *priv, u32 addr);
+ - every rpmsg address in the system is bound to an rx callback (so when
+ inbound messages arrive, they are dispatched by the rpmsg bus using the
+ appropriate callback handler) by means of an rpmsg_endpoint struct.
+
+ This function allows drivers to create such an endpoint, and by that,
+ bind a callback, and possibly some private data too, to an rpmsg address
+ (either one that is known in advance, or one that will be dynamically
+ assigned for them).
+
+ Simple rpmsg drivers need not call rpmsg_create_ept, because an endpoint
+ is already created for them when they are probed by the rpmsg bus
+ (using the rx callback they provide when they registered to the rpmsg bus).
+
+ So things should just work for simple drivers: they already have an
+ endpoint, their rx callback is bound to their rpmsg address, and when
+ relevant inbound messages arrive (i.e. messages which their dst address
+ equals to the src address of their rpmsg channel), the driver's handler
+ is invoked to process it.
+
+ That said, more complicated drivers might do need to allocate
+ additional rpmsg addresses, and bind them to different rx callbacks.
+ To accomplish that, those drivers need to call this function.
+ Drivers should provide their channel (so the new endpoint would bind
+ to the same remote processor their channel belongs to), an rx callback
+ function, an optional private data (which is provided back when the
+ rx callback is invoked), and an address they want to bind with the
+ callback. If addr is RPMSG_ADDR_ANY, then rpmsg_create_ept will
+ dynamically assign them an available rpmsg address (drivers should have
+ a very good reason why not to always use RPMSG_ADDR_ANY here).
+
+ Returns a pointer to the endpoint on success, or NULL on error.
+
+ void rpmsg_destroy_ept(struct rpmsg_endpoint *ept);
+ - destroys an existing rpmsg endpoint. user should provide a pointer
+ to an rpmsg endpoint that was previously created with rpmsg_create_ept().
+
+ int register_rpmsg_driver(struct rpmsg_driver *rpdrv);
+ - registers an rpmsg driver with the rpmsg bus. user should provide
+ a pointer to an rpmsg_driver struct, which contains the driver's
+ ->probe() and ->remove() functions, an rx callback, and an id_table
+ specifying the names of the channels this driver is interested to
+ be probed with.
+
+ void unregister_rpmsg_driver(struct rpmsg_driver *rpdrv);
+ - unregisters an rpmsg driver from the rpmsg bus. user should provide
+ a pointer to a previously-registered rpmsg_driver struct.
+ Returns 0 on success, and an appropriate error value on failure.
+
+
+3. Typical usage
+
+The following is a simple rpmsg driver, that sends an "hello!" message
+on probe(), and whenever it receives an incoming message, it dumps its
+content to the console.
+
+#include <linux/kernel.h>
+#include <linux/module.h>
+#include <linux/rpmsg.h>
+
+static void rpmsg_sample_cb(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev, void *data, int len,
+ void *priv, u32 src)
+{
+ print_hex_dump(KERN_INFO, "incoming message:", DUMP_PREFIX_NONE,
+ 16, 1, data, len, true);
+}
+
+static int rpmsg_sample_probe(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev)
+{
+ int err;
+
+ dev_info(&rpdev->dev, "chnl: 0x%x -> 0x%x\n", rpdev->src, rpdev->dst);
+
+ /* send a message on our channel */
+ err = rpmsg_send(rpdev, "hello!", 6);
+ if (err) {
+ pr_err("rpmsg_send failed: %d\n", err);
+ return err;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static void __devexit rpmsg_sample_remove(struct rpmsg_channel *rpdev)
+{
+ dev_info(&rpdev->dev, "rpmsg sample client driver is removed\n");
+}
+
+static struct rpmsg_device_id rpmsg_driver_sample_id_table[] = {
+ { .name = "rpmsg-client-sample" },
+ { },
+};
+MODULE_DEVICE_TABLE(rpmsg, rpmsg_driver_sample_id_table);
+
+static struct rpmsg_driver rpmsg_sample_client = {
+ .drv.name = KBUILD_MODNAME,
+ .drv.owner = THIS_MODULE,
+ .id_table = rpmsg_driver_sample_id_table,
+ .probe = rpmsg_sample_probe,
+ .callback = rpmsg_sample_cb,
+ .remove = __devexit_p(rpmsg_sample_remove),
+};
+
+static int __init init(void)
+{
+ return register_rpmsg_driver(&rpmsg_sample_client);
+}
+module_init(init);
+
+static void __exit fini(void)
+{
+ unregister_rpmsg_driver(&rpmsg_sample_client);
+}
+module_exit(fini);
+
+Note: a similar sample which can be built and loaded can be found
+in samples/rpmsg/.
+
+4. Allocations of rpmsg channels:
+
+At this point we only support dynamic allocations of rpmsg channels.
+
+This is possible only with remote processors that have the VIRTIO_RPMSG_F_NS
+virtio device feature set. This feature bit means that the remote
+processor supports dynamic name service announcement messages.
+
+When this feature is enabled, creation of rpmsg devices (i.e. channels)
+is completely dynamic: the remote processor announces the existence of a
+remote rpmsg service by sending a name service message (which contains
+the name and rpmsg addr of the remote service, see struct rpmsg_ns_msg).
+
+This message is then handled by the rpmsg bus, which in turn dynamically
+creates and registers an rpmsg channel (which represents the remote service).
+If/when a relevant rpmsg driver is registered, it will be immediately probed
+by the bus, and can then start sending messages to the remote service.
+
+The plan is also to add static creation of rpmsg channels via the virtio
+config space, but it's not implemented yet.
diff --git a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-stats.txt b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-stats.txt
index 1cd5d51bc76..8259b34a66a 100644
--- a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-stats.txt
+++ b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-stats.txt
@@ -38,7 +38,8 @@ First field is a sched_yield() statistic:
1) # of times sched_yield() was called
Next three are schedule() statistics:
- 2) # of times we switched to the expired queue and reused it
+ 2) This field is a legacy array expiration count field used in the O(1)
+ scheduler. We kept it for ABI compatibility, but it is always set to zero.
3) # of times schedule() was called
4) # of times schedule() left the processor idle
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.lpfc b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.lpfc
index c56ec99d7b2..2f6d595f95e 100644
--- a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.lpfc
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.lpfc
@@ -1718,7 +1718,7 @@ Changes from 20040319 to 20040326
* lpfc_els_timeout_handler() now uses system timer.
* Further cleanup of #ifdef powerpc
* lpfc_scsi_timeout_handler() now uses system timer.
- * Replace common driver's own defines for endianess w/ Linux's
+ * Replace common driver's own defines for endianness w/ Linux's
__BIG_ENDIAN etc.
* Added #ifdef IPFC for all IPFC specific code.
* lpfc_disc_retry_rptlun() now uses system timer.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid_sas b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid_sas
index 57566bacb4c..83f8ea8b79e 100644
--- a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid_sas
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid_sas
@@ -510,7 +510,7 @@ i. Support for 1078 type (ppc IOP) controller, device id : 0x60 added.
3 Older Version : 00.00.02.02
i. Register 16 byte CDB capability with scsi midlayer
- "Ths patch properly registers the 16 byte command length capability of the
+ "This patch properly registers the 16 byte command length capability of the
megaraid_sas controlled hardware with the scsi midlayer. All megaraid_sas
hardware supports 16 byte CDB's."
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.qla2xxx b/Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.qla2xxx
index 19e7cd4bba6..ce0fdf349a8 100644
--- a/Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.qla2xxx
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.qla2xxx
@@ -1,48 +1,11 @@
Copyright (c) 2003-2011 QLogic Corporation
-QLogic Linux/ESX Fibre Channel HBA Driver
+QLogic Linux FC-FCoE Driver
-This program includes a device driver for Linux 2.6/ESX that may be
-distributed with QLogic hardware specific firmware binary file.
+This program includes a device driver for Linux 3.x.
You may modify and redistribute the device driver code under the
GNU General Public License (a copy of which is attached hereto as
Exhibit A) published by the Free Software Foundation (version 2).
-You may redistribute the hardware specific firmware binary file
-under the following terms:
-
- 1. Redistribution of source code (only if applicable),
- must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
- conditions and the following disclaimer.
-
- 2. Redistribution in binary form must reproduce the above
- copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
- following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
- materials provided with the distribution.
-
- 3. The name of QLogic Corporation may not be used to
- endorse or promote products derived from this software
- without specific prior written permission
-
-REGARDLESS OF WHAT LICENSING MECHANISM IS USED OR APPLICABLE,
-THIS PROGRAM IS PROVIDED BY QLOGIC CORPORATION "AS IS'' AND ANY
-EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
-IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
-PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR
-BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
-EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
-TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
-DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
-ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
-OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
-OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
-POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
-
-USER ACKNOWLEDGES AND AGREES THAT USE OF THIS PROGRAM WILL NOT
-CREATE OR GIVE GROUNDS FOR A LICENSE BY IMPLICATION, ESTOPPEL, OR
-OTHERWISE IN ANY INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS (PATENT, COPYRIGHT,
-TRADE SECRET, MASK WORK, OR OTHER PROPRIETARY RIGHT) EMBODIED IN
-ANY OTHER QLOGIC HARDWARE OR SOFTWARE EITHER SOLELY OR IN
-COMBINATION WITH THIS PROGRAM.
EXHIBIT A
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/bfa.txt b/Documentation/scsi/bfa.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..f2d6e9d1791
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/bfa.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+Linux driver for Brocade FC/FCOE adapters
+
+
+Supported Hardware
+------------------
+
+bfa 3.0.2.2 driver supports all Brocade FC/FCOE adapters. Below is a list of
+adapter models with corresponding PCIIDs.
+
+ PCIID Model
+
+ 1657:0013:1657:0014 425 4Gbps dual port FC HBA
+ 1657:0013:1657:0014 825 8Gbps PCIe dual port FC HBA
+ 1657:0013:103c:1742 HP 82B 8Gbps PCIedual port FC HBA
+ 1657:0013:103c:1744 HP 42B 4Gbps dual port FC HBA
+ 1657:0017:1657:0014 415 4Gbps single port FC HBA
+ 1657:0017:1657:0014 815 8Gbps single port FC HBA
+ 1657:0017:103c:1741 HP 41B 4Gbps single port FC HBA
+ 1657:0017:103c 1743 HP 81B 8Gbps single port FC HBA
+ 1657:0021:103c:1779 804 8Gbps FC HBA for HP Bladesystem c-class
+
+ 1657:0014:1657:0014 1010 10Gbps single port CNA - FCOE
+ 1657:0014:1657:0014 1020 10Gbps dual port CNA - FCOE
+ 1657:0014:1657:0014 1007 10Gbps dual port CNA - FCOE
+ 1657:0014:1657:0014 1741 10Gbps dual port CNA - FCOE
+
+ 1657:0022:1657:0024 1860 16Gbps FC HBA
+ 1657:0022:1657:0022 1860 10Gbps CNA - FCOE
+
+
+Firmware download
+-----------------
+
+The latest Firmware package for 3.0.2.2 bfa driver can be found at:
+
+http://www.brocade.com/services-support/drivers-downloads/adapters/Linux.page
+
+and then click following respective util package link:
+
+ Version Link
+
+ v3.0.0.0 Linux Adapter Firmware package for RHEL 6.2, SLES 11SP2
+
+
+Configuration & Management utility download
+-------------------------------------------
+
+The latest driver configuration & management utility for 3.0.2.2 bfa driver can
+be found at:
+
+http://www.brocade.com/services-support/drivers-downloads/adapters/Linux.page
+
+and then click following respective util pacakge link
+
+ Version Link
+
+ v3.0.2.0 Linux Adapter Firmware package for RHEL 6.2, SLES 11SP2
+
+
+Documentation
+-------------
+
+The latest Administration's Guide, Installation and Reference Manual,
+Troubleshooting Guide, and Release Notes for the corresponding out-of-box
+driver can be found at:
+
+http://www.brocade.com/services-support/drivers-downloads/adapters/Linux.page
+
+and use the following inbox and out-of-box driver version mapping to find
+the corresponding documentation:
+
+ Inbox Version Out-of-box Version
+
+ v3.0.2.2 v3.0.0.0
+
+
+Support
+-------
+
+For general product and support info, go to the Brocade website at:
+
+http://www.brocade.com/services-support/index.page
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/libsas.txt b/Documentation/scsi/libsas.txt
index aa54f54c4a5..3cc9c7843e1 100644
--- a/Documentation/scsi/libsas.txt
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/libsas.txt
@@ -398,21 +398,6 @@ struct sas_task {
task_done -- callback when the task has finished execution
};
-When an external entity, entity other than the LLDD or the
-SAS Layer, wants to work with a struct domain_device, it
-_must_ call kobject_get() when getting a handle on the
-device and kobject_put() when it is done with the device.
-
-This does two things:
- A) implements proper kfree() for the device;
- B) increments/decrements the kref for all players:
- domain_device
- all domain_device's ... (if past an expander)
- port
- host adapter
- pci device
- and up the ladder, etc.
-
DISCOVERY
---------
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt b/Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt
index 0a22ab8ea0c..51be20a6a14 100644
--- a/Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt
@@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ There are two packages of sg utilities:
and earlier
Both packages will work in the lk 2.4 series however sg3_utils offers more
capabilities. They can be found at: http://sg.danny.cz/sg/sg3_utils.html and
-freshmeat.net
+freecode.com
Another approach is to look at the applications that use the sg driver.
These include cdrecord, cdparanoia, SANE and cdrdao.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt b/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt
index 61c0531e044..3303d218b32 100644
--- a/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt
@@ -102,7 +102,7 @@ So take at least the following measures:
ftp://student.physik.uni-dortmund.de/pub/linux/kernel/bootdisk.gz
One more warning: I used to overclock my PCI bus to 41.67 MHz. My Tekram
-DC390F (Sym53c875) accepted this as well as my Millenium. But the Am53C974
+DC390F (Sym53c875) accepted this as well as my Millennium. But the Am53C974
produced errors and started to corrupt my disks. So don't do that! A 37.50
MHz PCI bus works for me, though, but I don't recommend using higher clocks
than the 33.33 MHz being in the PCI spec.
diff --git a/Documentation/security/00-INDEX b/Documentation/security/00-INDEX
index 99b85d39751..eeed1de546d 100644
--- a/Documentation/security/00-INDEX
+++ b/Documentation/security/00-INDEX
@@ -6,6 +6,8 @@ SELinux.txt
- how to get started with the SELinux security enhancement.
Smack.txt
- documentation on the Smack Linux Security Module.
+Yama.txt
+ - documentation on the Yama Linux Security Module.
apparmor.txt
- documentation on the AppArmor security extension.
credentials.txt
diff --git a/Documentation/security/Smack.txt b/Documentation/security/Smack.txt
index e9dab41c0fe..d2f72ae6643 100644
--- a/Documentation/security/Smack.txt
+++ b/Documentation/security/Smack.txt
@@ -536,6 +536,6 @@ writing a single character to the /smack/logging file :
3 : log denied & accepted
Events are logged as 'key=value' pairs, for each event you at least will get
-the subjet, the object, the rights requested, the action, the kernel function
+the subject, the object, the rights requested, the action, the kernel function
that triggered the event, plus other pairs depending on the type of event
audited.
diff --git a/Documentation/security/Yama.txt b/Documentation/security/Yama.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..a9511f17906
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/security/Yama.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,65 @@
+Yama is a Linux Security Module that collects a number of system-wide DAC
+security protections that are not handled by the core kernel itself. To
+select it at boot time, specify "security=yama" (though this will disable
+any other LSM).
+
+Yama is controlled through sysctl in /proc/sys/kernel/yama:
+
+- ptrace_scope
+
+==============================================================
+
+ptrace_scope:
+
+As Linux grows in popularity, it will become a larger target for
+malware. One particularly troubling weakness of the Linux process
+interfaces is that a single user is able to examine the memory and
+running state of any of their processes. For example, if one application
+(e.g. Pidgin) was compromised, it would be possible for an attacker to
+attach to other running processes (e.g. Firefox, SSH sessions, GPG agent,
+etc) to extract additional credentials and continue to expand the scope
+of their attack without resorting to user-assisted phishing.
+
+This is not a theoretical problem. SSH session hijacking
+(http://www.storm.net.nz/projects/7) and arbitrary code injection
+(http://c-skills.blogspot.com/2007/05/injectso.html) attacks already
+exist and remain possible if ptrace is allowed to operate as before.
+Since ptrace is not commonly used by non-developers and non-admins, system
+builders should be allowed the option to disable this debugging system.
+
+For a solution, some applications use prctl(PR_SET_DUMPABLE, ...) to
+specifically disallow such ptrace attachment (e.g. ssh-agent), but many
+do not. A more general solution is to only allow ptrace directly from a
+parent to a child process (i.e. direct "gdb EXE" and "strace EXE" still
+work), or with CAP_SYS_PTRACE (i.e. "gdb --pid=PID", and "strace -p PID"
+still work as root).
+
+For software that has defined application-specific relationships
+between a debugging process and its inferior (crash handlers, etc),
+prctl(PR_SET_PTRACER, pid, ...) can be used. An inferior can declare which
+other process (and its descendents) are allowed to call PTRACE_ATTACH
+against it. Only one such declared debugging process can exists for
+each inferior at a time. For example, this is used by KDE, Chromium, and
+Firefox's crash handlers, and by Wine for allowing only Wine processes
+to ptrace each other. If a process wishes to entirely disable these ptrace
+restrictions, it can call prctl(PR_SET_PTRACER, PR_SET_PTRACER_ANY, ...)
+so that any otherwise allowed process (even those in external pid namespaces)
+may attach.
+
+The sysctl settings are:
+
+0 - classic ptrace permissions: a process can PTRACE_ATTACH to any other
+ process running under the same uid, as long as it is dumpable (i.e.
+ did not transition uids, start privileged, or have called
+ prctl(PR_SET_DUMPABLE...) already).
+
+1 - restricted ptrace: a process must have a predefined relationship
+ with the inferior it wants to call PTRACE_ATTACH on. By default,
+ this relationship is that of only its descendants when the above
+ classic criteria is also met. To change the relationship, an
+ inferior can call prctl(PR_SET_PTRACER, debugger, ...) to declare
+ an allowed debugger PID to call PTRACE_ATTACH on the inferior.
+
+The original children-only logic was based on the restrictions in grsecurity.
+
+==============================================================
diff --git a/Documentation/security/keys-trusted-encrypted.txt b/Documentation/security/keys-trusted-encrypted.txt
index c9e4855ed3d..e105ae97a4f 100644
--- a/Documentation/security/keys-trusted-encrypted.txt
+++ b/Documentation/security/keys-trusted-encrypted.txt
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
Trusted and Encrypted Keys
Trusted and Encrypted Keys are two new key types added to the existing kernel
-key ring service. Both of these new types are variable length symmetic keys,
+key ring service. Both of these new types are variable length symmetric keys,
and in both cases all keys are created in the kernel, and user space sees,
stores, and loads only encrypted blobs. Trusted Keys require the availability
of a Trusted Platform Module (TPM) chip for greater security, while Encrypted
diff --git a/Documentation/security/keys.txt b/Documentation/security/keys.txt
index 4d75931d2d7..78771709142 100644
--- a/Documentation/security/keys.txt
+++ b/Documentation/security/keys.txt
@@ -554,6 +554,10 @@ The keyctl syscall functions are:
process must have write permission on the keyring, and it must be a
keyring (or else error ENOTDIR will result).
+ This function can also be used to clear special kernel keyrings if they
+ are appropriately marked if the user has CAP_SYS_ADMIN capability. The
+ DNS resolver cache keyring is an example of this.
+
(*) Link a key into a keyring:
@@ -668,7 +672,7 @@ The keyctl syscall functions are:
If the kernel calls back to userspace to complete the instantiation of a
key, userspace should use this call mark the key as negative before the
- invoked process returns if it is unable to fulfil the request.
+ invoked process returns if it is unable to fulfill the request.
The process must have write access on the key to be able to instantiate
it, and the key must be uninstantiated.
diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt
index 936699e4f04..6f75ba3b8a3 100644
--- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt
+++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt
@@ -860,7 +860,8 @@ Prior to version 0.9.0rc4 options had a 'snd_' prefix. This was removed.
[Multiple options for each card instance]
model - force the model name
- position_fix - Fix DMA pointer (0 = auto, 1 = use LPIB, 2 = POSBUF)
+ position_fix - Fix DMA pointer (0 = auto, 1 = use LPIB, 2 = POSBUF,
+ 3 = VIACOMBO, 4 = COMBO)
probe_mask - Bitmask to probe codecs (default = -1, meaning all slots)
When the bit 8 (0x100) is set, the lower 8 bits are used
as the "fixed" codec slots; i.e. the driver probes the
@@ -925,6 +926,11 @@ Prior to version 0.9.0rc4 options had a 'snd_' prefix. This was removed.
(Usually SD_LPIB register is more accurate than the
position buffer.)
+ position_fix=3 is specific to VIA devices. The position
+ of the capture stream is checked from both LPIB and POSBUF
+ values. position_fix=4 is a combination mode, using LPIB
+ for playback and POSBUF for capture.
+
NB: If you get many "azx_get_response timeout" messages at
loading, it's likely a problem of interrupts (e.g. ACPI irq
routing). Try to boot with options like "pci=noacpi". Also, you
@@ -1588,7 +1594,7 @@ Prior to version 0.9.0rc4 options had a 'snd_' prefix. This was removed.
Module supports autoprobe a chip.
- Note: the driver may have problems regarding endianess.
+ Note: the driver may have problems regarding endianness.
The power-management is supported.
diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio-Models.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio-Models.txt
index c8c54544abc..d97d992ced1 100644
--- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio-Models.txt
+++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio-Models.txt
@@ -8,37 +8,10 @@ ALC880
5stack-digout 5-jack in back, 2-jack in front, a SPDIF out
6stack 6-jack in back, 2-jack in front
6stack-digout 6-jack with a SPDIF out
- w810 3-jack
- z71v 3-jack (HP shared SPDIF)
- asus 3-jack (ASUS Mobo)
- asus-w1v ASUS W1V
- asus-dig ASUS with SPDIF out
- asus-dig2 ASUS with SPDIF out (using GPIO2)
- uniwill 3-jack
- fujitsu Fujitsu Laptops (Pi1536)
- F1734 2-jack
- lg LG laptop (m1 express dual)
- lg-lw LG LW20/LW25 laptop
- tcl TCL S700
- clevo Clevo laptops (m520G, m665n)
- medion Medion Rim 2150
- test for testing/debugging purpose, almost all controls can be
- adjusted. Appearing only when compiled with
- $CONFIG_SND_DEBUG=y
- auto auto-config reading BIOS (default)
ALC260
======
- fujitsu Fujitsu S7020
- acer Acer TravelMate
- will Will laptops (PB V7900)
- replacer Replacer 672V
- favorit100 Maxdata Favorit 100XS
- basic fixed pin assignment (old default model)
- test for testing/debugging purpose, almost all controls can
- adjusted. Appearing only when compiled with
- $CONFIG_SND_DEBUG=y
- auto auto-config reading BIOS (default)
+ N/A
ALC262
======
@@ -70,55 +43,7 @@ ALC680
ALC882/883/885/888/889
======================
- 3stack-dig 3-jack with SPDIF I/O
- 6stack-dig 6-jack digital with SPDIF I/O
- arima Arima W820Di1
- targa Targa T8, MSI-1049 T8
- asus-a7j ASUS A7J
- asus-a7m ASUS A7M
- macpro MacPro support
- mb5 Macbook 5,1
- macmini3 Macmini 3,1
- mba21 Macbook Air 2,1
- mbp3 Macbook Pro rev3
- imac24 iMac 24'' with jack detection
- imac91 iMac 9,1
- w2jc ASUS W2JC
- 3stack-2ch-dig 3-jack with SPDIF I/O (ALC883)
- alc883-6stack-dig 6-jack digital with SPDIF I/O (ALC883)
- 3stack-6ch 3-jack 6-channel
- 3stack-6ch-dig 3-jack 6-channel with SPDIF I/O
- 6stack-dig-demo 6-jack digital for Intel demo board
- acer Acer laptops (Travelmate 3012WTMi, Aspire 5600, etc)
- acer-aspire Acer Aspire 9810
- acer-aspire-4930g Acer Aspire 4930G
- acer-aspire-6530g Acer Aspire 6530G
- acer-aspire-7730g Acer Aspire 7730G
- acer-aspire-8930g Acer Aspire 8930G
- medion Medion Laptops
- targa-dig Targa/MSI
- targa-2ch-dig Targa/MSI with 2-channel
- targa-8ch-dig Targa/MSI with 8-channel (MSI GX620)
- laptop-eapd 3-jack with SPDIF I/O and EAPD (Clevo M540JE, M550JE)
- lenovo-101e Lenovo 101E
- lenovo-nb0763 Lenovo NB0763
- lenovo-ms7195-dig Lenovo MS7195
- lenovo-sky Lenovo Sky
- haier-w66 Haier W66
- 3stack-hp HP machines with 3stack (Lucknow, Samba boards)
- 6stack-dell Dell machines with 6stack (Inspiron 530)
- mitac Mitac 8252D
- clevo-m540r Clevo M540R (6ch + digital)
- clevo-m720 Clevo M720 laptop series
- fujitsu-pi2515 Fujitsu AMILO Pi2515
- fujitsu-xa3530 Fujitsu AMILO XA3530
- 3stack-6ch-intel Intel DG33* boards
- intel-alc889a Intel IbexPeak with ALC889A
- intel-x58 Intel DX58 with ALC889
- asus-p5q ASUS P5Q-EM boards
- mb31 MacBook 3,1
- sony-vaio-tt Sony VAIO TT
- auto auto-config reading BIOS (default)
+ N/A
ALC861/660
==========
diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio.txt
index 91fee3b45fb..7813c06a5c7 100644
--- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio.txt
+++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/HD-Audio.txt
@@ -59,7 +59,12 @@ a case, you can change the default method via `position_fix` option.
`position_fix=1` means to use LPIB method explicitly.
`position_fix=2` means to use the position-buffer.
`position_fix=3` means to use a combination of both methods, needed
-for some VIA and ATI controllers. 0 is the default value for all other
+for some VIA controllers. The capture stream position is corrected
+by comparing both LPIB and position-buffer values.
+`position_fix=4` is another combination available for all controllers,
+and uses LPIB for the playback and the position-buffer for the capture
+streams.
+0 is the default value for all other
controllers, the automatic check and fallback to LPIB as described in
the above. If you get a problem of repeated sounds, this option might
help.
diff --git a/Documentation/spi/spi-summary b/Documentation/spi/spi-summary
index 4884cb33845..7312ec14dd8 100644
--- a/Documentation/spi/spi-summary
+++ b/Documentation/spi/spi-summary
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
Overview of Linux kernel SPI support
====================================
-21-May-2007
+02-Feb-2012
What is SPI?
------------
@@ -483,9 +483,9 @@ also initialize its own internal state. (See below about bus numbering
and those methods.)
After you initialize the spi_master, then use spi_register_master() to
-publish it to the rest of the system. At that time, device nodes for
-the controller and any predeclared spi devices will be made available,
-and the driver model core will take care of binding them to drivers.
+publish it to the rest of the system. At that time, device nodes for the
+controller and any predeclared spi devices will be made available, and
+the driver model core will take care of binding them to drivers.
If you need to remove your SPI controller driver, spi_unregister_master()
will reverse the effect of spi_register_master().
@@ -521,21 +521,53 @@ SPI MASTER METHODS
** When you code setup(), ASSUME that the controller
** is actively processing transfers for another device.
- master->transfer(struct spi_device *spi, struct spi_message *message)
- This must not sleep. Its responsibility is arrange that the
- transfer happens and its complete() callback is issued. The two
- will normally happen later, after other transfers complete, and
- if the controller is idle it will need to be kickstarted.
-
master->cleanup(struct spi_device *spi)
Your controller driver may use spi_device.controller_state to hold
state it dynamically associates with that device. If you do that,
be sure to provide the cleanup() method to free that state.
+ master->prepare_transfer_hardware(struct spi_master *master)
+ This will be called by the queue mechanism to signal to the driver
+ that a message is coming in soon, so the subsystem requests the
+ driver to prepare the transfer hardware by issuing this call.
+ This may sleep.
+
+ master->unprepare_transfer_hardware(struct spi_master *master)
+ This will be called by the queue mechanism to signal to the driver
+ that there are no more messages pending in the queue and it may
+ relax the hardware (e.g. by power management calls). This may sleep.
+
+ master->transfer_one_message(struct spi_master *master,
+ struct spi_message *mesg)
+ The subsystem calls the driver to transfer a single message while
+ queuing transfers that arrive in the meantime. When the driver is
+ finished with this message, it must call
+ spi_finalize_current_message() so the subsystem can issue the next
+ transfer. This may sleep.
+
+ DEPRECATED METHODS
+
+ master->transfer(struct spi_device *spi, struct spi_message *message)
+ This must not sleep. Its responsibility is arrange that the
+ transfer happens and its complete() callback is issued. The two
+ will normally happen later, after other transfers complete, and
+ if the controller is idle it will need to be kickstarted. This
+ method is not used on queued controllers and must be NULL if
+ transfer_one_message() and (un)prepare_transfer_hardware() are
+ implemented.
+
SPI MESSAGE QUEUE
-The bulk of the driver will be managing the I/O queue fed by transfer().
+If you are happy with the standard queueing mechanism provided by the
+SPI subsystem, just implement the queued methods specified above. Using
+the message queue has the upside of centralizing a lot of code and
+providing pure process-context execution of methods. The message queue
+can also be elevated to realtime priority on high-priority SPI traffic.
+
+Unless the queueing mechanism in the SPI subsystem is selected, the bulk
+of the driver will be managing the I/O queue fed by the now deprecated
+function transfer().
That queue could be purely conceptual. For example, a driver used only
for low-frequency sensor access might be fine using synchronous PIO.
@@ -561,4 +593,6 @@ Stephen Street
Mark Underwood
Andrew Victor
Vitaly Wool
-
+Grant Likely
+Mark Brown
+Linus Walleij
diff --git a/Documentation/static-keys.txt b/Documentation/static-keys.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..d93f3c00f24
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/static-keys.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,286 @@
+ Static Keys
+ -----------
+
+By: Jason Baron <jbaron@redhat.com>
+
+0) Abstract
+
+Static keys allows the inclusion of seldom used features in
+performance-sensitive fast-path kernel code, via a GCC feature and a code
+patching technique. A quick example:
+
+ struct static_key key = STATIC_KEY_INIT_FALSE;
+
+ ...
+
+ if (static_key_false(&key))
+ do unlikely code
+ else
+ do likely code
+
+ ...
+ static_key_slow_inc();
+ ...
+ static_key_slow_inc();
+ ...
+
+The static_key_false() branch will be generated into the code with as little
+impact to the likely code path as possible.
+
+
+1) Motivation
+
+
+Currently, tracepoints are implemented using a conditional branch. The
+conditional check requires checking a global variable for each tracepoint.
+Although the overhead of this check is small, it increases when the memory
+cache comes under pressure (memory cache lines for these global variables may
+be shared with other memory accesses). As we increase the number of tracepoints
+in the kernel this overhead may become more of an issue. In addition,
+tracepoints are often dormant (disabled) and provide no direct kernel
+functionality. Thus, it is highly desirable to reduce their impact as much as
+possible. Although tracepoints are the original motivation for this work, other
+kernel code paths should be able to make use of the static keys facility.
+
+
+2) Solution
+
+
+gcc (v4.5) adds a new 'asm goto' statement that allows branching to a label:
+
+http://gcc.gnu.org/ml/gcc-patches/2009-07/msg01556.html
+
+Using the 'asm goto', we can create branches that are either taken or not taken
+by default, without the need to check memory. Then, at run-time, we can patch
+the branch site to change the branch direction.
+
+For example, if we have a simple branch that is disabled by default:
+
+ if (static_key_false(&key))
+ printk("I am the true branch\n");
+
+Thus, by default the 'printk' will not be emitted. And the code generated will
+consist of a single atomic 'no-op' instruction (5 bytes on x86), in the
+straight-line code path. When the branch is 'flipped', we will patch the
+'no-op' in the straight-line codepath with a 'jump' instruction to the
+out-of-line true branch. Thus, changing branch direction is expensive but
+branch selection is basically 'free'. That is the basic tradeoff of this
+optimization.
+
+This lowlevel patching mechanism is called 'jump label patching', and it gives
+the basis for the static keys facility.
+
+3) Static key label API, usage and examples:
+
+
+In order to make use of this optimization you must first define a key:
+
+ struct static_key key;
+
+Which is initialized as:
+
+ struct static_key key = STATIC_KEY_INIT_TRUE;
+
+or:
+
+ struct static_key key = STATIC_KEY_INIT_FALSE;
+
+If the key is not initialized, it is default false. The 'struct static_key',
+must be a 'global'. That is, it can't be allocated on the stack or dynamically
+allocated at run-time.
+
+The key is then used in code as:
+
+ if (static_key_false(&key))
+ do unlikely code
+ else
+ do likely code
+
+Or:
+
+ if (static_key_true(&key))
+ do likely code
+ else
+ do unlikely code
+
+A key that is initialized via 'STATIC_KEY_INIT_FALSE', must be used in a
+'static_key_false()' construct. Likewise, a key initialized via
+'STATIC_KEY_INIT_TRUE' must be used in a 'static_key_true()' construct. A
+single key can be used in many branches, but all the branches must match the
+way that the key has been initialized.
+
+The branch(es) can then be switched via:
+
+ static_key_slow_inc(&key);
+ ...
+ static_key_slow_dec(&key);
+
+Thus, 'static_key_slow_inc()' means 'make the branch true', and
+'static_key_slow_dec()' means 'make the the branch false' with appropriate
+reference counting. For example, if the key is initialized true, a
+static_key_slow_dec(), will switch the branch to false. And a subsequent
+static_key_slow_inc(), will change the branch back to true. Likewise, if the
+key is initialized false, a 'static_key_slow_inc()', will change the branch to
+true. And then a 'static_key_slow_dec()', will again make the branch false.
+
+An example usage in the kernel is the implementation of tracepoints:
+
+ static inline void trace_##name(proto) \
+ { \
+ if (static_key_false(&__tracepoint_##name.key)) \
+ __DO_TRACE(&__tracepoint_##name, \
+ TP_PROTO(data_proto), \
+ TP_ARGS(data_args), \
+ TP_CONDITION(cond)); \
+ }
+
+Tracepoints are disabled by default, and can be placed in performance critical
+pieces of the kernel. Thus, by using a static key, the tracepoints can have
+absolutely minimal impact when not in use.
+
+
+4) Architecture level code patching interface, 'jump labels'
+
+
+There are a few functions and macros that architectures must implement in order
+to take advantage of this optimization. If there is no architecture support, we
+simply fall back to a traditional, load, test, and jump sequence.
+
+* select HAVE_ARCH_JUMP_LABEL, see: arch/x86/Kconfig
+
+* #define JUMP_LABEL_NOP_SIZE, see: arch/x86/include/asm/jump_label.h
+
+* __always_inline bool arch_static_branch(struct static_key *key), see:
+ arch/x86/include/asm/jump_label.h
+
+* void arch_jump_label_transform(struct jump_entry *entry, enum jump_label_type type),
+ see: arch/x86/kernel/jump_label.c
+
+* __init_or_module void arch_jump_label_transform_static(struct jump_entry *entry, enum jump_label_type type),
+ see: arch/x86/kernel/jump_label.c
+
+
+* struct jump_entry, see: arch/x86/include/asm/jump_label.h
+
+
+5) Static keys / jump label analysis, results (x86_64):
+
+
+As an example, let's add the following branch to 'getppid()', such that the
+system call now looks like:
+
+SYSCALL_DEFINE0(getppid)
+{
+ int pid;
+
++ if (static_key_false(&key))
++ printk("I am the true branch\n");
+
+ rcu_read_lock();
+ pid = task_tgid_vnr(rcu_dereference(current->real_parent));
+ rcu_read_unlock();
+
+ return pid;
+}
+
+The resulting instructions with jump labels generated by GCC is:
+
+ffffffff81044290 <sys_getppid>:
+ffffffff81044290: 55 push %rbp
+ffffffff81044291: 48 89 e5 mov %rsp,%rbp
+ffffffff81044294: e9 00 00 00 00 jmpq ffffffff81044299 <sys_getppid+0x9>
+ffffffff81044299: 65 48 8b 04 25 c0 b6 mov %gs:0xb6c0,%rax
+ffffffff810442a0: 00 00
+ffffffff810442a2: 48 8b 80 80 02 00 00 mov 0x280(%rax),%rax
+ffffffff810442a9: 48 8b 80 b0 02 00 00 mov 0x2b0(%rax),%rax
+ffffffff810442b0: 48 8b b8 e8 02 00 00 mov 0x2e8(%rax),%rdi
+ffffffff810442b7: e8 f4 d9 00 00 callq ffffffff81051cb0 <pid_vnr>
+ffffffff810442bc: 5d pop %rbp
+ffffffff810442bd: 48 98 cltq
+ffffffff810442bf: c3 retq
+ffffffff810442c0: 48 c7 c7 e3 54 98 81 mov $0xffffffff819854e3,%rdi
+ffffffff810442c7: 31 c0 xor %eax,%eax
+ffffffff810442c9: e8 71 13 6d 00 callq ffffffff8171563f <printk>
+ffffffff810442ce: eb c9 jmp ffffffff81044299 <sys_getppid+0x9>
+
+Without the jump label optimization it looks like:
+
+ffffffff810441f0 <sys_getppid>:
+ffffffff810441f0: 8b 05 8a 52 d8 00 mov 0xd8528a(%rip),%eax # ffffffff81dc9480 <key>
+ffffffff810441f6: 55 push %rbp
+ffffffff810441f7: 48 89 e5 mov %rsp,%rbp
+ffffffff810441fa: 85 c0 test %eax,%eax
+ffffffff810441fc: 75 27 jne ffffffff81044225 <sys_getppid+0x35>
+ffffffff810441fe: 65 48 8b 04 25 c0 b6 mov %gs:0xb6c0,%rax
+ffffffff81044205: 00 00
+ffffffff81044207: 48 8b 80 80 02 00 00 mov 0x280(%rax),%rax
+ffffffff8104420e: 48 8b 80 b0 02 00 00 mov 0x2b0(%rax),%rax
+ffffffff81044215: 48 8b b8 e8 02 00 00 mov 0x2e8(%rax),%rdi
+ffffffff8104421c: e8 2f da 00 00 callq ffffffff81051c50 <pid_vnr>
+ffffffff81044221: 5d pop %rbp
+ffffffff81044222: 48 98 cltq
+ffffffff81044224: c3 retq
+ffffffff81044225: 48 c7 c7 13 53 98 81 mov $0xffffffff81985313,%rdi
+ffffffff8104422c: 31 c0 xor %eax,%eax
+ffffffff8104422e: e8 60 0f 6d 00 callq ffffffff81715193 <printk>
+ffffffff81044233: eb c9 jmp ffffffff810441fe <sys_getppid+0xe>
+ffffffff81044235: 66 66 2e 0f 1f 84 00 data32 nopw %cs:0x0(%rax,%rax,1)
+ffffffff8104423c: 00 00 00 00
+
+Thus, the disable jump label case adds a 'mov', 'test' and 'jne' instruction
+vs. the jump label case just has a 'no-op' or 'jmp 0'. (The jmp 0, is patched
+to a 5 byte atomic no-op instruction at boot-time.) Thus, the disabled jump
+label case adds:
+
+6 (mov) + 2 (test) + 2 (jne) = 10 - 5 (5 byte jump 0) = 5 addition bytes.
+
+If we then include the padding bytes, the jump label code saves, 16 total bytes
+of instruction memory for this small fucntion. In this case the non-jump label
+function is 80 bytes long. Thus, we have have saved 20% of the instruction
+footprint. We can in fact improve this even further, since the 5-byte no-op
+really can be a 2-byte no-op since we can reach the branch with a 2-byte jmp.
+However, we have not yet implemented optimal no-op sizes (they are currently
+hard-coded).
+
+Since there are a number of static key API uses in the scheduler paths,
+'pipe-test' (also known as 'perf bench sched pipe') can be used to show the
+performance improvement. Testing done on 3.3.0-rc2:
+
+jump label disabled:
+
+ Performance counter stats for 'bash -c /tmp/pipe-test' (50 runs):
+
+ 855.700314 task-clock # 0.534 CPUs utilized ( +- 0.11% )
+ 200,003 context-switches # 0.234 M/sec ( +- 0.00% )
+ 0 CPU-migrations # 0.000 M/sec ( +- 39.58% )
+ 487 page-faults # 0.001 M/sec ( +- 0.02% )
+ 1,474,374,262 cycles # 1.723 GHz ( +- 0.17% )
+ <not supported> stalled-cycles-frontend
+ <not supported> stalled-cycles-backend
+ 1,178,049,567 instructions # 0.80 insns per cycle ( +- 0.06% )
+ 208,368,926 branches # 243.507 M/sec ( +- 0.06% )
+ 5,569,188 branch-misses # 2.67% of all branches ( +- 0.54% )
+
+ 1.601607384 seconds time elapsed ( +- 0.07% )
+
+jump label enabled:
+
+ Performance counter stats for 'bash -c /tmp/pipe-test' (50 runs):
+
+ 841.043185 task-clock # 0.533 CPUs utilized ( +- 0.12% )
+ 200,004 context-switches # 0.238 M/sec ( +- 0.00% )
+ 0 CPU-migrations # 0.000 M/sec ( +- 40.87% )
+ 487 page-faults # 0.001 M/sec ( +- 0.05% )
+ 1,432,559,428 cycles # 1.703 GHz ( +- 0.18% )
+ <not supported> stalled-cycles-frontend
+ <not supported> stalled-cycles-backend
+ 1,175,363,994 instructions # 0.82 insns per cycle ( +- 0.04% )
+ 206,859,359 branches # 245.956 M/sec ( +- 0.04% )
+ 4,884,119 branch-misses # 2.36% of all branches ( +- 0.85% )
+
+ 1.579384366 seconds time elapsed
+
+The percentage of saved branches is .7%, and we've saved 12% on
+'branch-misses'. This is where we would expect to get the most savings, since
+this optimization is about reducing the number of branches. In addition, we've
+saved .2% on instructions, and 2.8% on cycles and 1.4% on elapsed time.
diff --git a/Documentation/target/tcm_mod_builder.py b/Documentation/target/tcm_mod_builder.py
index 6e21b8b5263..a78879b01f0 100755
--- a/Documentation/target/tcm_mod_builder.py
+++ b/Documentation/target/tcm_mod_builder.py
@@ -775,7 +775,7 @@ def tcm_mod_dump_fabric_ops(proto_ident, fabric_mod_dir_var, fabric_mod_name):
buf += " struct " + fabric_mod_name + "_nacl *nacl;\n\n"
buf += " nacl = kzalloc(sizeof(struct " + fabric_mod_name + "_nacl), GFP_KERNEL);\n"
buf += " if (!nacl) {\n"
- buf += " printk(KERN_ERR \"Unable to alocate struct " + fabric_mod_name + "_nacl\\n\");\n"
+ buf += " printk(KERN_ERR \"Unable to allocate struct " + fabric_mod_name + "_nacl\\n\");\n"
buf += " return NULL;\n"
buf += " }\n\n"
buf += " return &nacl->se_node_acl;\n"
diff --git a/Documentation/trace/events-power.txt b/Documentation/trace/events-power.txt
index 96d87b67fe3..cf794af2285 100644
--- a/Documentation/trace/events-power.txt
+++ b/Documentation/trace/events-power.txt
@@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ power_end "cpu_id=%lu"
The 'type' parameter takes one of those macros:
. POWER_NONE = 0,
. POWER_CSTATE = 1, /* C-State */
- . POWER_PSTATE = 2, /* Fequency change or DVFS */
+ . POWER_PSTATE = 2, /* Frequency change or DVFS */
The 'state' parameter is set depending on the type:
. Target C-state for type=POWER_CSTATE,
diff --git a/Documentation/trace/ftrace.txt b/Documentation/trace/ftrace.txt
index 1ebc24cf9a5..6f51fed45f2 100644
--- a/Documentation/trace/ftrace.txt
+++ b/Documentation/trace/ftrace.txt
@@ -226,6 +226,13 @@ Here is the list of current tracers that may be configured.
Traces and records the max latency that it takes for
the highest priority task to get scheduled after
it has been woken up.
+ Traces all tasks as an average developer would expect.
+
+ "wakeup_rt"
+
+ Traces and records the max latency that it takes for just
+ RT tasks (as the current "wakeup" does). This is useful
+ for those interested in wake up timings of RT tasks.
"hw-branch-tracer"
diff --git a/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt b/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt
index 86302cd53ed..a91adb26ea7 100644
--- a/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt
+++ b/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
CHANGES
- 0.3 - Created based off of scanner & INSTALL from the original touchscreen
- driver on freshmeat (http://freshmeat.net/projects/3mtouchscreendriver)
+ driver on freecode (http://freecode.com/projects/3mtouchscreendriver)
- Amended for linux-2.4.18, then 2.4.19
- 0.5 - Complete rewrite using Linux Input in 2.6.3
diff --git a/Documentation/usb/power-management.txt b/Documentation/usb/power-management.txt
index 12511c98cc4..817df299ea0 100644
--- a/Documentation/usb/power-management.txt
+++ b/Documentation/usb/power-management.txt
@@ -345,7 +345,7 @@ autosuspend the device.
Drivers need not be concerned about balancing changes to the usage
counter; the USB core will undo any remaining "get"s when a driver
is unbound from its interface. As a corollary, drivers must not call
-any of the usb_autopm_* functions after their diconnect() routine has
+any of the usb_autopm_* functions after their disconnect() routine has
returned.
Drivers using the async routines are responsible for their own
diff --git a/Documentation/usb/proc_usb_info.txt b/Documentation/usb/proc_usb_info.txt
index afe596d5f20..c9c3f0f5ad7 100644
--- a/Documentation/usb/proc_usb_info.txt
+++ b/Documentation/usb/proc_usb_info.txt
@@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ The usbfs filesystem for USB devices is traditionally mounted at
/proc/bus/usb. It provides the /proc/bus/usb/devices file, as well as
the /proc/bus/usb/BBB/DDD files.
-In many modern systems the usbfs filsystem isn't used at all. Instead
+In many modern systems the usbfs filesystem isn't used at all. Instead
USB device nodes are created under /dev/usb/ or someplace similar. The
"devices" file is available in debugfs, typically as
/sys/kernel/debug/usb/devices.
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx23885 b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx23885
index 23584d0c6a7..f316d1816fc 100644
--- a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx23885
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx23885
@@ -32,3 +32,4 @@
31 -> Leadtek Winfast PxDVR3200 H XC4000 [107d:6f39]
32 -> MPX-885
33 -> Mygica X8507 [14f1:8502]
+ 34 -> TerraTec Cinergy T PCIe Dual [153b:117e]
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx88 b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx88
index eee18e6962b..fa4b3f94746 100644
--- a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx88
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.cx88
@@ -59,7 +59,7 @@
58 -> Pinnacle PCTV HD 800i [11bd:0051]
59 -> DViCO FusionHDTV 5 PCI nano [18ac:d530]
60 -> Pinnacle Hybrid PCTV [12ab:1788]
- 61 -> Leadtek TV2000 XP Global [107d:6f18,107d:6618]
+ 61 -> Leadtek TV2000 XP Global [107d:6f18,107d:6618,107d:6619]
62 -> PowerColor RA330 [14f1:ea3d]
63 -> Geniatech X8000-MT DVBT [14f1:8852]
64 -> DViCO FusionHDTV DVB-T PRO [18ac:db30]
@@ -87,3 +87,5 @@
86 -> TeVii S464 DVB-S/S2 [d464:9022]
87 -> Leadtek WinFast DTV2000 H PLUS [107d:6f42]
88 -> Leadtek WinFast DTV1800 H (XC4000) [107d:6f38]
+ 89 -> Leadtek TV2000 XP Global (SC4100) [107d:6f36]
+ 90 -> Leadtek TV2000 XP Global (XC4100) [107d:6f43]
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.em28xx b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.em28xx
index e7be3ac49ea..d99262dda53 100644
--- a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.em28xx
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.em28xx
@@ -7,7 +7,7 @@
6 -> Terratec Cinergy 200 USB (em2800)
7 -> Leadtek Winfast USB II (em2800) [0413:6023]
8 -> Kworld USB2800 (em2800)
- 9 -> Pinnacle Dazzle DVC 90/100/101/107 / Kaiser Baas Video to DVD maker (em2820/em2840) [1b80:e302,1b80:e304,2304:0207,2304:021a]
+ 9 -> Pinnacle Dazzle DVC 90/100/101/107 / Kaiser Baas Video to DVD maker (em2820/em2840) [1b80:e302,1b80:e304,2304:0207,2304:021a,093b:a003]
10 -> Hauppauge WinTV HVR 900 (em2880) [2040:6500]
11 -> Terratec Hybrid XS (em2880)
12 -> Kworld PVR TV 2800 RF (em2820/em2840)
@@ -61,7 +61,7 @@
61 -> Pixelview PlayTV Box 4 USB 2.0 (em2820/em2840)
62 -> Gadmei TVR200 (em2820/em2840)
63 -> Kaiomy TVnPC U2 (em2860) [eb1a:e303]
- 64 -> Easy Cap Capture DC-60 (em2860)
+ 64 -> Easy Cap Capture DC-60 (em2860) [1b80:e309]
65 -> IO-DATA GV-MVP/SZ (em2820/em2840) [04bb:0515]
66 -> Empire dual TV (em2880)
67 -> Terratec Grabby (em2860) [0ccd:0096,0ccd:10AF]
@@ -76,7 +76,11 @@
76 -> KWorld PlusTV 340U or UB435-Q (ATSC) (em2870) [1b80:a340]
77 -> EM2874 Leadership ISDBT (em2874)
78 -> PCTV nanoStick T2 290e (em28174)
- 79 -> Terratec Cinergy H5 (em2884) [0ccd:10a2,0ccd:10ad]
+ 79 -> Terratec Cinergy H5 (em2884) [0ccd:008e,0ccd:00ac,0ccd:10a2,0ccd:10ad]
80 -> PCTV DVB-S2 Stick (460e) (em28174)
81 -> Hauppauge WinTV HVR 930C (em2884) [2040:1605]
82 -> Terratec Cinergy HTC Stick (em2884) [0ccd:00b2]
+ 83 -> Honestech Vidbox NW03 (em2860) [eb1a:5006]
+ 84 -> MaxMedia UB425-TC (em2874) [1b80:e425]
+ 85 -> PCTV QuatroStick (510e) (em2884) [2304:0242]
+ 86 -> PCTV QuatroStick nano (520e) (em2884) [2013:0251]
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.saa7134 b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.saa7134
index e7ef38a1985..34f3b330e5f 100644
--- a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.saa7134
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.saa7134
@@ -187,3 +187,4 @@
186 -> Beholder BeholdTV 501 [5ace:5010]
187 -> Beholder BeholdTV 503 FM [5ace:5030]
188 -> Sensoray 811/911 [6000:0811,6000:0911]
+189 -> Kworld PC150-U [17de:a134]
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.tuner b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.tuner
index 6323b7a2071..c83f6e41887 100644
--- a/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.tuner
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/CARDLIST.tuner
@@ -78,10 +78,11 @@ tuner=77 - TCL tuner MF02GIP-5N-E
tuner=78 - Philips FMD1216MEX MK3 Hybrid Tuner
tuner=79 - Philips PAL/SECAM multi (FM1216 MK5)
tuner=80 - Philips FQ1216LME MK3 PAL/SECAM w/active loopthrough
-tuner=81 - Xceive 4000 tuner
tuner=81 - Partsnic (Daewoo) PTI-5NF05
tuner=82 - Philips CU1216L
tuner=83 - NXP TDA18271
tuner=84 - Sony BTF-Pxn01Z
tuner=85 - Philips FQ1236 MK5
tuner=86 - Tena TNF5337 MFD
+tuner=87 - Xceive 4000 tuner
+tuner=88 - Xceive 5000C tuner
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/fimc.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/fimc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000000..eb049708f3e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/fimc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,178 @@
+Samsung S5P/EXYNOS4 FIMC driver
+
+Copyright (C) 2012 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The FIMC (Fully Interactive Mobile Camera) device available in Samsung
+SoC Application Processors is an integrated camera host interface, color
+space converter, image resizer and rotator. It's also capable of capturing
+data from LCD controller (FIMD) through the SoC internal writeback data
+path. There are multiple FIMC instances in the SoCs (up to 4), having
+slightly different capabilities, like pixel alignment constraints, rotator
+availability, LCD writeback support, etc. The driver is located at
+drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc directory.
+
+1. Supported SoCs
+=================
+
+S5PC100 (mem-to-mem only), S5PV210, EXYNOS4210
+
+2. Supported features
+=====================
+
+ - camera parallel interface capture (ITU-R.BT601/565);
+ - camera serial interface capture (MIPI-CSI2);
+ - memory-to-memory processing (color space conversion, scaling, mirror
+ and rotation);
+ - dynamic pipeline re-configuration at runtime (re-attachment of any FIMC
+ instance to any parallel video input or any MIPI-CSI front-end);
+ - runtime PM and system wide suspend/resume
+
+Not currently supported:
+ - LCD writeback input
+ - per frame clock gating (mem-to-mem)
+
+3. Files partitioning
+=====================
+
+- media device driver
+ drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc/fimc-mdevice.[ch]
+
+ - camera capture video device driver
+ drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc/fimc-capture.c
+
+ - MIPI-CSI2 receiver subdev
+ drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc/mipi-csis.[ch]
+
+ - video post-processor (mem-to-mem)
+ drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc/fimc-core.c
+
+ - common files
+ drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc/fimc-core.h
+ drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc/fimc-reg.h
+ drivers/media/video/s5p-fimc/regs-fimc.h
+
+4. User space interfaces
+========================
+
+4.1. Media device interface
+
+The driver supports Media Controller API as defined at
+http://http://linuxtv.org/downloads/v4l-dvb-apis/media_common.html
+The media device driver name is "SAMSUNG S5P FIMC".
+
+The purpose of this interface is to allow changing assignment of FIMC instances
+to the SoC peripheral camera input at runtime and optionally to control internal
+connections of the MIPI-CSIS device(s) to the FIMC entities.
+
+The media device interface allows to configure the SoC for capturing image
+data from the sensor through more than one FIMC instance (e.g. for simultaneous
+viewfinder and still capture setup).
+Reconfiguration is done by enabling/disabling media links created by the driver
+during initialization. The internal device topology can be easily discovered
+through media entity and links enumeration.
+
+4.2. Memory-to-memory video node
+
+V4L2 memory-to-memory interface at /dev/video? device node. This is standalone
+video device, it has no media pads. However please note the mem-to-mem and
+capture video node operation on same FIMC instance is not allowed. The driver
+detects such cases but the applications should prevent them to avoid an
+undefined behaviour.
+
+4.3. Capture video node
+
+The driver supports V4L2 Video Capture Interface as defined at:
+http://linuxtv.org/downloads/v4l-dvb-apis/devices.html
+
+At the capture and mem-to-mem video nodes only the multi-planar API is
+supported. For more details see:
+http://linuxtv.org/downloads/v4l-dvb-apis/planar-apis.html
+
+4.4. Camera capture subdevs
+
+Each FIMC instance exports a sub-device node (/dev/v4l-subdev?), a sub-device
+node is also created per each available and enabled at the platform level
+MIPI-CSI receiver device (currently up to two).
+
+4.5. sysfs
+
+In order to enable more precise camera pipeline control through the sub-device
+API the driver creates a sysfs entry associated with "s5p-fimc-md" platform
+device. The entry path is: /sys/platform/devices/s5p-fimc-md/subdev_conf_mode.
+
+In typical use case there could be a following capture pipeline configuration:
+sensor subdev -> mipi-csi subdev -> fimc subdev -> video node
+
+When we configure these devices through sub-device API at user space, the
+configuration flow must be from left to right, and the video node is
+configured as last one.
+When we don't use sub-device user space API the whole configuration of all
+devices belonging to the pipeline is done at the video node driver.
+The sysfs entry allows to instruct the capture node driver not to configure
+the sub-devices (format, crop), to avoid resetting the subdevs' configuration
+when the last configuration steps at the video node is performed.
+
+For full sub-device control support (subdevs configured at user space before
+starting streaming):
+# echo "sub-dev" > /sys/platform/devices/s5p-fimc-md/subdev_conf_mode
+
+For V4L2 video node control only (subdevs configured internally by the host
+driver):
+# echo "vid-dev" > /sys/platform/devices/s5p-fimc-md/subdev_conf_mode
+This is a default option.
+
+5. Device mapping to video and subdev device nodes
+==================================================
+
+There are associated two video device nodes with each device instance in
+hardware - video capture and mem-to-mem and additionally a subdev node for
+more precise FIMC capture subsystem control. In addition a separate v4l2
+sub-device node is created per each MIPI-CSIS device.
+
+How to find out which /dev/video? or /dev/v4l-subdev? is assigned to which
+device?
+
+You can either grep through the kernel log to find relevant information, i.e.
+# dmesg | grep -i fimc
+(note that udev, if present, might still have rearranged the video nodes),
+
+or retrieve the information from /dev/media? with help of the media-ctl tool:
+# media-ctl -p
+
+6. Platform support
+===================
+
+The machine code (plat-s5p and arch/arm/mach-*) must select following options
+
+CONFIG_S5P_DEV_FIMC0 mandatory
+CONFIG_S5P_DEV_FIMC1 \
+CONFIG_S5P_DEV_FIMC2 | optional
+CONFIG_S5P_DEV_FIMC3 |
+CONFIG_S5P_SETUP_FIMC /
+CONFIG_S5P_SETUP_MIPIPHY \
+CONFIG_S5P_DEV_CSIS0 | optional for MIPI-CSI interface
+CONFIG_S5P_DEV_CSIS1 /
+
+Except that, relevant s5p_device_fimc? should be registered in the machine code
+in addition to a "s5p-fimc-md" platform device to which the media device driver
+is bound. The "s5p-fimc-md" device instance is required even if only mem-to-mem
+operation is used.
+
+The description of sensor(s) attached to FIMC/MIPI-CSIS camera inputs should be
+passed as the "s5p-fimc-md" device platform_data. The platform data structure
+is defined in file include/media/s5p_fimc.h.
+
+7. Build
+========
+
+This driver depends on following config options:
+PLAT_S5P,
+PM_RUNTIME,
+I2C,
+REGULATOR,
+VIDEO_V4L2_SUBDEV_API,
+
+If the driver is built as a loadable kernel module (CONFIG_VIDEO_SAMSUNG_S5P_FIMC=m)
+two modules are created (in addition to the core v4l2 modules): s5p-fimc.ko and
+optional s5p-csis.ko (MIPI-CSI receiver subdev).
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/gspca.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/gspca.txt
index f2060f0dc02..e6c2842407a 100644
--- a/Documentation/video4linux/gspca.txt
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/gspca.txt
@@ -217,6 +217,7 @@ ov534_9 06f8:3003 Hercules Dualpix HD Weblog
sonixj 06f8:3004 Hercules Classic Silver
sonixj 06f8:3008 Hercules Deluxe Optical Glass
pac7302 06f8:3009 Hercules Classic Link
+pac7302 06f8:301b Hercules Link
nw80x 0728:d001 AVerMedia Camguard
spca508 0733:0110 ViewQuest VQ110
spca501 0733:0401 Intel Create and Share
diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/uvcvideo.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/uvcvideo.txt
index 848d620dcc5..35ce19cddcf 100644
--- a/Documentation/video4linux/uvcvideo.txt
+++ b/Documentation/video4linux/uvcvideo.txt
@@ -116,7 +116,7 @@ Description:
A UVC control can be mapped to several V4L2 controls. For instance,
a UVC pan/tilt control could be mapped to separate pan and tilt V4L2
controls. The UVC control is divided into non overlapping fields using
- the 'size' and 'offset' fields and are then independantly mapped to
+ the 'size' and 'offset' fields and are then independently mapped to
V4L2 control.
For signed integer V4L2 controls the data_type field should be set to
diff --git a/Documentation/virtual/kvm/mmu.txt b/Documentation/virtual/kvm/mmu.txt
index 5dc972c09b5..fa5f1dbc6b2 100644
--- a/Documentation/virtual/kvm/mmu.txt
+++ b/Documentation/virtual/kvm/mmu.txt
@@ -347,7 +347,7 @@ To instantiate a large spte, four constraints must be satisfied:
- the spte must point to a large host page
- the guest pte must be a large pte of at least equivalent size (if tdp is
- enabled, there is no guest pte and this condition is satisified)
+ enabled, there is no guest pte and this condition is satisfied)
- if the spte will be writeable, the large page frame may not overlap any
write-protected pages
- the guest page must be wholly contained by a single memory slot
@@ -356,7 +356,7 @@ To check the last two conditions, the mmu maintains a ->write_count set of
arrays for each memory slot and large page size. Every write protected page
causes its write_count to be incremented, thus preventing instantiation of
a large spte. The frames at the end of an unaligned memory slot have
-artificically inflated ->write_counts so they can never be instantiated.
+artificially inflated ->write_counts so they can never be instantiated.
Further reading
===============
diff --git a/Documentation/virtual/virtio-spec.txt b/Documentation/virtual/virtio-spec.txt
index a350ae135b8..da094737e2f 100644
--- a/Documentation/virtual/virtio-spec.txt
+++ b/Documentation/virtual/virtio-spec.txt
@@ -1403,7 +1403,7 @@ segmentation, if both guests are amenable.
Packets are transmitted by placing them in the transmitq, and
buffers for incoming packets are placed in the receiveq. In each
-case, the packet itself is preceeded by a header:
+case, the packet itself is preceded by a header:
struct virtio_net_hdr {
@@ -1642,7 +1642,7 @@ struct virtio_net_ctrl_mac {
The device can filter incoming packets by any number of
destination MAC addresses.[footnote:
-Since there are no guarentees, it can use a hash filter
+Since there are no guarantees, it can use a hash filter
orsilently switch to allmulti or promiscuous mode if it is given
too many addresses.
] This table is set using the class VIRTIO_NET_CTRL_MAC and the
@@ -1805,7 +1805,7 @@ the FLUSH and FLUSH_OUT types are equivalent, the device does not
distinguish between them
]). If the device has VIRTIO_BLK_F_BARRIER feature the high bit
(VIRTIO_BLK_T_BARRIER) indicates that this request acts as a
-barrier and that all preceeding requests must be complete before
+barrier and that all preceding requests must be complete before
this one, and all following requests must not be started until
this is complete. Note that a barrier does not flush caches in
the underlying backend device in host, and thus does not serve as
@@ -2118,7 +2118,7 @@ This is historical, and independent of the guest page size
Otherwise, the guest may begin to re-use pages previously given
to the balloon before the device has acknowledged their
- withdrawl. [footnote:
+ withdrawal. [footnote:
In this case, deflation advice is merely a courtesy
]
diff --git a/Documentation/vm/cleancache.txt b/Documentation/vm/cleancache.txt
index 36c367c7308..142fbb0f325 100644
--- a/Documentation/vm/cleancache.txt
+++ b/Documentation/vm/cleancache.txt
@@ -46,10 +46,11 @@ a negative return value indicates failure. A "put_page" will copy a
the pool id, a file key, and a page index into the file. (The combination
of a pool id, a file key, and an index is sometimes called a "handle".)
A "get_page" will copy the page, if found, from cleancache into kernel memory.
-A "flush_page" will ensure the page no longer is present in cleancache;
-a "flush_inode" will flush all pages associated with the specified file;
-and, when a filesystem is unmounted, a "flush_fs" will flush all pages in
-all files specified by the given pool id and also surrender the pool id.
+An "invalidate_page" will ensure the page no longer is present in cleancache;
+an "invalidate_inode" will invalidate all pages associated with the specified
+file; and, when a filesystem is unmounted, an "invalidate_fs" will invalidate
+all pages in all files specified by the given pool id and also surrender
+the pool id.
An "init_shared_fs", like init_fs, obtains a pool id but tells cleancache
to treat the pool as shared using a 128-bit UUID as a key. On systems
@@ -62,12 +63,12 @@ of the kernel (e.g. by "tools" that control cleancache). Or a
cleancache implementation can simply disable shared_init by always
returning a negative value.
-If a get_page is successful on a non-shared pool, the page is flushed (thus
-making cleancache an "exclusive" cache). On a shared pool, the page
-is NOT flushed on a successful get_page so that it remains accessible to
+If a get_page is successful on a non-shared pool, the page is invalidated
+(thus making cleancache an "exclusive" cache). On a shared pool, the page
+is NOT invalidated on a successful get_page so that it remains accessible to
other sharers. The kernel is responsible for ensuring coherency between
cleancache (shared or not), the page cache, and the filesystem, using
-cleancache flush operations as required.
+cleancache invalidate operations as required.
Note that cleancache must enforce put-put-get coherency and get-get
coherency. For the former, if two puts are made to the same handle but
@@ -77,22 +78,22 @@ if a get for a given handle fails, subsequent gets for that handle will
never succeed unless preceded by a successful put with that handle.
Last, cleancache provides no SMP serialization guarantees; if two
-different Linux threads are simultaneously putting and flushing a page
+different Linux threads are simultaneously putting and invalidating a page
with the same handle, the results are indeterminate. Callers must
lock the page to ensure serial behavior.
CLEANCACHE PERFORMANCE METRICS
-Cleancache monitoring is done by sysfs files in the
-/sys/kernel/mm/cleancache directory. The effectiveness of cleancache
+If properly configured, monitoring of cleancache is done via debugfs in
+the /sys/kernel/debug/mm/cleancache directory. The effectiveness of cleancache
can be measured (across all filesystems) with:
succ_gets - number of gets that were successful
failed_gets - number of gets that failed
puts - number of puts attempted (all "succeed")
-flushes - number of flushes attempted
+invalidates - number of invalidates attempted
-A backend implementatation may provide additional metrics.
+A backend implementation may provide additional metrics.
FAQ
@@ -143,7 +144,7 @@ systems.
The core hooks for cleancache in VFS are in most cases a single line
and the minimum set are placed precisely where needed to maintain
-coherency (via cleancache_flush operations) between cleancache,
+coherency (via cleancache_invalidate operations) between cleancache,
the page cache, and disk. All hooks compile into nothingness if
cleancache is config'ed off and turn into a function-pointer-
compare-to-NULL if config'ed on but no backend claims the ops
@@ -184,15 +185,15 @@ or for real kernel-addressable RAM, it makes perfect sense for
transcendent memory.
4) Why is non-shared cleancache "exclusive"? And where is the
- page "flushed" after a "get"? (Minchan Kim)
+ page "invalidated" after a "get"? (Minchan Kim)
The main reason is to free up space in transcendent memory and
-to avoid unnecessary cleancache_flush calls. If you want inclusive,
+to avoid unnecessary cleancache_invalidate calls. If you want inclusive,
the page can be "put" immediately following the "get". If
put-after-get for inclusive becomes common, the interface could
-be easily extended to add a "get_no_flush" call.
+be easily extended to add a "get_no_invalidate" call.
-The flush is done by the cleancache backend implementation.
+The invalidate is done by the cleancache backend implementation.
5) What's the performance impact?
@@ -222,7 +223,7 @@ Some points for a filesystem to consider:
as tmpfs should not enable cleancache)
- To ensure coherency/correctness, the FS must ensure that all
file removal or truncation operations either go through VFS or
- add hooks to do the equivalent cleancache "flush" operations
+ add hooks to do the equivalent cleancache "invalidate" operations
- To ensure coherency/correctness, either inode numbers must
be unique across the lifetime of the on-disk file OR the
FS must provide an "encode_fh" function.
@@ -243,11 +244,11 @@ If cleancache would use the inode virtual address instead of
inode/filehandle, the pool id could be eliminated. But, this
won't work because cleancache retains pagecache data pages
persistently even when the inode has been pruned from the
-inode unused list, and only flushes the data page if the file
+inode unused list, and only invalidates the data page if the file
gets removed/truncated. So if cleancache used the inode kva,
there would be potential coherency issues if/when the inode
kva is reused for a different file. Alternately, if cleancache
-flushed the pages when the inode kva was freed, much of the value
+invalidated the pages when the inode kva was freed, much of the value
of cleancache would be lost because the cache of pages in cleanache
is potentially much larger than the kernel pagecache and is most
useful if the pages survive inode cache removal.
diff --git a/Documentation/vm/page-types.c b/Documentation/vm/page-types.c
index 7445caa26d0..0b13f02d405 100644
--- a/Documentation/vm/page-types.c
+++ b/Documentation/vm/page-types.c
@@ -98,6 +98,7 @@
#define KPF_HWPOISON 19
#define KPF_NOPAGE 20
#define KPF_KSM 21
+#define KPF_THP 22
/* [32-] kernel hacking assistances */
#define KPF_RESERVED 32
@@ -147,6 +148,7 @@ static const char *page_flag_names[] = {
[KPF_HWPOISON] = "X:hwpoison",
[KPF_NOPAGE] = "n:nopage",
[KPF_KSM] = "x:ksm",
+ [KPF_THP] = "t:thp",
[KPF_RESERVED] = "r:reserved",
[KPF_MLOCKED] = "m:mlocked",
diff --git a/Documentation/vm/pagemap.txt b/Documentation/vm/pagemap.txt
index df09b9650a8..4600cbe3d6b 100644
--- a/Documentation/vm/pagemap.txt
+++ b/Documentation/vm/pagemap.txt
@@ -60,6 +60,7 @@ There are three components to pagemap:
19. HWPOISON
20. NOPAGE
21. KSM
+ 22. THP
Short descriptions to the page flags:
@@ -97,6 +98,9 @@ Short descriptions to the page flags:
21. KSM
identical memory pages dynamically shared between one or more processes
+22. THP
+ contiguous pages which construct transparent hugepages
+
[IO related page flags]
1. ERROR IO error occurred
3. UPTODATE page has up-to-date data
diff --git a/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.txt b/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.txt
index 97bae3c576c..fa206cccf89 100644
--- a/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.txt
+++ b/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.txt
@@ -538,7 +538,7 @@ different reverse map mechanisms.
process because mlocked pages are migratable. However, for reclaim, if
the page is mapped into a VM_LOCKED VMA, the scan stops.
- try_to_unmap_anon() attempts to acquire in read mode the mmap semphore of
+ try_to_unmap_anon() attempts to acquire in read mode the mmap semaphore of
the mm_struct to which the VMA belongs. If this is successful, it will
mlock the page via mlock_vma_page() - we wouldn't have gotten to
try_to_unmap_anon() if the page were already mlocked - and will return
@@ -619,11 +619,11 @@ all PTEs from the page. For this purpose, the unevictable/mlock infrastructure
introduced a variant of try_to_unmap() called try_to_munlock().
try_to_munlock() calls the same functions as try_to_unmap() for anonymous and
-mapped file pages with an additional argument specifing unlock versus unmap
+mapped file pages with an additional argument specifying unlock versus unmap
processing. Again, these functions walk the respective reverse maps looking
for VM_LOCKED VMAs. When such a VMA is found for anonymous pages and file
pages mapped in linear VMAs, as in the try_to_unmap() case, the functions
-attempt to acquire the associated mmap semphore, mlock the page via
+attempt to acquire the associated mmap semaphore, mlock the page via
mlock_vma_page() and return SWAP_MLOCK. This effectively undoes the
pre-clearing of the page's PG_mlocked done by munlock_vma_page.
@@ -641,7 +641,7 @@ with it - the usual fallback position.
Note that try_to_munlock()'s reverse map walk must visit every VMA in a page's
reverse map to determine that a page is NOT mapped into any VM_LOCKED VMA.
However, the scan can terminate when it encounters a VM_LOCKED VMA and can
-successfully acquire the VMA's mmap semphore for read and mlock the page.
+successfully acquire the VMA's mmap semaphore for read and mlock the page.
Although try_to_munlock() might be called a great many times when munlocking a
large region or tearing down a large address space that has been mlocked via
mlockall(), overall this is a fairly rare event.
diff --git a/Documentation/watchdog/00-INDEX b/Documentation/watchdog/00-INDEX
deleted file mode 100644
index fc9082a1477..00000000000
--- a/Documentation/watchdog/00-INDEX
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,19 +0,0 @@
-00-INDEX
- - this file.
-convert_drivers_to_kernel_api.txt
- - how-to for converting old watchdog drivers to the new kernel API.
-hpwdt.txt
- - information on the HP iLO2 NMI watchdog
-pcwd-watchdog.txt
- - documentation for Berkshire Products PC Watchdog ISA cards.
-src/
- - directory holding watchdog related example programs.
-watchdog-api.txt
- - description of the Linux Watchdog driver API.
-watchdog-kernel-api.txt
- - description of the Linux WatchDog Timer Driver Core kernel API.
-watchdog-parameters.txt
- - information on driver parameters (for drivers other than
- the ones that have driver-specific files here)
-wdt.txt
- - description of the Watchdog Timer Interfaces for Linux.
diff --git a/Documentation/watchdog/convert_drivers_to_kernel_api.txt b/Documentation/watchdog/convert_drivers_to_kernel_api.txt
index be8119bb15d..271b8850dde 100644
--- a/Documentation/watchdog/convert_drivers_to_kernel_api.txt
+++ b/Documentation/watchdog/convert_drivers_to_kernel_api.txt
@@ -59,6 +59,10 @@ Here is a overview of the functions and probably needed actions:
WDIOC_GETTIMEOUT:
No preparations needed
+ WDIOC_GETTIMELEFT:
+ It needs get_timeleft() callback to be defined. Otherwise it
+ will return EOPNOTSUPP
+
Other IOCTLs can be served using the ioctl-callback. Note that this is mainly
intended for porting old drivers; new drivers should not invent private IOCTLs.
Private IOCTLs are processed first. When the callback returns with
diff --git a/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-kernel-api.txt b/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-kernel-api.txt
index 4b93c28e35c..227f6cd0e5f 100644
--- a/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-kernel-api.txt
+++ b/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-kernel-api.txt
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
The Linux WatchDog Timer Driver Core kernel API.
===============================================
-Last reviewed: 29-Nov-2011
+Last reviewed: 16-Mar-2012
Wim Van Sebroeck <wim@iguana.be>
@@ -77,6 +77,7 @@ struct watchdog_ops {
int (*ping)(struct watchdog_device *);
unsigned int (*status)(struct watchdog_device *);
int (*set_timeout)(struct watchdog_device *, unsigned int);
+ unsigned int (*get_timeleft)(struct watchdog_device *);
long (*ioctl)(struct watchdog_device *, unsigned int, unsigned long);
};
@@ -117,11 +118,13 @@ they are supported. These optional routines/operations are:
status of the device is reported with watchdog WDIOF_* status flags/bits.
* set_timeout: this routine checks and changes the timeout of the watchdog
timer device. It returns 0 on success, -EINVAL for "parameter out of range"
- and -EIO for "could not write value to the watchdog". On success the timeout
- value of the watchdog_device will be changed to the value that was just used
- to re-program the watchdog timer device.
+ and -EIO for "could not write value to the watchdog". On success this
+ routine should set the timeout value of the watchdog_device to the
+ achieved timeout value (which may be different from the requested one
+ because the watchdog does not necessarily has a 1 second resolution).
(Note: the WDIOF_SETTIMEOUT needs to be set in the options field of the
watchdog's info structure).
+* get_timeleft: this routines returns the time that's left before a reset.
* ioctl: if this routine is present then it will be called first before we do
our own internal ioctl call handling. This routine should return -ENOIOCTLCMD
if a command is not supported. The parameters that are passed to the ioctl
@@ -167,4 +170,4 @@ driver specific data to and a pointer to the data itself.
The watchdog_get_drvdata function allows you to retrieve driver specific data.
The argument of this function is the watchdog device where you want to retrieve
-data from. The function retruns the pointer to the driver specific data.
+data from. The function returns the pointer to the driver specific data.
diff --git a/Documentation/zh_CN/HOWTO b/Documentation/zh_CN/HOWTO
index faf976c0c73..7fba5aab9ef 100644
--- a/Documentation/zh_CN/HOWTO
+++ b/Documentation/zh_CN/HOWTO
@@ -316,7 +316,7 @@ linux-kernel邮件列表中提供反馈,告诉大家你遇到了问题还是
git.kernel.org:/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/jejb/scsi-misc-2.6.git
使用quilt管理的补丁集:
- - USB, PCI, 驱动程序核心和I2C, Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
+ - USB, PCI, 驱动程序核心和I2C, Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
kernel.org/pub/linux/kernel/people/gregkh/gregkh-2.6/
- x86-64, 部分i386, Andi Kleen <ak@suse.de>
ftp.firstfloor.org:/pub/ak/x86_64/quilt/
diff --git a/Documentation/zh_CN/magic-number.txt b/Documentation/zh_CN/magic-number.txt
index c278f412dc6..f606ba8598c 100644
--- a/Documentation/zh_CN/magic-number.txt
+++ b/Documentation/zh_CN/magic-number.txt
@@ -89,7 +89,7 @@ TTY_DRIVER_MAGIC 0x5402 tty_driver include/linux/tty_driver.h
MGSLPC_MAGIC 0x5402 mgslpc_info drivers/char/pcmcia/synclink_cs.c
TTY_LDISC_MAGIC 0x5403 tty_ldisc include/linux/tty_ldisc.h
USB_SERIAL_MAGIC 0x6702 usb_serial drivers/usb/serial/usb-serial.h
-FULL_DUPLEX_MAGIC 0x6969 drivers/net/tulip/de2104x.c
+FULL_DUPLEX_MAGIC 0x6969 drivers/net/ethernet/dec/tulip/de2104x.c
USB_BLUETOOTH_MAGIC 0x6d02 usb_bluetooth drivers/usb/class/bluetty.c
RFCOMM_TTY_MAGIC 0x6d02 net/bluetooth/rfcomm/tty.c
USB_SERIAL_PORT_MAGIC 0x7301 usb_serial_port drivers/usb/serial/usb-serial.h